blob: 3054029fbd7277c3daeabf2303b5f1a370852620 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaueaded982022-12-01 15:25:34 +01005 version 2.8
Willy Tarreau40c88f92023-01-07 09:45:17 +01006 2023/01/07
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007
8
9This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
18 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
19 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020020 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
22 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
23 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020024 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025
26
27Summary
28-------
29
301. Quick reminder about HTTP
311.1. The HTTP transaction model
321.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100331.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200341.2.2. The request headers
351.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100361.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200371.3.2. The response headers
38
392. Configuring HAProxy
402.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200422.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100432.4. Conditional blocks
442.5. Time format
452.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100573.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020058
594. Proxies
604.1. Proxy keywords matrix
614.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
62
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100635. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200645.1. Bind options
655.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200665.3. Server DNS resolution
675.3.1. Global overview
685.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100706. Cache
716.1. Limitation
726.2. Setup
736.2.1. Cache section
746.2.2. Proxy section
75
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200767. Using ACLs and fetching samples
777.1. ACL basics
787.1.1. Matching booleans
797.1.2. Matching integers
807.1.3. Matching strings
817.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
827.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
837.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
847.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
857.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200867.3.1. Converters
877.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
887.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
897.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
907.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
917.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200927.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200937.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094
958. Logging
968.1. Log levels
978.2. Log formats
988.2.1. Default log format
998.2.2. TCP log format
1008.2.3. HTTP log format
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02001018.2.4. HTTPS log format
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +01001028.2.5. Error log format
1038.2.6. Custom log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001048.3. Advanced logging options
1058.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1068.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1078.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1088.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1098.4. Timing events
1108.5. Session state at disconnection
1118.6. Non-printable characters
1128.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1138.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1148.9. Examples of logs
115
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001169. Supported filters
1179.1. Trace
1189.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001199.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001209.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001219.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001229.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02001239.7. Bandwidth limitation
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200124
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012510. FastCGI applications
12610.1. Setup
12710.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12810.1.2. Proxy section
12910.1.3. Example
13010.2. Default parameters
13110.3. Limitations
132
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013311. Address formats
13411.1. Address family prefixes
13511.2. Socket type prefixes
13611.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137
1381. Quick reminder about HTTP
139----------------------------
140
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100141When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200142fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
143on almost anything found in the contents.
144
145However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
146formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
147correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
148
149
1501.1. The HTTP transaction model
151-------------------------------
152
153The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100154to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100155from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
156connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157will involve a new connection :
158
159 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
160
161In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
162establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
163by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
164length.
165
166Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
167to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
168however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
169response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
170header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
171
172 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
173
174Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
175power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
176but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200177a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100179Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
181second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
182page :
183
184 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
185
186This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
187latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
188correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
189the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100190server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200191
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +0200192The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2 and HTTP/3.
193This time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all
194streams are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100195parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
196carry the stream identifier.
197
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +0200198
199HTTP/3 is implemented over QUIC, itself implemented over UDP. QUIC solves the
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +0200200head of line blocking at transport level by means of independently treated
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +0200201streams. Indeed, when experiencing loss, an impacted stream does not affect the
202other streams.
203
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100204By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
205connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
206leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100207start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
208processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
209waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200210
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200211HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100212 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
213 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100214 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100215 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200216 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100217
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100218
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200219
2201.2. HTTP request
221-----------------
222
223First, let's consider this HTTP request :
224
225 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100226 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200227 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
228 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
229 3 User-agent: my small browser
230 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
231 5 Accept: image/png
232
233
2341.2.1. The Request line
235-----------------------
236
237Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
238
239 - a METHOD : GET
240 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
241 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
242
243All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
244which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
245followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
246is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
247desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
248the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
249
250The URI itself can have several forms :
251
252 - A "relative URI" :
253
254 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
255
256 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
257 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
258
259 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
260
261 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
262
263 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
264 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
265 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
266 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
267 must accept this form too.
268
269 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
270 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
271 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100272
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200273 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
274 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
275 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
276 other protocols too.
277
278In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
279mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
280on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
281It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
282specific to the language, framework or application in use.
283
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100284HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100285assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100286
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287
2881.2.2. The request headers
289--------------------------
290
291The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
292beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
293an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
294Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
295values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
296encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
297the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
298define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
299
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100300Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200301their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100302"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200303as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
304normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
305representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
306HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200307
308The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
309that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
310is one valid form of empty line.
311
312Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
313headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
314about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
315application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
316
317Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000318 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200319 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
320 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
321 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
322
323
3241.3. HTTP response
325------------------
326
327An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
328messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
329
330 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100331 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200332 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
333 2 Content-length: 350
334 3 Content-Type: text/html
335
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200336As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
337codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
338response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100339continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
340the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
341following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
342sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
343(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
344correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
345such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
346state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400347over the same connection and that HAProxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100348if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
349information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200350
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003521.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200353------------------------
354
355Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
356
357 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
358 - a status code : 200
359 - a reason : OK
360
361The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100362 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
363 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
364 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
365 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
366 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200367
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000368Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100369"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200370found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
371messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
372or "Authentication Required".
373
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100374HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200375
376 Code When / reason
377 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
378 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
379 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
380 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100381 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
382 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200383 400 for an invalid or too large request
384 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
385 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200386 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100387 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200388 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100389 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
390 be available again
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400391 500 when HAProxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200392 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400393 501 when HAProxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100394 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200395 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200396 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200397 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
398 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
399 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
400
401The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
4024.2).
403
404
4051.3.2. The response headers
406---------------------------
407
408Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
409the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
410details.
411
412
4132. Configuring HAProxy
414----------------------
415
4162.1. Configuration file format
417------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200418
419HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
420
421 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100422 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700423 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100424 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200425
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100426The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
427a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100428
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100429 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
430
431 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
432
433 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
434 tab characters
435
436 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
437 keyword sequences listed in this document
438
439 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
440 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
441 parts of the configuration, or expressions
442
443 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
444 are supported
445
446 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
447 section
448
449This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
450generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
451figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
452
453First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
454the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
455a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
456word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
457follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
458the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
459the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
460the parts that need to be addressed.
461
462A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
463requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
464extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
465the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
466section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
467section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
468not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
469
470A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
471each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
472a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
473start a new one.
474
475Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
476that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
477applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
478"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
479processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
480ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
481which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
482In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
483of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
484identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
485such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4862, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
487
488 listen foo
489 bind :80
490
491 listen bar
492 bind :81
493
494Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
495spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
496of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
497following configurations are strictly equivalent:
498
499 global#this is the global section
500 daemon#daemonize
501 frontend foo
502 mode http # or tcp
503
504and:
505
506 global
507 daemon
508
509 # this is the public web frontend
510 frontend foo
511 mode http
512
513The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
514new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
515other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
516section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
517section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
518at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
519
520Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
521are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
522editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
523support automatic indent.
524
525In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
526positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
527modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
528anymore, and is not recommended.
529
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200530
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005312.2. Quoting and escaping
532-------------------------
533
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100534In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
535that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
536possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
537in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
538('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200539
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100540This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
541very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
542the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
543also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
544delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
545word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
546remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200547
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100548If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
549(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
550
551Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
552backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200553
554 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
555 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
556 \\ to use a backslash
557 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
558 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
559
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100560In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
561C-language representation:
562
563 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
564 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
565 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
566 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
567
568Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
569or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
570of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200571
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100572 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200573 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
574 # hash as a comment start
575
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100576Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
577evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
578dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
579backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200580
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100581Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
582character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
583is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200584
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100585As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
586entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
587name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
588represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
589hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200590
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100591 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
592 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
593 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
594 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
595 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
596 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
597 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
598 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
599 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
600 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
601 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200602
603 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100604 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200605 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
606 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
607 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
608 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
609 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
610
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100611There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
612necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
613by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
614they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
615escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
616characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
617case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
618if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
619own quotes.
620
621The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600622quotes, except that the \#, \$, and \xNN escapes are not processed. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500623not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100624quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
625
626Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
627arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
628
629 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
630 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
631
632Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
633"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
634cannot write:
635
636 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
637
638because we would like the string to cut like this:
639
640 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
641 |---------|----|-|
642 arg1 _/ / /
643 arg2 __________/ /
644 arg3 ______________/
645
646but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
647parenthesis then garbage:
648
649 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
650 |--------|--------|
651 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
652 trailing garbage _________/
653
654The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
655quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
656processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
657this word:
658
659 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
660 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
661 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
662
663So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
664still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
665the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
666the second level:
667
668 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
669 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
670 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
671 |---------||----|-|
672 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
673 arg2=blah ___________/ /
674 arg3=g _______________/
675
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500676Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100677double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
678
679 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
680 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
681 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
682 |---------||----|-|
683 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
684 arg2 ___________/ /
685 arg3 _______________/
686
687When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
688appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
689string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
690thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
691
692 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
693 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
694 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
695 |-------------| |-----||-|
696 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
697 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
698 arg3 ______________________/
699
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400700Remember that backslashes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600701that the whole word above is already protected against them using the single
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100702quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
703single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
704level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
705
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600706Unfortunately, since single quotes can't be escaped inside of strong quoting,
707if you need to include single quotes in your argument, you will need to escape
708or quote them twice. There are a few ways to do this:
709
710 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str("\\'foo\\'")
711 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\"\'foo\'\")
712 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\\\'foo\\\')
713
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100714When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
715double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600716and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash if the string contains
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100717a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
718a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
719the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
720regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
721around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
722more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200723
724
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007252.3. Environment variables
726--------------------------
727
728HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
729interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
730configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
731optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
732shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200733underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
734list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
735arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
Willy Tarreauec347b12021-11-18 17:42:50 +0100736before the closing brace. It is also possible to specify a default value to
737use when the variable is not set, by appending that value after a dash '-'
738next to the variable name. Note that the default value only replaces non
739existing variables, not empty ones.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200740
741 Example:
742
743 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
744
Willy Tarreauec347b12021-11-18 17:42:50 +0100745 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG-127.0.0.1}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200746
747 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
748
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200749Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
750file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200751
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200752* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
753 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
754
755* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
756 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
757 directory.
758
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +0100759* HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT: contains the value of the default HTTP log format as
760 defined in section 8.2.3 "HTTP log format". It can be used to override the
761 default log format without having to copy the whole original definition.
762
763 Example:
764 # Add the rule that gave the final verdict to the log
765 log-format "${HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT} lr=last_rule_file:last_rule_line"
766
767* HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT: similar to HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT but for HTTPS log
768 format as defined in section 8.2.4 "HTTPS log format".
769
770* HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT: similar to HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT but for TCP log format
771 as defined in section 8.2.2 "TCP log format".
772
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200773* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
774
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500775* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200776 processes, separated by semicolons.
777
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500778* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200779 CLI, separated by semicolons.
780
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200781In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
782regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
783only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
784
785* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
786
787* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
788 starting at one.
789
790* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
791 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
792 first section.
793
794These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
795if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
796section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
797"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
798proxies.
799
800This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
801logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
802to name some config objects like servers for example.
803
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200804See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200805
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100806
8072.4. Conditional blocks
808-----------------------
809
810It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
811some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
812ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
813configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
814versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
815preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
816text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
817lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
818switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
819are defined to form conditional blocks:
820
821 - .if <condition>
822 - .elif <condition>
823 - .else
824 - .endif
825
826The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
827as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
828matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
829there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
830only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
831".elif" of a block.
832
833Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
834ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
835as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
836
Maximilian Maderfc0cceb2021-06-06 00:50:22 +0200837Conditions can also be evaluated on startup with the -cc parameter.
838See "3. Starting HAProxy" in the management doc.
839
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200840The conditions are either an empty string (which then returns false), or an
841expression made of any combination of:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100842
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100843 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
844 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200845 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200846 - a condition placed between a pair of parenthesis '(' and ')'
Kunal Gangakhedkard0bacde2021-08-17 11:55:45 +0530847 - an exclamation mark ('!') preceding any of the non-empty elements above,
848 and which will negate its status.
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200849 - expressions combined with a logical AND ('&&'), which will be evaluated
850 from left to right until one returns false
851 - expressions combined with a logical OR ('||'), which will be evaluated
852 from right to left until one returns true
853
854Note that like in other languages, the AND operator has precedence over the OR
855operator, so that "A && B || C && D" evalues as "(A && B) || (C && D)".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200856
857The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
858
859 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
860 exists, regardless of its contents
861
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200862 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
863 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
864 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
865
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200866 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
867 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
868
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200869 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
870 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
871 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
872 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
873
874 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
875 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
876 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
877 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
878
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200879Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100880
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200881 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
882 listen mwcli_px
883 bind :1111
884 ...
885 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100886
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200887 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
888 bind :80
889 .endif
890
891 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200892 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200893 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200894 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200895 .endif
896
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200897 .if feature(OPENSSL) && (streq("$WITH_SSL",yes) || streq("$SSL_ONLY",yes))
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200898 bind :443 ssl crt ...
899 .endif
900
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200901 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
902 profiling.memory on
903 .endif
904
Willy Tarreauca56d3d2021-07-16 13:56:54 +0200905 .if !feature(OPENSSL)
906 .alert "SSL support is mandatory"
907 .endif
908
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200909Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100910
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200911 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100912 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
913 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
914 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
915
916Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
917"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
918fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
919provide advice to the user.
920
921Example:
922
923 .if "${A}"
924 .if "${B}"
925 .notice "A=1, B=1"
926 .elif "${C}"
927 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
928 .elif "${D}"
929 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
930 .else
931 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
932 .endif
933 .else
934 .notice "A=0"
935 .endif
936
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200937 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
938 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
939
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100940
9412.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200942----------------
943
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100944Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100945values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
946otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
947numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
948for every keyword. Supported units are :
949
950 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
951 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
952 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
953 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
954 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
955 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
956
957
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01009582.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200959-------------
960
961 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
962 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
963 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
964 global
965 daemon
966 maxconn 256
967
968 defaults
969 mode http
970 timeout connect 5000ms
971 timeout client 50000ms
972 timeout server 50000ms
973
974 frontend http-in
975 bind *:80
976 default_backend servers
977
978 backend servers
979 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
980
981
982 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
983 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
984 global
985 daemon
986 maxconn 256
987
988 defaults
989 mode http
990 timeout connect 5000ms
991 timeout client 50000ms
992 timeout server 50000ms
993
994 listen http-in
995 bind *:80
996 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
997
998
999Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
1000
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +01001001 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02001002
1003
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010043. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001005--------------------
1006
1007Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
1008are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
1009of them have command-line equivalents.
1010
1011The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
1012
1013 * Process management and security
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001014 - 51degrees-allow-unmatched
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001015 - 51degrees-cache-size
1016 - 51degrees-data-file
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001017 - 51degrees-difference
1018 - 51degrees-drift
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001019 - 51degrees-property-name-list
1020 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001021 - 51degrees-use-performance-graph
1022 - 51degrees-use-predictive-graph
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001023 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001024 - chroot
Frédéric Lécaille372508c2022-05-06 08:53:16 +02001025 - cluster-secret
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001026 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001027 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001028 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001029 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001030 - description
1031 - deviceatlas-json-file
1032 - deviceatlas-log-level
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001033 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001034 - deviceatlas-separator
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001035 - expose-experimental-directives
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001036 - external-check
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02001037 - fd-hard-limit
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001038 - gid
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001039 - grace
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001040 - group
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001041 - h1-accept-payload-with-any-method
1042 - h1-case-adjust
1043 - h1-case-adjust-file
1044 - h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001045 - hard-stop-after
William Lallemandcfabb352022-05-12 10:51:15 +02001046 - httpclient.resolvers.id
1047 - httpclient.resolvers.prefer
1048 - httpclient.ssl.ca-file
1049 - httpclient.ssl.verify
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001050 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001051 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001052 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001053 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001054 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001055 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001056 - log-tag
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001057 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001058 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001059 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001060 - mworker-max-reloads
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001061 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001062 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001063 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001064 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001065 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001066 - presetenv
1067 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001068 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001069 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001070 - setenv
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001071 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001072 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001073 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001074 - ssl-default-bind-options
1075 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001076 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001077 - ssl-default-server-options
1078 - ssl-dh-param-file
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone8097652022-05-16 16:24:32 +02001079 - ssl-propquery
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02001080 - ssl-provider
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonccc03552022-05-17 15:18:37 +02001081 - ssl-provider-path
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001082 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001083 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001084 - stats
1085 - strict-limits
1086 - uid
1087 - ulimit-n
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001088 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001089 - unsetenv
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001090 - user
1091 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001092 - wurfl-data-file
1093 - wurfl-information-list
1094 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001095
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001096 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001097 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001098 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001099 - maxcompcpuusage
1100 - maxcomprate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001101 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001102 - maxconnrate
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001103 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001104 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001105 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001106 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001107 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreauc4e56dc2022-03-08 10:41:40 +01001108 - no-memory-trimming
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001109 - noepoll
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001110 - noevports
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001111 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001112 - nokqueue
1113 - nopoll
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001114 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001115 - nosplice
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001116 - profiling.tasks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001117 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001118 - server-state-file
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001119 - spread-checks
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001120 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001121 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001122 - tune.buffers.limit
1123 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001124 - tune.bufsize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001125 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001126 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001127 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001128 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001129 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001130 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001131 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001132 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001133 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001134 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001135 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001136 - tune.lua.maxmem
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001137 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001138 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1139 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001140 - tune.maxaccept
1141 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001142 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreau284cfc62022-12-19 08:15:57 +01001143 - tune.memory.hot-size
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001144 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreau8bd146d2022-07-19 20:17:38 +02001145 - tune.peers.max-updates-at-once
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001146 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001147 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1148 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Frédéric Lécaille38dea052022-05-25 17:14:28 +02001149 - tune.quic.frontend.conn-tx-buffers.limit
Frédéric Lécaille1d96d6e2022-05-23 16:38:14 +02001150 - tune.quic.frontend.max-idle-timeout
Frédéric Lécaille26740982022-05-23 17:28:01 +02001151 - tune.quic.frontend.max-streams-bidi
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02001152 - tune.quic.retry-threshold
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01001153 - tune.quic.socket-owner
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001154 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1155 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001156 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001157 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001158 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001159 - tune.sndbuf.client
1160 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +01001161 - tune.stick-counters
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001162 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001163 - tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size
1164 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size (deprecated)
1165 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02001166 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1167 - tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001168 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001169 - tune.ssl.lifetime
1170 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001171 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001172 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001173 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001174 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1175 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1176 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001177 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1178 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001179
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001180 * Debugging
Erwan Le Goasfad9da82022-09-14 17:24:22 +02001181 - anonkey
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001182 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001183 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001184
1185
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011863.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001187------------------------------------
1188
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100118951degrees-data-file <file path>
1190 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
1191 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1192
1193 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001194 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001195
119651degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
1197 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1198 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1199 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1200
1201 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001202 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001203
120451degrees-property-separator <char>
1205 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1206 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1207
1208 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001209 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001210
121151degrees-cache-size <number>
1212 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1213 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1214 By default, this cache is disabled.
1215
1216 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001217 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001218
121951degrees-use-performance-graph { on | off }
1220 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the use of the performance graph in
1221 the detection process. The default value depends on 51Degrees library.
1222
1223 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001224 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001225
122651degrees-use-predictive-graph { on | off }
1227 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the use of the predictive graph in
1228 the detection process. The default value depends on 51Degrees library.
1229
1230 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001231 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001232
123351degrees-drift <number>
1234 Sets the drift value that a detection can allow.
1235
1236 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001237 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001238
123951degrees-difference <number>
1240 Sets the difference value that a detection can allow.
1241
1242 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001243 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001244
124551degrees-allow-unmatched { on | off }
1246 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the use of unmatched nodes in the
1247 detection process. The default value depends on 51Degrees library.
1248
1249 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001250 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001251
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001252ca-base <dir>
1253 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001254 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1255 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1256 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001257
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001258chroot <jail dir>
1259 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1260 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1261 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1262 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1263 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001264 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001265
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001266close-spread-time <time>
1267 Define a time window during which idle connections and active connections
1268 closing is spread in case of soft-stop. After a SIGUSR1 is received and the
1269 grace period is over (if any), the idle connections will all be closed at
1270 once if this option is not set, and active HTTP or HTTP2 connections will be
1271 ended after the next request is received, either by appending a "Connection:
1272 close" line to the HTTP response, or by sending a GOAWAY frame in case of
1273 HTTP2. When this option is set, connection closing will be spread over this
1274 set <time>.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001275 If the close-spread-time is set to "infinite", active connection closing
1276 during a soft-stop will be disabled. The "Connection: close" header will not
1277 be added to HTTP responses (or GOAWAY for HTTP2) anymore and idle connections
1278 will only be closed once their timeout is reached (based on the various
1279 timeouts set in the configuration).
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001280
1281 Arguments :
1282 <time> is a time window (by default in milliseconds) during which
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001283 connection closing will be spread during a soft-stop operation, or
1284 "infinite" if active connection closing should be disabled.
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001285
1286 It is recommended to set this setting to a value lower than the one used in
1287 the "hard-stop-after" option if this one is used, so that all connections
1288 have a chance to gracefully close before the process stops.
1289
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001290 See also: grace, hard-stop-after, idle-close-on-response
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001291
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001292cluster-secret <secret>
1293 Define an ASCII string secret shared between several nodes belonging to the
1294 same cluster. It could be used for different usages. It is at least used to
1295 derive stateless reset tokens for all the QUIC connections instantiated by
1296 this process. This is also the case to derive secrets used to encrypt Retry
Amaury Denoyelle28ea31c2022-11-14 16:18:46 +01001297 tokens.
1298
1299 If this parameter is not set, a random value will be selected on process
1300 startup. This allows to use features which rely on it, albeit with some
1301 limitations.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001302
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001303cpu-map [auto:]<thread-group>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
1304 On some operating systems, it is possible to bind a thread group or a thread
1305 to a specific CPU set. This means that the designated threads will never run
1306 on other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for individual
1307 threads or thread groups. The first argument is a thread group range,
1308 optionally followed by a thread set. These ranges have the following format:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001309
1310 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1311
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001312 <number> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001313 word size. Any group IDs above 'thread-groups' and any thread IDs above the
1314 machine's word size are ignored. All thread numbers are relative to the group
1315 they belong to. It is possible to specify a range with two such number
1316 delimited by a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all threads at once
1317 using "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just
1318 like with the "thread" bind directive. The second and forthcoming arguments
1319 are CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the
1320 first CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside
1321 of Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to
1322 either 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the
1323 processes or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously,
1324 multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will
1325 replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001326
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001327 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1328 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1329 on the machine's word size.
1330
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001331 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the thread set to let HAProxy
1332 automatically bind a set of threads to a CPU by incrementing threads and
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001333 CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same size. No matter the
1334 declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from the lowest to the
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001335 highest bound. Having both a group and a thread range with the "auto:"
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001336 prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one must be
1337 a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001338
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001339 Note that group ranges are supported for historical reasons. Nowadays, a lone
1340 number designates a thread group and must be 1 if thread-groups are not used,
1341 and specifying a thread range or number requires to prepend "1/" in front of
1342 it if thread groups are not used. Finally, "1" is strictly equivalent to
1343 "1/all" and designates all threads in the group.
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001344
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001345 Examples:
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001346 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first group on the
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001347 # first 4 CPUs
1348
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001349 cpu-map 1/1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1/1-64 0-63"
1350 # or "cpu-map 1/1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001351 # word size.
1352
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001353 # all these lines bind thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001354 # and so on.
1355 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1356 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1357 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1358
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001359 # bind each thread to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
1360 cpu-map auto:1/all 0-63
1361 cpu-map auto:1/even 0-31
1362 cpu-map auto:1/odd 32-63
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001363
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001364 # invalid cpu-map because thread and CPU sets have different sizes.
1365 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0 # invalid
1366 cpu-map auto:1/1 0-3 # invalid
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001367
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001368 # map 40 threads of those 4 groups to individual CPUs
1369 cpu-map auto:1/1-10 0-9
1370 cpu-map auto:2/1-10 10-19
1371 cpu-map auto:3/1-10 20-29
1372 cpu-map auto:4/1-10 30-39
1373
1374 # Map 80 threads to one physical socket and 80 others to another socket
1375 # without forcing assignment. These are split into 4 groups since no
1376 # group may have more than 64 threads.
1377 cpu-map 1/1-40 0-39 80-119 # node0, siblings 0 & 1
1378 cpu-map 2/1-40 0-39 80-119
1379 cpu-map 3/1-40 40-79 120-159 # node1, siblings 0 & 1
1380 cpu-map 4/1-40 40-79 120-159
1381
1382
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001383crt-base <dir>
1384 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001385 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1386 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001387
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001388daemon
1389 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1390 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001391 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1392 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001393
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001394default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001395 By default HAProxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001396 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1397 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1398 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1399 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1400 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1401 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1402 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1403 not start with a slash ('/'):
1404 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1405 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1406
1407 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1408 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1409 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1410 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1411 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1412 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1413 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1414 each of them.
1415
1416 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1417 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1418 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1419 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1420 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1421 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1422 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1423 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1424
1425 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1426 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001427 different HAProxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001428 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1429 made easily relocatable.
1430
1431 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1432 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1433 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1434 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1435 consistent across all configuration files.
1436
1437 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1438 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1439 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1440 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1441 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1442 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1443 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1444 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1445
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001446description <text>
1447 Add a text that describes the instance.
1448
1449 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1450 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1451 "<" and ">" characters.
1452
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001453deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1454 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001455 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001456
1457deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001458 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001459 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1460
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001461deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001462 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1463 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1464 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001465
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001466deviceatlas-separator <char>
1467 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1468 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1469
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001470expose-experimental-directives
1471 This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
1472 the config file will be rejected.
1473
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001474external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001475 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1476 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001477 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1478 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1479 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1480 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1481 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001482
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02001483fd-hard-limit <number>
1484 Sets an upper bound to the maximum number of file descriptors that the
1485 process will use, regardless of system limits. While "ulimit-n" and "maxconn"
1486 may be used to enforce a value, when they are not set, the process will be
1487 limited to the hard limit of the RLIMIT_NOFILE setting as reported by
1488 "ulimit -n -H". But some modern operating systems are now allowing extremely
1489 large values here (in the order of 1 billion), which will consume way too
1490 much RAM for regular usage. The fd-hard-limit setting is provided to enforce
1491 a possibly lower bound to this limit. This means that it will always respect
1492 the system-imposed limits when they are below <number> but the specified
1493 value will be used if system-imposed limits are higher. In the example below,
1494 no other setting is specified and the maxconn value will automatically adapt
1495 to the lower of "fd-hard-limit" and the system-imposed limit:
1496
1497 global
1498 # use as many FDs as possible but no more than 50000
1499 fd-hard-limit 50000
1500
1501 See also: ulimit-n, maxconn
1502
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001503gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001504 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001505 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1506 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001507 Note that if HAProxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001508 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001509 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001510
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001511grace <time>
1512 Defines a delay between SIGUSR1 and real soft-stop.
1513
1514 Arguments :
1515 <time> is an extra delay (by default in milliseconds) after receipt of the
1516 SIGUSR1 signal that will be waited for before proceeding with the
1517 soft-stop operation.
1518
1519 This is used for compatibility with legacy environments where the haproxy
1520 process needs to be stopped but some external components need to detect the
1521 status before listeners are unbound. The principle is that the internal
1522 "stopping" variable (which is reported by the "stopping" sample fetch
1523 function) will be turned to true, but listeners will continue to accept
1524 connections undisturbed, until the delay expires, after what the regular
1525 soft-stop will proceed. This must not be used with processes that are
1526 reloaded, or this will prevent the old process from unbinding, and may
1527 prevent the new one from starting, or simply cause trouble.
1528
1529 Example:
1530
1531 global
1532 grace 10s
1533
1534 # Returns 200 OK until stopping is set via SIGUSR1
1535 frontend ext-check
1536 bind :9999
1537 monitor-uri /ext-check
1538 monitor fail if { stopping }
1539
1540 Please note that a more flexible and durable approach would instead consist
1541 for an orchestration system in setting a global variable from the CLI, use
1542 that variable to respond to external checks, then after a delay send the
1543 SIGUSR1 signal.
1544
1545 Example:
1546
1547 # Returns 200 OK until proc.stopping is set to non-zero. May be done
1548 # from HTTP using set-var(proc.stopping) or from the CLI using:
1549 # > set var proc.stopping int(1)
1550 frontend ext-check
1551 bind :9999
1552 monitor-uri /ext-check
1553 monitor fail if { var(proc.stopping) -m int gt 0 }
1554
1555 See also: hard-stop-after, monitor
1556
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001557group <group name>
1558 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1559 See also "gid" and "user".
1560
Christopher Faulet0f9c0f52022-05-13 09:20:13 +02001561h1-accept-payload-with-any-method
1562 Does not reject HTTP/1.0 GET/HEAD/DELETE requests with a payload.
1563
1564 While It is explicitly allowed in HTTP/1.1, HTTP/1.0 is not clear on this
1565 point and some old servers don't expect any payload and never look for body
1566 length (via Content-Length or Transfer-Encoding headers). It means that some
1567 intermediaries may properly handle the payload for HTTP/1.0 GET/HEAD/DELETE
1568 requests, while some others may totally ignore it. That may lead to security
1569 issues because a request smuggling attack is possible. Thus, by default,
1570 HAProxy rejects HTTP/1.0 GET/HEAD/DELETE requests with a payload.
1571
1572 However, it may be an issue with some old clients. In this case, this global
1573 option may be set.
1574
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001575h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1576 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1577 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1578 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1579 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001580 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001581 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1582 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1583 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1584 specified in a proxy.
1585
1586 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1587 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1588 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1589 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1590 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1591 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1592 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1593
1594 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1595 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1596 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1597 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1598 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1599
1600 Example:
1601 global
1602 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1603
1604 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1605 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1606
1607h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1608 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1609 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1610 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1611 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1612 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1613 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1614 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1615 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1616
1617 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1618 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1619 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1620
1621 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1622 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1623
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001624h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1625 This disables the announcement of the support for h2 websockets to clients.
1626 This can be use to overcome clients which have issues when implementing the
1627 relatively fresh RFC8441, such as Firefox 88. To allow clients to
1628 automatically downgrade to http/1.1 for the websocket tunnel, specify h2
1629 support on the bind line using "alpn" without an explicit "proto" keyword. If
1630 this statement was previously activated, this can be disabled by prefixing
1631 the keyword with "no'.
1632
1633hard-stop-after <time>
1634 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1635
1636 Arguments :
1637 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1638 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1639 SIGUSR1 signal.
1640
1641 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1642 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1643 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1644
1645 Example:
1646 global
1647 hard-stop-after 30s
1648
1649 See also: grace
1650
1651httpclient.resolvers.id <resolvers id>
1652 This option defines the resolvers section with which the httpclient will try
1653 to resolve.
1654
1655 Default option is the "default" resolvers ID. By default, if this option is
1656 not used, it will simply disable the resolving if the section is not found.
1657
1658 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
1659 configuration error if it fails to load.
1660
1661httpclient.resolvers.prefer <ipv4|ipv6>
1662 This option allows to chose which family of IP you want when resolving,
1663 which is convenient when IPv6 is not available on your network. Default
1664 option is "ipv6".
1665
William Lallemandde1803f2022-05-04 18:14:25 +02001666httpclient.ssl.ca-file <cafile>
1667 This option defines the ca-file which should be used to verify the server
1668 certificate. It takes the same parameters as the "ca-file" option on the
1669 server line.
1670
1671 By default and when this option is not used, the value is
1672 "@system-ca" which tries to load the CA of the system. If it fails the SSL
1673 will be disabled for the httpclient.
1674
1675 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
1676 configuration error if it fails.
1677
1678httpclient.ssl.verify [none|required]
1679 Works the same way as the verify option on server lines. If specified to 'none',
1680 servers certificates are not verified. Default option is "required".
1681
1682 By default and when this option is not used, the value is
1683 "required". If it fails the SSL will be disabled for the httpclient.
1684
1685 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
1686 configuration error if it fails.
1687
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001688insecure-fork-wanted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001689 By default HAProxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001690 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1691 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1692 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1693 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1694 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1695 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1696 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001697 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within HAProxy itself
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001698 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1699 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1700 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1701 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1702 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1703 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1704 disable it.
1705
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001706insecure-setuid-wanted
1707 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1708 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1709 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1710 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001711 aware of the risks. In a situation where HAProxy would need to call external
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001712 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001713 HAProxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001714 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1715 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001716 escalation in such a situation. This is what HAProxy does by default. In case
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001717 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1718 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1719 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1720 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1721
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001722issuers-chain-path <dir>
1723 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1724 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1725 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001726 intermediate certificate), HAProxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001727 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1728 "issuers-chain-path".
1729 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1730 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1731 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1732 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1733 will share the chain in memory.
1734
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001735localpeer <name>
1736 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1737 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1738 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1739 the configuration parsing.
1740
1741 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1742 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1743
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001744log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001745 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001746 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001747 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001748 configured with "log global".
1749
1750 <address> can be one of:
1751
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001752 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001753 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1754 port).
1755
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001756 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1757 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1758 port).
1759
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001760 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001761 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1762 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001763 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001764
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001765 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1766 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1767 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1768 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1769 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1770 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1771 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1772 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1773 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1774 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001775 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow HAProxy down
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001776 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1777 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1778 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001779 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1780 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001781
1782 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1783 "fd@2", see above.
1784
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001785 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1786 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1787 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1788 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1789 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1790
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001791 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1792 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001793
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001794 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1795 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1796 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1797 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1798 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1799 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1800 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1801 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1802 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1803 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001804 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1805 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001806
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001807 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1808 one of the following :
1809
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001810 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1811 field is stripped. This is the default.
1812 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1813 rfc3164.
1814
1815 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001816 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1817
1818 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1819 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1820
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001821 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1822 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1823 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1824 designed to be used with a local log server.
1825
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001826 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1827 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1828 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1829 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1830 logger consumes.
1831
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001832 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1833 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1834 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1835 used with a local log server.
1836
1837 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1838 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1839 designed to be used with a local log server.
1840
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001841 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1842 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1843 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1844 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1845
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001846 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1847 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1848 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1849 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1850 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1851
1852 <sample_size>
1853 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1854 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1855 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1856 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1857 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1858
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001859 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001860
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001861 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1862 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1863 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1864
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001865 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1866 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1867 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1868 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001869
1870 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001871 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1872 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1873 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1874 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1875 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1876 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001877
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001878 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001879
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001880log-send-hostname [<string>]
1881 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1882 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1883 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1884 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1885 the logs.
1886
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001887log-tag <string>
1888 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1889 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1890 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001891 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001892
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02001893lua-load <file> [ <arg1> [ <arg2> [ ... ] ] ]
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001894 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1895 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1896 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1897 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1898 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1899 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001900 used multiple times.
1901
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +05001902 args are available in the lua file using the code below in the body of the
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02001903 file. Do not forget that Lua arrays start at index 1. A "local" variable
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +05001904 declared in a file is available in the entire file and not available on
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02001905 other files.
1906
1907 local args = table.pack(...)
1908
1909lua-load-per-thread <file> [ <arg1> [ <arg2> [ ... ] ] ]
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001910 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1911 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1912 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1913 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1914 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1915 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1916 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1917 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1918 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1919 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1920 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1921 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1922 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1923 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1924 times.
1925
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02001926 See lua-load for usage of args.
1927
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001928lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1929 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1930 variable.
1931 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1932 to "path".
1933
1934 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1935 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1936 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1937 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1938 will be checked earlier.
1939
1940 As an example by specifying the following path:
1941
1942 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1943 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1944
1945 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1946 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1947 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1948 paths if that does not exist either.
1949
1950 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1951 documentation.
1952
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001953master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001954 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1955 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1956 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001957 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001958 or daemon mode.
1959
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001960 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1961 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1962 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1963 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1964 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001965
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001966 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001967
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001968mworker-max-reloads <number>
1969 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001970 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001971 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1972 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1973 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1974
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001975nbthread <number>
1976 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02001977 makes HAProxy run on <number> threads. "nbthread" also works when HAProxy is
1978 started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity, the default
1979 "nbthread" value is automatically set to the number of CPUs the process is
1980 bound to upon startup. This means that the thread count can easily be
1981 adjusted from the calling process using commands like "taskset" or "cpuset".
1982 Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default value is reported in the
1983 output of "haproxy -vv".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001984
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001985numa-cpu-mapping
Amaury Denoyelleb09f4472021-12-15 09:48:39 +01001986 If running on a NUMA-aware platform, HAProxy inspects on startup the CPU
1987 topology of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity
1988 is automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done
1989 in order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the
1990 inter-socket bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a
1991 particular architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no
1992 numa-cpu-mapping'. This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread
1993 statement is present in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is
1994 already specified, for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset
1995 utility.
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001996
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001997pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001998 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1999 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
2000 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
2001 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002002
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02002003pp2-never-send-local
2004 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
2005 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
2006 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
2007 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
2008 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
2009 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
2010 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
2011 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
2012 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
2013 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
2014 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
2015
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002016presetenv <name> <value>
2017 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
2018 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
2019 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
2020 and "unsetenv".
2021
2022resetenv [<name> ...]
2023 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
2024 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
2025 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
2026 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
2027 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
2028 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
2029 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
2030 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
2031
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02002032server-state-base <directory>
2033 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002034 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
2035 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02002036
2037server-state-file <file>
2038 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
2039 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
2040 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
2041 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
2042 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
2043 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
2044 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
2045 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002046 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
2047 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02002048
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002049set-dumpable
2050 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
2051 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
2052 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
2053 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
2054 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
2055 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
2056 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
2057 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
2058 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
2059 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
2060 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
2061 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
2062 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
2063 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
2064 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
2065 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
2066 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the "haproxy" process and verify that it
2067 leaves a core where expected when dying.
2068
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01002069set-var <var-name> <expr>
2070 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
2071 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
2072 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
2073 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
2074 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
2075 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
Willy Tarreau753d4db2021-09-03 09:02:47 +02002076 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It is
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01002077 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
2078 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
2079
2080 Example:
2081 global
2082 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
2083 set-var proc.prio int(100)
2084 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
2085
Willy Tarreau753d4db2021-09-03 09:02:47 +02002086set-var-fmt <var-name> <fmt>
2087 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the string resulting from the
2088 evaluation of the log-format <fmt>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
2089 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
2090 'set-var-fmt' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is
2091 evaluated at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly
2092 set. The sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression
2093 are only those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'.
2094 It is possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These
2095 variables will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
2096 Please see section 8.2.4 for details on the log-format syntax.
2097
2098 Example:
2099 global
2100 set-var-fmt proc.current_state "primary"
2101 set-var-fmt proc.bootid "%pid|%t"
2102
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002103setenv <name> <value>
2104 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
2105 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
2106 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
2107 and "unsetenv".
2108
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002109ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
2110 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2111 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00002112 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002113 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002114 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
2115 information and recommendations see e.g.
2116 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
2117 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
2118 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
2119 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002120
2121ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
2122 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
2123 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
2124 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
2125 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
2126 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002127 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
2128 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
2129 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002130 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002131
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02002132ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
2133 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2134 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
2135 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
2136 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
2137 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
2138
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01002139ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
2140 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2141 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
2142 keyword to see available options.
2143
2144 Example:
2145 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02002146 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01002147
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002148ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
2149 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
2150 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00002151 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002152 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002153 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
2154 information and recommendations see e.g.
2155 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
2156 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
2157 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
2158 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
2159 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002160
2161ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
2162 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
2163 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
2164 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
2165 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
2166 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002167 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
2168 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
2169 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
2170 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002171
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01002172ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
2173 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2174 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
2175 keyword to see available options.
2176
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002177ssl-dh-param-file <file>
2178 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2179 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
2180 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002181 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002182 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02002183 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1d6338e2022-04-12 11:31:55 +02002184 directly in the certificate file, DHE ciphers will not be used, unless
2185 tune.ssl.default-dh-param is set. In this latter case, pre-defined DH
2186 parameters of the specified size will be used. Custom parameters are known to
2187 be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002188 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
2189 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
2190 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
2191
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone8097652022-05-16 16:24:32 +02002192ssl-propquery <query>
2193 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and when
2194 OpenSSL's version is at least 3.0. It allows to define a default property
2195 string used when fetching algorithms in providers. It behave the same way as
2196 the openssl propquery option and it follows the same syntax (described in
2197 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man3.0/man7/property.html). For instance, if you
2198 have two providers loaded, the foo one and the default one, the propquery
2199 "?provider=foo" allows to pick the algorithm implementations provided by the
2200 foo provider by default, and to fallback on the default provider's one if it
2201 was not found.
2202
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002203ssl-provider <name>
2204 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and when
2205 OpenSSL's version is at least 3.0. It allows to load a provider during init.
2206 If loading is successful, any capabilities provided by the loaded provider
2207 might be used by HAProxy. Multiple 'ssl-provider' options can be specified in
2208 a configuration file. The providers will be loaded in their order of
2209 appearance.
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02002210
2211 Please note that loading a provider explicitly prevents OpenSSL from loading
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002212 the 'default' provider automatically. OpenSSL also allows to define the
2213 providers that should be loaded directly in its configuration file
2214 (openssl.cnf for instance) so it is not necessary to use this 'ssl-provider'
2215 option to load providers. The "show ssl providers" CLI command can be used to
2216 show all the providers that were successfully loaded.
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02002217
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002218 The default search path of OpenSSL provider can be found in the output of the
2219 "openssl version -a" command. If the provider is in another directory, you
2220 can set the OPENSSL_MODULES environment variable, which takes the directory
2221 where your provider can be found.
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02002222
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonccc03552022-05-17 15:18:37 +02002223 See also "ssl-propquery" and "ssl-provider-path".
2224
2225ssl-provider-path <path>
2226 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and when
2227 OpenSSL's version is at least 3.0. It allows to specify the search path that
2228 is to be used by OpenSSL for looking for providers. It behaves the same way
2229 as the OPENSSL_MODULES environment variable. It will be used for any
2230 following 'ssl-provider' option or until a new 'ssl-provider-path' is
2231 defined.
2232 See also "ssl-provider".
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002233
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002234ssl-load-extra-del-ext
2235 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
2236 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02002237 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002238 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02002239 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
2240
2241 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002242
2243 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
2244 and won't try to remove them.
2245
2246 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
2247
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002248ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002249 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002250 the loading of the SSL certificates. This option applies to certificates
2251 associated to "bind" lines as well as "server" lines but some of the extra
2252 files will not have any functional impact for "server" line certificates.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002253
2254 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
2255 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
2256 optimize the startup time.
2257
2258 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
2259 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
2260 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
2261
2262 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002263 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002264
2265 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002266 will try to load a "cert bundle". Certificate bundles are only managed on the
2267 frontend side and will not work for backend certificates.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002268
2269 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
2270 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
2271 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
2272 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
2273 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002274 bind configuration.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002275
2276 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002277 HAProxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002278 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
2279 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
2280 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
2281 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
2282 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002283 this bundle into HAProxy, specify the base name only:
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002284
2285 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
2286
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002287 Note that the suffix is not given to HAProxy; this tells HAProxy to look for
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002288 a cert bundle.
2289
2290 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
2291 separately in several "crt".
2292
2293 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
2294 since files are loading separately.
2295
2296 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
2297 required to commit them.
2298
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02002299 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002300 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002301
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002302 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2303 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2304 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002305
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002306 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2307 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2308 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002309
2310 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002311 not provided in the PEM file. If provided for a backend certificate, it will
2312 be loaded but will not have any functional impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002313
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002314 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
2315 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
2316
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002317 The default behavior is "all".
2318
2319 Example:
2320 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
2321 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
2322 ssl-load-extra-files none
2323
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002324 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options and section 5.2 about server
2325 options.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002326
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01002327ssl-server-verify [none|required]
2328 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
2329 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
2330 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
2331
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002332ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002333 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002334 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
2335 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
2336 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
2337 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
2338 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
2339 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02002340 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002341
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002342stats maxconn <connections>
2343 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
2344 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
2345
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002346stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
2347 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
2348 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
2349 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02002350 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02002351 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02002352
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002353 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
2354 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
2355 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002356
2357stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
2358 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
2359 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01002360 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002361
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002362strict-limits
2363 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. HAProxy tries to set the
2364 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2365 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
2366 HAProxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
2367 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002368
Willy Tarreaud04bc3a2021-09-27 13:55:10 +02002369thread-group <group> [<thread-range>...]
2370 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
2371 enumerates the list of threads that will compose thread group <group>.
2372 Thread numbers and group numbers start at 1. Thread ranges are defined either
2373 using a single thread number at once, or by specifying the lower and upper
2374 bounds delimited by a dash '-' (e.g. "1-16"). Unassigned threads will be
2375 automatically assigned to unassigned thread groups, and thread groups
2376 defined with this directive will never receive more threads than those
2377 defined. Defining the same group multiple times overrides previous
2378 definitions with the new one. See also "nbthread" and "thread-groups".
2379
Willy Tarreauc33b9692021-09-22 12:07:23 +02002380thread-groups <number>
2381 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
2382 makes HAProxy split its threads into <number> independent groups. At the
Willy Tarreau856d56d2022-07-15 21:46:55 +02002383 moment, the default value is 1. Thread groups make it possible to reduce
2384 sharing between threads to limit contention, at the expense of some extra
2385 configuration efforts. It is also the only way to use more than 64 threads
2386 since up to 64 threads per group may be configured. The maximum number of
2387 groups is configured at compile time and defaults to 16. See also "nbthread".
Willy Tarreauc33b9692021-09-22 12:07:23 +02002388
Willy Tarreau9fd05422022-11-16 17:29:12 +01002389trace <args...>
2390 This command configures one "trace" subsystem statement. Each of them can be
2391 found in the management manual, and follow the exact same syntax. Only one
2392 statement per line is permitted (i.e. if some long trace configurations using
2393 semi-colons are to be imported, they must be placed one per line). Any output
2394 that the "trace" command would produce will be emitted during the parsing
2395 step of the section. Most of the time these will be errors and warnings, but
2396 certain incomplete commands might list permissible choices. This command is
2397 not meant for regular use, it will generally only be suggested by developers
2398 along complex debugging sessions. For this reason it is internally marked as
2399 experimental, meaning that "expose-experimental-directives" must appear on a
2400 line before any "trace" statement. Note that these directives are parsed on
2401 the fly, so referencing a ring buffer that is only declared further will not
2402 work. For such use cases it is suggested to place another "global" section
2403 with only the "trace" statements after the declaration of that ring. It is
2404 important to keep in mind that depending on the trace level and details,
2405 enabling traces can severely degrade the global performance. Please refer to
2406 the management manual for the statements syntax.
2407
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002408uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07002409 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002410 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
2411 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
2412 one. See also "gid" and "user".
2413
2414ulimit-n <number>
2415 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
2416 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002417 option. If the intent is only to limit the number of file descriptors, better
2418 use "fd-hard-limit" instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002419
Amaury Denoyelle414a6122021-08-06 10:25:32 +02002420 Note that the dynamic servers are not taken into account in this automatic
2421 resource calculation. If using a large number of them, it may be needed to
2422 manually specify this value.
2423
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002424 See also: fd-hard-limit, maxconn
2425
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002426unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
2427 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2428
2429 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2430 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2431 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2432 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2433 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002434 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before HAProxy chroots
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002435 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2436 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2437 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2438 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2439
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002440unsetenv [<name> ...]
2441 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2442 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2443 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2444 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2445 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2446 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2447 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2448
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002449user <user name>
2450 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2451 See also "uid" and "group".
2452
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002453node <name>
2454 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2455
2456 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2457 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2458 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2459 traffic.
2460
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002461wurfl-cache-size <size>
2462 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2463 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
2464 - "0" : no cache is used.
2465 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002466
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002467 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
2468 with USE_WURFL=1.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002469
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002470wurfl-data-file <file path>
2471 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2472 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2473
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002474 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002475 with USE_WURFL=1.
2476
2477wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2478 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2479 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2480 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2481
2482 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2483
2484 Valid WURFL properties are:
2485 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2486
2487 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2488 device.
2489
2490 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2491 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2492
2493 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2494 particular web request.
2495
2496 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2497 used Libwurfl API version.
2498
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002499 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2500 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2501
2502 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2503 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2504
2505 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2506
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002507 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002508 with USE_WURFL=1.
2509
2510wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2511 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2512 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2513
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002514 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002515 with USE_WURFL=1.
2516
2517wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2518 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2519 thus before the chroot.
2520
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002521 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002522 with USE_WURFL=1.
2523
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025243.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002525-----------------------
2526
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002527busy-polling
2528 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2529 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2530 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2531 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2532 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2533 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2534 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2535 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2536 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2537 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2538 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2539 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2540 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2541 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2542 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2543 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2544 "poll" pollers.
2545
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002546 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2547 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2548 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2549
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002550max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002551 By default, HAProxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002552 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2553 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2554 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2555 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2556 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2557 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2558 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2559
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002560maxcompcpuusage <number>
2561 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2562 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2563 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
2564 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by HAProxy. A
2565 value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting a lower
2566 value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole process down
2567 and from introducing high latencies.
2568
2569maxcomprate <number>
2570 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
2571 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
2572 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2573 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2574 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
2575 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
2576 default value.
2577
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002578maxconn <number>
2579 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2580 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2581 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002582 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2583 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2584 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2585 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002586 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2587 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2588 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2589 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2590 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002591 also be automatic). In any case, the fd-hard-limit applies if set.
2592
2593 See also: fd-hard-limit, ulimit-n
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002594
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002595maxconnrate <number>
2596 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2597 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2598 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2599 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2600 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2601 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2602 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2603 fairness.
2604
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002605maxpipes <number>
2606 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2607 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2608 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2609 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2610 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2611 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2612
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002613maxsessrate <number>
2614 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2615 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2616 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2617 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2618 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2619 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2620 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2621 fairness.
2622
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002623maxsslconn <number>
2624 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2625 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2626 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2627 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2628 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2629 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2630 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002631 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2632 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2633 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2634 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002635 when there is a memory limit, HAProxy will automatically adjust these values
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002636 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2637 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002638
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002639maxsslrate <number>
2640 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2641 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2642 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2643 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2644 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2645 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2646 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2647 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2648 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2649 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2650
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002651maxzlibmem <number>
2652 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2653 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2654 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002655 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2656 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2657 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2658
Willy Tarreauc4e56dc2022-03-08 10:41:40 +01002659no-memory-trimming
2660 Disables memory trimming ("malloc_trim") at a few moments where attempts are
2661 made to reclaim lots of memory (on memory shortage or on reload). Trimming
2662 memory forces the system's allocator to scan all unused areas and to release
2663 them. This is generally seen as nice action to leave more available memory to
2664 a new process while the old one is unlikely to make significant use of it.
2665 But some systems dealing with tens to hundreds of thousands of concurrent
2666 connections may experience a lot of memory fragmentation, that may render
2667 this release operation extremely long. During this time, no more traffic
2668 passes through the process, new connections are not accepted anymore, some
2669 health checks may even fail, and the watchdog may even trigger and kill the
2670 unresponsive process, leaving a huge core dump. If this ever happens, then it
2671 is suggested to use this option to disable trimming and stop trying to be
2672 nice with the new process. Note that advanced memory allocators usually do
2673 not suffer from such a problem.
2674
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002675noepoll
2676 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2677 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002678 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002679
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002680noevports
2681 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2682 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2683 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2684 also "nopoll".
2685
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002686nogetaddrinfo
2687 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2688 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2689
2690nokqueue
2691 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2692 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2693 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2694
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002695nopoll
2696 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2697 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002698 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002699 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2700 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002701
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002702noreuseport
2703 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2704 command line argument "-dR".
2705
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002706nosplice
2707 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002708 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002709 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002710 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002711 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2712 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2713 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2714 "option splice-response".
2715
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002716profiling.memory { on | off }
2717 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2718 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2719 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2720 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2721 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2722 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2723 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2724 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2725 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2726
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002727profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2728 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2729 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2730 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2731 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002732 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002733 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2734 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2735 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2736 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2737
2738 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2739 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2740 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2741 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2742 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002743 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2744 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2745 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2746 CLI.
2747
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002748spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002749 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2750 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2751 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2752 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2753 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2754 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002755
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002756ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002757 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002758 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002759 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002760 unsupported engine will prevent HAProxy from starting. Note that many engines
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002761 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2762 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2763 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002764 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2765 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002766 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2767 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2768 openssl configuration file uses:
2769 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2770
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002771ssl-mode-async
2772 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002773 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002774 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2775 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002776 HAProxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002777 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002778 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002779
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002780tune.buffers.limit <number>
2781 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2782 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2783 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2784 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2785 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002786 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002787 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2788 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2789 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2790 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2791 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2792 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2793 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2794 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002795 advised to do so by an HAProxy core developer.
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002796
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002797tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2798 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2799 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2800 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002801 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at HAProxy core developers.
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002802
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002803tune.bufsize <number>
2804 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2805 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2806 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2807 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2808 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2809 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2810 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002811 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2812 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002813 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), HAProxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002814 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002815 than this size, HAProxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002816 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2817 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002818
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002819tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2820 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2821 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2822 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2823 this value. The default value is 1.
2824
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002825tune.fail-alloc
Willy Tarreauf4b79c42022-02-23 15:20:53 +01002826 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC or started with "-dMfail", gives the
2827 percentage of chances an allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no
2828 failure) and 100 (no success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory
2829 failures are handled gracefully.
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002830
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002831tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2832 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2833 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2834 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2835 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2836 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2837
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002838tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2839 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2840 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2841 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2842 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2843 change it.
2844
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002845tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2846 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002847 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from HAProxy. This setting
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002848 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Glenn Strauss0012f892022-06-04 22:11:50 -04002849 The default value is 65536, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002850 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2851 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2852 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2853 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2854
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002855tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2856 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2857 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2858 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2859 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2860 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002861 client may create as many streams as allocatable by HAProxy. It is highly
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002862 recommended not to change this value.
2863
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002864tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002865 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that HAProxy announces it is willing to
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002866 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002867 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, HAProxy will not announce support
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002868 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2869 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2870 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2871 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2872
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002873tune.http.cookielen <number>
2874 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2875 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2876 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2877 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2878 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2879 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2880 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2881 to change this value.
2882
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002883tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002884 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2885 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002886 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002887 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002888 configuration directives too.
2889 The default value is 1024.
2890
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002891tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2892 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2893 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2894 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2895 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2896 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2897 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002898 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2899 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2900 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002901
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002902tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2903 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2904 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2905 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2906 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2907 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2908 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002909 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2910 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2911 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2912 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2913 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002914
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002915tune.idletimer <timeout>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002916 Sets the duration after which HAProxy will consider that an empty buffer is
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002917 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2918 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2919 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2920 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002921 means that HAProxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002922 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002923 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002924 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2925
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002926tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2927 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2928 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2929 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2930 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2931 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2932 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2933 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2934 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2935 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2936
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002937tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2938 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002939 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002940 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2941 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002942 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002943 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2944 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2945
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002946tune.lua.maxmem
2947 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2948 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2949 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2950 memory.
2951
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002952tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2953 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002954 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2955 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002956 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002957
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002958tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2959 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2960 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2961 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002962 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002963
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002964tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2965 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2966 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2967 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2968 check servers.
2969
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002970tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002971 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2972 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002973 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2974 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2975 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2976 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2977 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2978 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2979 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2980 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2981 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002982
2983tune.maxpollevents <number>
2984 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2985 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2986 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2987 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2988 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2989
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002990tune.maxrewrite <number>
2991 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2992 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2993 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2994 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2995 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2996 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2997 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2998 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2999 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
3000 bufsize.
3001
Willy Tarreau284cfc62022-12-19 08:15:57 +01003002tune.memory.hot-size <number>
3003 Sets the per-thread amount of memory that will be kept hot in the local cache
3004 and will never be recoverable by other threads. Access to this memory is very
3005 fast (lockless), and having enough is critical to maintain a good performance
3006 level under extreme thread contention. The value is expressed in bytes, and
3007 the default value is configured at build time via CONFIG_HAP_POOL_CACHE_SIZE
3008 which defaults to 524288 (512 kB). A larger value may increase performance in
3009 some usage scenarios, especially when performance profiles show that memory
3010 allocation is stressed a lot. Experience shows that a good value sits between
3011 once to twice the per CPU core L2 cache size. Too large values will have a
3012 negative impact on performance by making inefficient use of the L3 caches in
3013 the CPUs, and will consume larger amounts of memory. It is recommended not to
3014 change this value, or to proceed in small increments. In order to completely
3015 disable the per-thread CPU caches, using a very small value could work, but
3016 it is better to use "-dMno-cache" on the command-line.
3017
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02003018tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
3019 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
3020 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
3021 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
3022 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
3023 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
3024 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
3025 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
3026 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
3027 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02003028 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
3029 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02003030 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
3031 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
3032 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
3033 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
3034 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
3035 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
3036 setting this parameter to 0.
3037
Willy Tarreau8bd146d2022-07-19 20:17:38 +02003038tune.peers.max-updates-at-once <number>
3039 Sets the maximum number of stick-table updates that haproxy will try to
3040 process at once when sending messages. Retrieving the data for these updates
3041 requires some locking operations which can be CPU intensive on highly
3042 threaded machines if unbound, and may also increase the traffic latency
3043 during the initial batched transfer between an older and a newer process.
3044 Conversely low values may also incur higher CPU overhead, and take longer
3045 to complete. The default value is 200 and it is suggested not to change it.
3046
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02003047tune.pipesize <number>
3048 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
3049 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
3050 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
3051 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
3052 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
3053 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
3054
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02003055tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
3056 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003057 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02003058 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
3059 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
3060 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
3061 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003062 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02003063
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02003064tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
3065 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003066 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02003067 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
3068 default is 20.
3069
Frédéric Lécaille38dea052022-05-25 17:14:28 +02003070tune.quic.frontend.conn-tx-buffers.limit <number>
Amaury Denoyelle97e84c62022-04-19 18:26:55 +02003071 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
3072 change without deprecation in the future.
3073
3074 This settings defines the maximum number of buffers allocated for a QUIC
3075 connection on data emission. By default, it is set to 30. QUIC buffers are
3076 drained on ACK reception. This setting has a direct impact on the throughput
3077 and memory consumption and can be adjusted according to an estimated round
Frédéric Lécaille38dea052022-05-25 17:14:28 +02003078 time-trip. Each buffer is tune.bufsize.
Amaury Denoyelle97e84c62022-04-19 18:26:55 +02003079
Frédéric Lécaille1d96d6e2022-05-23 16:38:14 +02003080tune.quic.frontend.max-idle-timeout <timeout>
3081 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
3082 change without deprecation in the future.
3083
3084 Sets the QUIC max_idle_timeout transport parameters in milliseconds for
3085 frontends which determines the period of time after which a connection silently
3086 closes if it has remained inactive during an effective period of time deduced
3087 from the two max_idle_timeout values announced by the two endpoints:
3088 - the minimum of the two values if both are not null,
3089 - the maximum if only one of them is not null,
3090 - if both values are null, this feature is disabled.
3091
3092 The default value is 30000.
3093
Frédéric Lécaille26740982022-05-23 17:28:01 +02003094tune.quic.frontend.max-streams-bidi <number>
3095 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
3096 change without deprecation in the future.
3097
3098 Sets the QUIC initial_max_streams_bidi transport parameter for frontends.
3099 This is the initial maximum number of bidirectional streams the remote peer
3100 will be authorized to open. This determines the number of concurrent client
3101 requests.
3102
3103 The default value is 100.
3104
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02003105tune.quic.retry-threshold <number>
3106 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
3107 change without deprecation in the future.
3108
3109 Dynamically enables the Retry feature for all the configured QUIC listeners
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02003110 as soon as this number of half open connections is reached. A half open
3111 connection is a connection whose handshake has not already successfully
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02003112 completed or failed. To be functional this setting needs a cluster secret to
3113 be set, if not it will be silently ignored (see "cluster-secret" setting).
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02003114 This setting will be also silently ignored if the use of QUIC Retry was
3115 forced (see "quic-force-retry").
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02003116
3117 The default value is 100.
3118
3119 See https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc9000.html#section-8.1.2 for more
3120 information about QUIC retry.
3121
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01003122tune.quic.socket-owner { listener | connection }
3123 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
3124 change without deprecation in the future.
3125
3126 Specifies how QUIC connections will use socket for receive/send operations.
3127 Connections can share listener socket or each connection can allocate its
3128 own socket.
3129
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01003130 When default "connection" value is set, a dedicated socket will be allocated
3131 by every QUIC connections. This option is the preferred one to achieve the
3132 best performance with a large QUIC traffic. However, this relies on some
3133 advanced features from the UDP network stack. If your platform is deemed not
3134 compatible, haproxy will automatically switch to "listener" mode on startup.
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01003135
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01003136 The "listener" value indicates that QUIC transfers will occur on the shared
3137 listener socket. This option can be a good compromise for small traffic as it
3138 allows to reduce FD consumption. However, performance won't be optimal due to
Ilya Shipitsin5fa29b82022-12-07 09:46:19 +05003139 a higher CPU usage if listeners are shared across a lot of threads or a
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01003140 large number of QUIC connections can be used simultaneously.
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01003141
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003142tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
3143tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
3144 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
3145 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
3146 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003147 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003148 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003149 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
3150 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
3151
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01003152tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003153 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01003154 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
3155 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
3156 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
3157 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
3158
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02003159tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003160 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01003161 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
3162 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
3163 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
3164 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
3165 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
3166 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
3167 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02003168
3169tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
3170 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003171 HAProxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02003172 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
3173 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
3174 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
3175 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
3176 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
3177 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
3178 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02003179
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003180tune.sndbuf.client <number>
3181tune.sndbuf.server <number>
3182 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
3183 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
3184 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003185 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003186 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003187 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
3188 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
3189 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
3190 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003191 notifying HAProxy again.
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003192
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01003193tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01003194 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01003195 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
3196 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
3197 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
3198 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
3199 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
3200 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
3201 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
3202 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
3203 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02003204 pre-allocated upon startup. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session
3205 cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01003206
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01003207tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size <number>
3208tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number> (deprecated)
3209 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client hello cipher
3210 list, extensions list, elliptic curves list and elliptic curve point
3211 formats. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled,
3212 otherwise a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
3213
3214tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
3215 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
3216 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
3217 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
3218 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
3219 this maximum value. Only 1024 or higher values are allowed. Higher values
3220 will increase the CPU load, and values greater than 1024 bits are not
3221 supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not used if static
3222 Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly in the certificate
3223 file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
3224 If there is neither a default-dh-param nor a ssl-dh-param-file defined, and
3225 if the server's PEM file of a given frontend does not specify its own DH
3226 parameters, then DHE ciphers will be unavailable for this frontend.
3227
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02003228tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02003229 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02003230 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
3231 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
3232 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
3233 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
3234 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
3235
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02003236tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord <number>
3237 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at any time. Default
3238 value 0 means there is no limit. In contrast to tune.ssl.maxrecord this
3239 settings will not be adjusted dynamically. Smaller records may decrease
3240 throughput, but may be required when dealing with low-footprint clients.
3241
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02003242tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
3243 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
3244 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
3245 performances. This is disabled by default.
3246
3247 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
3248 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
3249
3250 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
3251
3252 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
3253
3254 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
3255
3256 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
3257 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
3258 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
3259
3260 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
3261 converted.
3262
3263 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
3264 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
3265 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
3266 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
3267 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
3268 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
3269 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02003270 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
3271 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02003272
3273 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
3274
3275 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
3276 only need this line:
3277
3278 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
3279
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01003280tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
3281 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003282 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01003283 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
3284 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
3285 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
3286 being used for too long.
3287
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01003288tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02003289 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at the beginning of
3290 the data transfer. Default value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS,
3291 the client can decipher the data only once it has received a full record.
3292 With large records, it means that clients might have to download up to 16kB
3293 of data before starting to process them. Limiting the value can improve page
3294 load times on browsers located over high latency or low bandwidth networks.
3295 It is suggested to find optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments
3296 (generally 1448 bytes over Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when
3297 timestamps are disabled), keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead.
3298 Typical values of 1419 and 2859 gave good results during tests. Use
3299 "strace -e trace=write" to find the best value. HAProxy will automatically
3300 switch to this setting after an idle stream has been detected (see
3301 tune.idletimer above). See also tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord.
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01003302
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02003303tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
3304 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
3305 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
3306 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
3307 1000 entries.
3308
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +01003309tune.stick-counters <number>
3310 Sets the number of stick-counters that may be tracked at the same time by a
3311 connection or a request via "track-sc*" actions in "tcp-request" or
3312 "http-request" rules. The defaut value is set at build time by the macro
3313 MAX_SESS_STK_CTR, and defaults to 3. With this setting it is possible to
3314 change the value and ignore the one passed at build time. Increasing this
3315 value may be needed when porting complex configurations to haproxy, but users
3316 are warned against the costs: each entry takes 16 bytes per connection and
3317 16 bytes per request, all of which need to be allocated and zeroed for all
3318 requests even when not used. As such a value of 10 will inflate the memory
3319 consumption per request by 320 bytes and will cause this memory to be erased
3320 for each request, which does have measurable CPU impacts. Conversely, when
3321 no "track-sc" rules are used, the value may be lowered (0 being valid to
3322 entirely disable stick-counters).
3323
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003324tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01003325tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003326tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
3327tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
3328tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01003329 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
3330 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
3331 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
3332 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
3333 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
3334 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
3335 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
3336 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003337
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003338 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
3339 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
3340 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
3341 all available space is consumed.
3342 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
3343 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
3344 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003345
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003346tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
3347 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003348 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003349 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003350 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003351 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
3352
3353tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
3354 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
3355 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003356 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
3357 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003358
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020033593.3. Debugging
3360--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003361
Erwan Le Goasfad9da82022-09-14 17:24:22 +02003362anonkey <key>
3363 This sets the global anonymizing key to <key>, which must be a 32-bit number
3364 between 0 and 4294967295. This is the key that will be used by default by CLI
3365 commands when anonymized mode is enabled. This key may also be set at runtime
Erwan Le Goasb0c05012022-09-14 17:51:55 +02003366 from the CLI command "set global-key". See also command line argument "-dC"
3367 in the management manual.
Erwan Le Goasfad9da82022-09-14 17:24:22 +02003368
Willy Tarreaue98d3852022-11-15 09:34:07 +01003369quick-exit
3370 This speeds up the old process exit upon reload by skipping the releasing of
3371 memory objects and listeners, since all of these are reclaimed by the
3372 operating system at the process' death. The gains are only marginal (in the
3373 order of a few hundred milliseconds for huge configurations at most). The
3374 main target usage in fact is when a bug is spotted in the deinit() code, as
3375 this allows to bypass it. It is better not to use this unless instructed to
3376 do so by developers.
3377
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003378quiet
3379 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
3380 line argument "-q".
3381
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02003382zero-warning
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003383 When this option is set, HAProxy will refuse to start if any warning was
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02003384 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
3385 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
3386 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
3387 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
3388 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
3389
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003390
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010033913.4. Userlists
3392--------------
3393It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
3394http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
3395it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
3396
3397userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003398 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003399 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
3400
3401group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003402 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003403 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
3404 proceeded by "users" keyword.
3405
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003406user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
3407 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003408 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
3409 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003410 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
3411 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
3412 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
3413 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003414
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003415 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
3416 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
3417 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
3418 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
3419 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
3420 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
3421 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003422 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in HAProxy's
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003423 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003424
3425 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003426 userlist L1
3427 group G1 users tiger,scott
3428 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003429
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003430 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
3431 user scott insecure-password elgato
3432 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003433
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003434 userlist L2
3435 group G1
3436 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003437
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003438 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
3439 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
3440 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003441
3442 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003443
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003444
34453.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003446----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003447It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003448several HAProxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003449instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
Willy Tarreaudb2ab822021-10-08 17:53:12 +02003450values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. As an exception, the data
3451type "conn_cur" is never learned from peers, as it is supposed to reflect local
3452values. Earlier versions used to synchronize it and to cause negative values in
3453active-active setups, and always-growing values upon reloads or active-passive
3454switches because the local value would reflect more connections than locally
3455present. This information, however, is pushed so that monitoring systems can
3456watch it.
3457
3458Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
3459known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
3460the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
3461process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
3462during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
3463tables.
3464
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003465Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
3466that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
3467each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003468
3469peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003470 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003471 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
3472
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003473bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3474 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
3475 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
3476
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003477disabled
3478 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
3479 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
3480 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
3481
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003482default-bind [param*]
3483 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
3484
3485default-server [param*]
3486 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
3487
3488 Arguments:
3489 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3490 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
Willy Tarreau0f4a02b2022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003491 section dedicated to it. In a peers section, the transport
3492 parameters of a "default-server" line are supported. Please refer
3493 to section 5 for more details, and the "server" keyword below in
3494 this section for some of the restrictions.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003495
3496 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
3497
Emeric Brun620761f2021-09-29 10:29:52 +02003498enabled
3499 This re-enables a peers section which was previously disabled via the
3500 "disabled" keyword.
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003501
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003502log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01003503 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3504 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
3505 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
3506 more details.
3507
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003508peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003509 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
3510 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003511 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003512 HAProxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003513 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
3514 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
3515 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003516
3517 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
3518 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
3519
3520 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003521 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
3522 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
3523 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003524
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003525 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
3526 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003527
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003528 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
3529 "server" keyword explanation below).
3530
3531server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003532 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Willy Tarreau0f4a02b2022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003533 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph that are
3534 related to transport settings. If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port>
3535 parameters must not be present; these parameters must be provided on a "bind"
3536 line (see "bind" keyword of this "peers" section).
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003537
Willy Tarreau0f4a02b2022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003538 A number of "server" parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections. Peers by
3539 nature do not support dynamic host name resolution nor health checks, hence
3540 parameters like "init_addr", "resolvers", "check", "agent-check", or "track"
3541 are not supported. Similarly, there is no load balancing nor stickiness, thus
3542 parameters such as "weight" or "cookie" have no effect.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003543
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003544 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003545 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003546 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003547 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
3548 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3549 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003550
3551 backend mybackend
3552 mode tcp
3553 balance roundrobin
3554 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3555 stick on src
3556
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003557 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3558 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003559
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003560 Example:
3561 peers mypeers
Emeric Brune77984f2022-05-30 18:13:35 +02003562 bind 192.168.0.1:1024 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3563 default-server ssl verify none
3564 server haproxy1 #local peer
3565 server haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3566 server haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003567
Frédéric Lécaille36d15652022-10-17 14:58:19 +02003568shards <shards>
3569
3570 In some configurations, one would like to distribute the stick-table contents
3571 to some peers in place of sending all the stick-table contents to each peer
3572 declared in the "peers" section. In such cases, "shards" specifies the
3573 number of peer involved in this stick-table contents distribution.
3574 See also "shard" server parameter.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003575
3576table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3577 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3578
3579 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3580 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003581 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003582 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3583 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3584 "stick-table" keyword).
3585
3586 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3587 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3588 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3589 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3590 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3591 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3592 of the stick-table name as follows:
3593
3594 peers mypeers
3595 peer A ...
3596 peer B ...
3597 table t1 ...
3598
3599 frontend fe1
3600 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3601
3602 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3603 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3604
3605 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3606 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3607 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3608 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3609 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3610 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3611 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3612
3613 peers mypeers
3614 peer A ...
3615 peer B ...
3616 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3617
3618 backend t1
3619 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3620
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003621 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003622 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
3623 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
3624
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090036253.6. Mailers
3626------------
3627It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
3628If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
3629in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
3630
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02003631mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003632 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
3633 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
3634
3635mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
3636 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
3637
3638 Example:
3639 mailers mymailers
3640 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3641 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3642
3643 backend mybackend
3644 mode tcp
3645 balance roundrobin
3646
3647 email-alert mailers mymailers
3648 email-alert from test1@horms.org
3649 email-alert to test2@horms.org
3650
3651 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3652 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
3653
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01003654timeout mail <time>
3655 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
3656 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
3657 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
3658 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
3659
3660 Example:
3661 mailers mymailers
3662 timeout mail 20s
3663 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003664
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020036653.7. Programs
3666-------------
3667In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
3668master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
3669managed the same way as the workers.
3670
3671During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
3672sequence as a worker:
3673
3674 - the master is re-executed
3675 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
3676 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
3677 instance of the program
3678
3679During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
3680
3681program <name>
3682 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
3683 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
3684 the management guide).
3685
3686command <command> [arguments*]
3687 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
3688 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
3689 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
3690 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
3691
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08003692user <user name>
3693 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3694 See also "group".
3695
3696group <group name>
3697 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3698 See also "user".
3699
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003700option start-on-reload
3701no option start-on-reload
3702 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3703 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3704 program section.
3705
3706
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010037073.8. HTTP-errors
3708----------------
3709
3710It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3711imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3712several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3713
3714http-errors <name>
3715 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3716 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3717
3718errorfile <code> <file>
3719 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3720
3721 Arguments :
3722 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003723 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003724 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003725
3726 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3727 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3728 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3729 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3730 before any chroot is performed.
3731
3732 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3733
3734 Example:
3735 http-errors website-1
3736 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3737 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3738 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3739
3740 http-errors website-2
3741 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3742 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3743 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3744
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020037453.9. Rings
3746----------
3747
3748It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3749servers or traces.
3750
3751ring <ringname>
3752 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3753
Willy Tarreau0b8e9ce2022-08-11 16:38:20 +02003754backing-file <path>
3755 This replaces the regular memory allocation by a RAM-mapped file to store the
3756 ring. This can be useful for collecting traces or logs for post-mortem
3757 analysis, without having to attach a slow client to the CLI. Newer contents
3758 will automatically replace older ones so that the latest contents are always
3759 available. The contents written to the ring will be visible in that file once
3760 the process stops (most often they will even be seen very soon after but
3761 there is no such guarantee since writes are not synchronous).
3762
3763 When this option is used, the total storage area is reduced by the size of
3764 the "struct ring" that starts at the beginning of the area, and that is
3765 required to recover the area's contents. The file will be created with the
3766 starting user's ownership, with mode 0600 and will be of the size configured
Willy Tarreau32872db2022-08-31 18:52:17 +02003767 by the "size" directive. When the directive is parsed (thus even during
3768 config checks), any existing non-empty file will first be renamed with the
3769 extra suffix ".bak", and any previously existing file with suffix ".bak" will
3770 be removed. This ensures that instant reload or restart of the process will
3771 not wipe precious debugging information, and will leave time for an admin to
3772 spot this new ".bak" file and to archive it if needed. As such, after a crash
3773 the file designated by <path> will contain the freshest information, and if
3774 the service is restarted, the "<path>.bak" file will have it instead. This
3775 means that the total storage capacity required will be double of the ring
3776 size. Failures to rotate the file are silently ignored, so placing the file
3777 into a directory without write permissions will be sufficient to avoid the
3778 backup file if not desired.
Willy Tarreau0b8e9ce2022-08-11 16:38:20 +02003779
3780 WARNING: there are stability and security implications in using this feature.
3781 First, backing the ring to a slow device (e.g. physical hard drive) may cause
3782 perceptible slowdowns during accesses, and possibly even panics if too many
3783 threads compete for accesses. Second, an external process modifying the area
3784 could cause the haproxy process to crash or to overwrite some of its own
3785 memory with traces. Third, if the file system fills up before the ring,
3786 writes to the ring may cause the process to crash.
3787
3788 The information present in this ring are structured and are NOT directly
3789 readable using a text editor (even though most of it looks barely readable).
3790 The output of this file is only intended for developers.
3791
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003792description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003793 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003794 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3795
3796format <format>
3797 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3798
3799 Arguments:
3800 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3801 one of the following :
3802
3803 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3804 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3805 designed to be used with a local log server.
3806
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003807 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3808 field is stripped. This is the default.
3809 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3810 rfc3164.
3811
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003812 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3813 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3814 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3815 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3816 is the default.
3817
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003818 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003819 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3820
3821 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3822 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3823
3824 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3825 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3826 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3827 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3828 logger consumes.
3829
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003830 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3831 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3832 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3833 with a local log server.
3834
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003835 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3836 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3837 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3838 used with a local log server.
3839
3840maxlen <length>
3841 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3842 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3843 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3844
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003845server <name> <address> [param*]
3846 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3847 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3848 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3849 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3850 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3851 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3852 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3853 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3854 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003855 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3856 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003857
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003858size <size>
3859 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3860 set to BUFSIZE.
3861
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003862timeout connect <timeout>
3863 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3864
3865 Arguments :
3866 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3867 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3868 as explained at the top of this document.
3869
3870timeout server <timeout>
3871 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3872
3873 Arguments :
3874 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3875 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3876 as explained at the top of this document.
3877
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003878 Example:
3879 global
3880 log ring@myring local7
3881
3882 ring myring
3883 description "My local buffer"
3884 format rfc3164
3885 maxlen 1200
3886 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003887 timeout connect 5s
3888 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003889 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003890
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020038913.10. Log forwarding
3892-------------------
3893
3894It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003895HAProxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003896
3897log-forward <name>
3898 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3899
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003900backlog <conns>
3901 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3902 on connections accept.
3903
3904bind <addr> [param*]
3905 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003906 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3907 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3908 syslog protocol over TCP.
3909 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003910 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3911
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003912dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003913 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3914 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3915 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3916 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003917 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003918
3919log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003920log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003921 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3922 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3923 documentation.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003924 If no format specified, HAProxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003925 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3926 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3927 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003928 exists in output format, HAProxy will use the local date.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003929
3930 Example:
3931 global
3932 log stderr format iso local7
3933
3934 ring myring
3935 description "My local buffer"
3936 format rfc5424
3937 maxlen 1200
3938 size 32764
3939 timeout connect 5s
3940 timeout server 10s
3941 # syslog tcp server
3942 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3943
3944 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003945 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3946 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003947 # all messages on stderr
3948 log global
3949 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3950 log ring@myring local0
3951 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3952 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3953 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3954 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3955 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003956
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003957maxconn <conns>
3958 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3959 10 is the default.
3960
3961timeout client <timeout>
3962 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3963
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020039644. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003965----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003966
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003967Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003968 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3969 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3970 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3971 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003972
3973A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3974connections.
3975
3976A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3977to forward incoming connections.
3978
3979A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3980parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3981
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003982A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3983ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3984sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3985the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3986explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3987from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3988"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3989for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3990to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3991optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3992are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3993any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3994names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3995that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3996duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
Christopher Fauletb4054202021-10-12 18:57:43 +02003997names. This rule might be enforced in a future version. In addition, a warning
3998is emitted if a defaults section is explicitly used by a proxy while it is also
3999implicitly used by another one because it is the last one defined. It is highly
4000encouraged to not mix both usages by always using explicit references or by
4001adding a last common defaults section reserved for all implicit uses.
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01004002
4003Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
4004settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
4005of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
4006profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
4007timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
4008
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004009All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
4010'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
4011case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
4012
4013Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
4014logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
4015proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
4016However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
4017name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
4018
4019Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
4020and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004021bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004022protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
4023modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
4024arbitrary criteria.
4025
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004026In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
4027a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01004028the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004029
4030 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
4031 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
4032 between responses and new requests.
4033
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004034 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
4035 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
4036 client-facing connection remains open.
4037
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004038 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
4039 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004040
4041The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
4042frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
4043following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004044weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004045
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004046 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004047
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004048 | KAL | SCL | CLO
4049 ----+-----+-----+----
4050 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
4051 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004052 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
4053 ----+-----+-----+----
4054 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004055
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004056It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004057only HTTP traffic is handled. But it may be used to handle several protocols
4058within the same frontend. In this case, the client's connection is first handled
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004059as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004060content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data is parsed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004061and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
4062possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004063
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004064There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004065first ones involves a TCP to HTTP/1 upgrade. In HTTP/1, the request
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004066processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004067second one involves a TCP to HTTP/2 upgrade. Because it is a multiplexed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004068protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
4069is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
4070new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004071to understand this difference because that drastically changes the way to
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004072process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
4073already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
4074HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
4075evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
4076one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
4077
4078There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
4079performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
4080tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
4081preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
4082analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
4083HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
4084header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
4085mitigate this drawback.
4086
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004087There are two ways to perform an HTTP upgrade. The first one, the historical
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004088method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
4089set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
4090in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
4091is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
4092to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
4093above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
4094to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
4095"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
4096frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
4097frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
4098as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
4099upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
4100on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
4101the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
4102upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
4103frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
4104remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004105
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020041064.1. Proxy keywords matrix
4107--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004108
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004109The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
4110limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
4111they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
4112limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004113marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004114option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02004115and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
4116with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004117specified in a previous "defaults" section. Keywords supported in defaults
4118sections marked with "(!)" are only supported in named defaults sections, not
4119anonymous ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004120
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004121
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004122 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
4123------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004124acl X (!) X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004125backlog X X X -
4126balance X - X X
4127bind - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004128capture cookie - X X -
4129capture request header - X X -
4130capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004131clitcpka-cnt X X X -
4132clitcpka-idle X X X -
4133clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004134compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004135cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004136declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004137default-server X - X X
4138default_backend X X X -
4139description - X X X
4140disabled X X X X
4141dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004142email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004143email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004144email-alert mailers X X X X
4145email-alert myhostname X X X X
4146email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004147enabled X X X X
4148errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004149errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004150errorloc X X X X
4151errorloc302 X X X X
4152-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
4153errorloc303 X X X X
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02004154error-log-format X X X -
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004155force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004156filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004157fullconn X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004158hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004159http-after-response X (!) X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004160http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004161http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004162http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004163http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02004164http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02004165http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004166http-check set-var X - X X
4167http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004168http-error X X X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004169http-request X (!) X X X
4170http-response X (!) X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004171http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02004172http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004173id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004174ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004175load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004176log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004177log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02004178log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004179log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004180max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004181maxconn X X X -
4182mode X X X X
4183monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004184monitor-uri X X X -
4185option abortonclose (*) X - X X
4186option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
4187option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
4188option allbackups (*) X - X X
4189option checkcache (*) X - X X
4190option clitcpka (*) X X X -
4191option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02004192option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004193option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
4194option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004195-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
4196option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02004197option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
4198option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02004199option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02004200option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004201option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004202option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02004203option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Christopher Faulet18c13d32022-05-16 11:43:10 +02004204option http-restrict-req-hdr-names X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004205option http-server-close (*) X X X X
4206option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
4207option httpchk X - X X
4208option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01004209option httplog X X X -
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02004210option httpslog X X X -
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004211option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004212option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09004213option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004214option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
4215option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
4216option logasap (*) X X X -
4217option mysql-check X - X X
4218option nolinger (*) X X X X
4219option originalto X X X X
4220option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02004221option pgsql-check X - X X
4222option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004223option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004224option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004225option smtpchk X - X X
4226option socket-stats (*) X X X -
4227option splice-auto (*) X X X X
4228option splice-request (*) X X X X
4229option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01004230option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004231option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
4232option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
4233-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004234option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004235option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
4236option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
4237option tcpka X X X X
4238option tcplog X X X X
4239option transparent (*) X - X X
William Dauchya9dd9012022-01-05 22:53:24 +01004240option idle-close-on-response (*) X X X -
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09004241external-check command X - X X
4242external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004243persist rdp-cookie X - X X
4244rate-limit sessions X X X -
4245redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004246-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004247retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02004248retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004249server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004250server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02004251server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004252source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004253srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
4254srvtcpka-idle X - X X
4255srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02004256stats admin - X X X
4257stats auth X X X X
4258stats enable X X X X
4259stats hide-version X X X X
4260stats http-request - X X X
4261stats realm X X X X
4262stats refresh X X X X
4263stats scope X X X X
4264stats show-desc X X X X
4265stats show-legends X X X X
4266stats show-node X X X X
4267stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004268-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
4269stick match - - X X
4270stick on - - X X
4271stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02004272stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01004273stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004274tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02004275tcp-check connect X - X X
4276tcp-check expect X - X X
4277tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02004278tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02004279tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02004280tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02004281tcp-check set-var X - X X
4282tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004283tcp-request connection X (!) X X -
4284tcp-request content X (!) X X X
4285tcp-request inspect-delay X (!) X X X
4286tcp-request session X (!) X X -
4287tcp-response content X (!) - X X
4288tcp-response inspect-delay X (!) - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004289timeout check X - X X
4290timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02004291timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004292timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004293timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
4294timeout http-request X X X X
4295timeout queue X - X X
4296timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02004297timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004298timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004299timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004300transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01004301unique-id-format X X X -
4302unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004303use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02004304use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02004305use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004306------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
4307 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004308
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004309
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020043104.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
4311---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004312
4313This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
4314
4315
4316acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
4317 Declare or complete an access list.
4318 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004319 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
4320
4321 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
4322 ones. ACLs defined in a defaults section are not visible from other sections
4323 using it.
4324
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004325 Example:
4326 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
4327 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
4328 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
4329
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004330 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004331
4332
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01004333backlog <conns>
4334 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
4335 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4336 yes | yes | yes | no
4337 Arguments :
4338 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
4339 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004340 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01004341
4342 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
4343 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
4344 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
4345 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
4346 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
4347 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
4348 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
4349 backlog parameter.
4350
4351 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
4352 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
4353 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
4354
4355 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
4356
4357
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004358balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004359balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004360 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
4361 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4362 yes | no | yes | yes
4363 Arguments :
4364 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
4365 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
4366 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
4367 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
4368
4369 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
4370 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
4371 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
4372 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02004373 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08004374 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02004375 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
4376 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
4377 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
4378 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
4379 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
4380 it, so that you don't worry.
4381
4382 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
4383 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
4384 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
4385 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
4386 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
4387 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
4388 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
4389 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004390
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01004391 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
4392 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
4393 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
4394 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
4395 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
4396 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
4397 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02004398 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
4399 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
4400 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01004401
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004402 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004403 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004404 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
4405 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02004406 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004407 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
4408 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
4409 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
4410 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
4411 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02004412 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
4413 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
4414 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
4415 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
4416 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
4417 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004418
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004419 hash Takes a regular sample expression in argument. The expression
4420 is evaluated for each request and hashed according to the
4421 configured hash-type. The result of the hash is divided by
4422 the total weight of the running servers to designate which
4423 server will receive the request. This can be used in place of
4424 "source", "uri", "hdr()", "url_param()", "rdp-cookie" to make
4425 use of a converter, refine the evaluation, or be used to
4426 extract data from local variables for example. When the data
4427 is not available, round robin will apply. This algorithm is
4428 static by default, which means that changing a server's
4429 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
4430 changed using "hash-type".
4431
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004432 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
4433 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
4434 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
4435 address will always reach the same server as long as no
4436 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
4437 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
4438 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
4439 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004440 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004441 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004442 static by default, which means that changing a server's
4443 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004444 changed using "hash-type". See also the "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004445
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01004446 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
4447 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
4448 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
4449 the running servers. The result designates which server will
4450 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
4451 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
4452 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
4453 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
4454 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
4455 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4456 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
4457 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004458
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01004459 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004460 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
4461 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
4462 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
4463 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
4464 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
4465 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
4466 URIs start with a leading "/".
4467
4468 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
4469 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
4470 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
4471 evaluation stops when either is reached.
4472
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02004473 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
4474 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
4475 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004476 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash. See also the
4477 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02004478
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004479 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004480 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
4481
4482 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004483 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
4484 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004485 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
4486 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
4487 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
4488 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004489 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004490 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
4491 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004492
4493 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
4494 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
4495 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
4496 server will receive the request.
4497
4498 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
4499 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
4500 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
4501 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
4502 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004503 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
4504 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004505 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also
4506 the "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004507
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004508 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
4509 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
4510 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
4511 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
4512 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004513
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004514 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004515 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
4516 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
4517 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
4518
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004519 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4520 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004521 but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also the
4522 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004523
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01004524 random
4525 random(<draws>)
4526 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004527 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
4528 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
4529 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
4530 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01004531 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
4532 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
4533 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
4534 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
4535 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
4536 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
4537 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
4538 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
4539 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
4540 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
4541 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
4542 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
4543 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
4544 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
4545 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
4546 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
4547 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
4548 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
4549 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
4550 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004551
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004552 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004553 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004554 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
4555 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +01004556 with the equivalent ACL 'req.rdp_cookie()' function, the name
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004557 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
4558 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
4559 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004560 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004561 used instead.
4562
4563 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
4564 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
4565 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +01004566 a 'req.rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004567
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004568 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4569 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004570 but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also the
4571 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004572
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004573 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004574 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
4575 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004576
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01004577 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
4578 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
4579 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004580
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004581 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05004582 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004583 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
4584 NTLM relies on.
4585
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004586 Examples :
4587 balance roundrobin
4588 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004589 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004590 balance hdr(User-Agent)
4591 balance hdr(host)
4592 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004593 balance hash req.cookie(clientid)
4594 balance hash var(req.client_id)
4595 balance hash req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1),ipmask(24)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004596
4597 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
4598 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
4599
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004600 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004601 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
4602 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
4603 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004604 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004605
4606 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
4607 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
4608 defaults to 16 kB.
4609
4610 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
4611 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
4612
4613 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
4614 Round Robin.
4615
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00004616 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004617 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
4618 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
4619 actually appeared in the first chunk).
4620
4621 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
4622
4623 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004624 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004625 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
4626 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
4627 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004628
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +02004629 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004630
4631
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004632bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
4633bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004634 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
4635 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4636 no | yes | yes | no
4637 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004638 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
4639 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
4640 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
4641 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02004642 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'. Note
4643 that if you bind a frontend to multiple UDP addresses you have
4644 no guarantee about the address which will be used to respond.
4645 This is why "0.0.0.0" addresses and lists of comma-separated
4646 IP addresses have been forbidden to bind QUIC addresses.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004647 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
4648 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
4649 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
4650 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
4651 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
4652 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004653 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004654 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
4655 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004656 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004657 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4658 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004659 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004660 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4661 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004662 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02004663 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01004664 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
4665 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
4666 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02004667 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
4668 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
4669 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
4670 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
Amaury Denoyelle936c1352022-11-14 17:14:41 +01004671 - 'quic4@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 and protocol UDP
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01004672 is used. Note that to achieve the best performance with a
4673 large traffic you should keep "tune.quic.conn-owner" on
4674 connection. Else QUIC connections will be multiplexed
4675 over the listener socket. Another alternative would be to
4676 duplicate QUIC listener instances over several threads,
4677 for example using "shards" keyword to at least reduce
4678 thread contention.
Amaury Denoyelle936c1352022-11-14 17:14:41 +01004679 - 'quic6@' -> address is resolved as IPv6 and protocol UDP
Amaury Denoyelle7078fb12022-11-22 11:26:16 +01004680 is used. The performance note for QUIC over IPv4 applies
4681 as well.
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02004682
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004683 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4684 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
4685 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004686
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004687 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
4688 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004689 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
4690 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
4691 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004692 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
4693 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
4694 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
4695 the range.
4696
4697 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
4698 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
4699 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
4700 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
4701 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
4702 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
4703 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004704 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004705 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004706
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004707 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004708 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004709 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
4710 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
4711 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
4712 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
4713 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
4714 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
4715
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004716 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
4717 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
4718 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
4719 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004720
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004721 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
4722 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
4723 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
4724 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
4725 in a frontend.
4726
4727 Example :
4728 listen http_proxy
4729 bind :80,:443
4730 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004731 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004732
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004733 listen http_https_proxy
4734 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02004735 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004736
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004737 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
4738 bind ipv6@:80
4739 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
4740 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
4741
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004742 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004743 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004744
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02004745 listen h3_quic_proxy
Amaury Denoyelle936c1352022-11-14 17:14:41 +01004746 bind quic4@10.0.0.1:8888 ssl crt /etc/mycrt alpn h3
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02004747
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02004748 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
4749 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
4750 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
4751 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
4752 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
4753
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004754 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004755 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004756
4757
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004758capture cookie <name> len <length>
4759 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4760 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4761 no | yes | yes | no
4762 Arguments :
4763 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4764 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4765 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4766 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004767 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004768
4769 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4770 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4771 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4772 right if it exceeds <length>.
4773
4774 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4775 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4776 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4777 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4778
4779 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4780 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4781 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4782
4783 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4784 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4785 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004786 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4787 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4788 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004789
4790 Example:
4791 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4792
4793 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004794 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004795
4796
4797capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004798 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4800 no | yes | yes | no
4801 Arguments :
4802 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004803 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004804 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4805 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4806 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4807
4808 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4809 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4810 it exceeds <length>.
4811
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004812 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004813 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4814 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004815 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4816 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4817 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4818 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004819 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004820 environments to find where the request came from.
4821
4822 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4823 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4824 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4825 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004826
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004827 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4828 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4829 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4830 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4831 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004832
4833 Example:
4834 capture request header Host len 15
4835 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004836 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004837
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004838 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004839 about logging.
4840
4841
4842capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004843 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4845 no | yes | yes | no
4846 Arguments :
4847 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004848 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004849 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4850 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4851 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4852
4853 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4854 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4855 it exceeds <length>.
4856
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004857 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004858 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4859 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4860 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004861 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4862 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4863 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4864 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004865
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004866 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4867 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4868 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4869 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4870 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004871
4872 Example:
4873 capture response header Content-length len 9
4874 capture response header Location len 15
4875
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004876 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004877 about logging.
4878
4879
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004880clitcpka-cnt <count>
4881 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4882 the connection on the client side.
4883 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4884 yes | yes | yes | no
4885 Arguments :
4886 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4887
4888 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4889 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004890 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4891 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004892
4893 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4894
4895
4896clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4897 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4898 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4899 client side.
4900 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4901 yes | yes | yes | no
4902 Arguments :
4903 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4904 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4905 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4906 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4907
4908 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4909 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004910 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4911 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004912
4913 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4914
4915
4916clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4917 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4918 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4919 yes | yes | yes | no
4920 Arguments :
4921 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4922 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4923 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4924 document.
4925
4926 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4927 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004928 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4929 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004930
4931 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4932
4933
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004934compression algo <algorithm> ...
4935compression type <mime type> ...
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004936 Enable HTTP compression.
4937 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4938 yes | yes | yes | yes
4939 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004940 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4941 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004942
4943 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004944 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4945 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4946 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004947
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004948 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004949 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004950
4951 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4952 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4953 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4954 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4955 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004956 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004957
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004958 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4959 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4960 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4961 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4962 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4963 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4964 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004965 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004966
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004967 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004968 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004969 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004970 will be no-op: HAProxy will see the compressed response and will not
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004971 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004972 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, HAProxy will compress the
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004973 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004974
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004975 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004976 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4977 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004978 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004979 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004980 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4981 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4982 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4983 "multipart"
4984 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4985 header
4986 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4987 and later
4988 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4989 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004990 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004991
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004992 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004993
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004994 Examples :
4995 compression algo gzip
4996 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004997
Christopher Faulet44d34bf2021-11-05 12:06:14 +01004998 See also : "compression offload"
4999
5000compression offload
5001 Makes HAProxy work as a compression offloader only.
5002 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5003 no | yes | yes | yes
5004
5005 The "offload" setting makes HAProxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
5006 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
5007 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
5008 will be done on the single point where HAProxy is located. However in some
5009 deployment scenarios, HAProxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
5010 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
5011 In that case HAProxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
5012 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
5013 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
5014 so that prevents HAProxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
5015 then be used for such scenarios.
5016
5017 If this setting is used in a defaults section, a warning is emitted and the
5018 option is ignored.
5019
5020 See also : "compression type", "compression algo"
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005021
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005022cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02005023 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
5024 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01005025 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005026 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
5027 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5028 yes | no | yes | yes
5029 Arguments :
5030 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
5031 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
5032 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
5033 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
5034 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
5035 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005036 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005037 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
5038 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
5039
5040 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005041 server and that HAProxy will have to modify its value to set the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005042 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
5043 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
5044 headers is left to the application. The application can then
5045 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005046 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
5047 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005048 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005049 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
5050 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005051
5052 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005053 be inserted by HAProxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005054
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02005055 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005056 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005057 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005058 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005059 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
5060 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
5061 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
5062 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
5063 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
5064 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
5065 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005066
5067 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
5068 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
5069 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
5070 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
5071 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
5072 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
5073 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
5074 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
5075 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005076 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02005077 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
5078 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
5079 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005080
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02005081 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
5082 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
5083 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005084 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
5085 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
5086 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
5087 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02005088 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
5089 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
5090 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005091
5092 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
5093 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
5094 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
5095 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
5096 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
5097 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
5098 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
5099 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
5100 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
5101
5102 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
5103 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
5104 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
5105 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
5106 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
5107 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
5108 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
5109 persistence cookie in the cache.
5110 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
5111
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005112 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
5113 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005114 case, if a cookie is found in the response, HAProxy will leave it
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005115 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
5116 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005117 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005118 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
5119 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
5120 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
5121 they logout.
5122
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005123 httponly This option tells HAProxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02005124 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
5125 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
5126 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
5127
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005128 secure This option tells HAProxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02005129 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
5130 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
5131 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
5132 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
5133 this attribute.
5134
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02005135 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005136 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01005137 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
5138 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
5139 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
5140 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
5141 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
5142 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02005143
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005144 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
5145 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
5146 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
5147 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
5148 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
5149 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
5150 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
5151 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005152 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005153 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
5154 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
5155 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
5156 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
5157 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
5158 the site.
5159
5160 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
5161 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
5162 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
5163 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
5164 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
5165 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
5166 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
5167 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
5168 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
5169 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
5170 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
5171 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
5172 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005173 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005174 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
5175 redispatch after some absolute delay.
5176
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005177 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
5178 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
5179 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
5180 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
5181 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
5182 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
5183
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005184 attr This option tells HAProxy to add an extra attribute when a
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01005185 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
5186 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
5187 repeated.
5188
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005189 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
5190 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
5191 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
5192 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02005193
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005194 Examples :
5195 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
5196 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5197 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005198 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005199
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02005200 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005201
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005202
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02005203declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
5204 Declares a capture slot.
5205 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5206 no | yes | yes | no
5207 Arguments:
5208 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
5209
5210 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
5211 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
5212 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
5213 for use in the response.
5214
5215 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02005216 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02005217 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
5218
5219
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01005220default-server [param*]
5221 Change default options for a server in a backend
5222 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5223 yes | no | yes | yes
5224 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005225 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
5226 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
5227 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
5228 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01005229
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005230 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01005231 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
5232
5233 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005234
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005235
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005236default_backend <backend>
5237 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
5238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5239 yes | yes | yes | no
5240 Arguments :
5241 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
5242
5243 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
5244 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
5245 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
5246 will catch all undetermined requests.
5247
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005248 Example :
5249
5250 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
5251 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
5252 default_backend dynamic
5253
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02005254 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005255
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005256
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02005257description <string>
5258 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
5259 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5260 no | yes | yes | yes
5261 Arguments : string
5262
5263 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
5264 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
5265 it describes.
5266 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
5267
5268
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005269disabled
5270 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
5271 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5272 yes | yes | yes | yes
5273 Arguments : none
5274
5275 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
5276 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
5277 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
5278 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
5279 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
5280 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
5281 keyword in a "defaults" section.
5282
5283 See also : "enabled"
5284
5285
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005286dispatch <address>:<port>
5287 Set a default server address
5288 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5289 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005290 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005291
5292 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
5293 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5294 during start-up.
5295
5296 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
5297 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
5298 possible with normal servers.
5299
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02005300 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005301 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
5302 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
5303 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
5304 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
5305
5306 See also : "server"
5307
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005308
5309dynamic-cookie-key <string>
5310 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
5311 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5312 yes | no | yes | yes
5313 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
5314
5315 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005316 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005317 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
5318 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005319 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005320 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005321
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005322enabled
5323 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
5324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5325 yes | yes | yes | yes
5326 Arguments : none
5327
5328 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
5329 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
5330
5331 See also : "disabled"
5332
5333
5334errorfile <code> <file>
5335 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5336 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5337 yes | yes | yes | yes
5338 Arguments :
5339 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005340 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005341 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005342
5343 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005344 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005345 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005346 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
5347 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005348
5349 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5350 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5351 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5352
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005353 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5354
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02005355 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
5356 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
5357 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
5358 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
5359 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
5360 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
5361 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
5362 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
5363 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005364
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005365 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5366 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5367 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005368 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005369 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
5370
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005371 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005372
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005373 Example :
5374 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01005375 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005376 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
5377 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
5378
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005379
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005380errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
5381 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
5382 section.
5383 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5384 yes | yes | yes | yes
5385 Arguments :
5386 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
5387
5388 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005389 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005390 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
5391 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005392
5393 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
5394 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
5395 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
5396 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
5397 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005398 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005399 hand using "errorfile" directives.
5400
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005401 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
5402 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005403
5404 Example :
5405 errorfiles generic
5406 errorfiles site-1 403 404
5407
5408
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005409errorloc <code> <url>
5410errorloc302 <code> <url>
5411 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5412 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5413 yes | yes | yes | yes
5414 Arguments :
5415 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005416 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005417 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005418
5419 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
5420 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
5421 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
5422 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005423 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005424
5425 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5426 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5427 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5428
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005429 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5430
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005431 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
5432 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
5433 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
5434 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01005435 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005436 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
5437 request.
5438
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005439 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005440
5441
5442errorloc303 <code> <url>
5443 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5444 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5445 yes | yes | yes | yes
5446 Arguments :
5447 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005448 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005449 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005450
5451 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
5452 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
5453 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
5454 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005455 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005456
5457 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5458 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5459 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5460
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005461 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5462
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005463 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
5464 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
5465 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
5466 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005467 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005468
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005469 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005470
5471
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005472email-alert from <emailaddr>
5473 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005474 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005475 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5476 yes | yes | yes | yes
5477
5478 Arguments :
5479
5480 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
5481
5482 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5483 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5484
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005485 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02005486 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
5487 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005488
5489
5490email-alert level <level>
5491 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
5492 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
5493 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5494 yes | yes | yes | yes
5495
5496 Arguments :
5497
5498 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
5499 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5500 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
5501
5502 By default level is alert
5503
5504 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5505 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5506 for the proxy.
5507
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09005508 Alerts are sent when :
5509
5510 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
5511 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
5512 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
5513 is notice or lower
5514 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
5515 and a health check status update occurs
5516
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005517 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
5518 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005519 section 3.6 about mailers.
5520
5521
5522email-alert mailers <mailersect>
5523 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
5524 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5525 yes | yes | yes | yes
5526
5527 Arguments :
5528
5529 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
5530
5531 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
5532 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5533
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005534 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
5535 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005536
5537
5538email-alert myhostname <hostname>
5539 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
5540 mailers.
5541 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5542 yes | yes | yes | yes
5543
5544 Arguments :
5545
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01005546 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005547
5548 By default the systems hostname is used.
5549
5550 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5551 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5552 for the proxy.
5553
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005554 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
5555 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005556
5557
5558email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005559 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005560 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
5561 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5562 yes | yes | yes | yes
5563
5564 Arguments :
5565
5566 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
5567
5568 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5569 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5570
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005571 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005572 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
5573
5574
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02005575error-log-format <string>
5576 Specifies the log format string to use in case of connection error on the frontend side.
5577 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5578 yes | yes | yes | no
5579
5580 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for logs
5581 containing information related to errors, timeouts, retries redispatches or
5582 HTTP status code 5xx. This format will in short be used for every log line
5583 that would be concerned by the "log-separate-errors" option, including
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +01005584 connection errors described in section 8.2.5.
5585
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02005586 If the directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will
5587 use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5588 string in depth.
5589
5590 "error-log-format" directive overrides previous "error-log-format"
5591 directives.
5592
5593
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005594force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5595 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
5596 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005597 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005598
5599 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
5600 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
5601 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
5602 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
5603 marked down for maintenance operations.
5604
5605 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5606 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
5607 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
5608 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
5609 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
5610 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
5611 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
5612 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
5613 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
5614
5615 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5616 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
5617 is used.
5618
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005619 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02005620 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005621
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005622
5623filter <name> [param*]
5624 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
5625 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5626 no | yes | yes | yes
5627 Arguments :
5628 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
5629 referenced in section 9.
5630
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005631 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005632 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005633 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
5634 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005635
5636 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
5637 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
5638
5639 Example:
5640 listen
5641 bind *:80
5642
5643 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
5644 filter compression
5645 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
5646
5647 compression algo gzip
5648 compression offload
5649
5650 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5651
5652 See also : section 9.
5653
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005654
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005655fullconn <conns>
5656 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
5657 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5658 yes | no | yes | yes
5659 Arguments :
5660 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
5661 servers use the maximal number of connections.
5662
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005663 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005664 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005665 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005666 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
5667 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
5668 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
5669 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
5670 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005671 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005672
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005673 Since it's hard to get this value right, HAProxy automatically sets it to
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005674 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01005675 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
5676 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
5677 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005678
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005679 Example :
5680 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
5681 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
5682 # connections.
5683 backend dynamic
5684 fullconn 10000
5685 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5686 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5687
5688 See also : "maxconn", "server"
5689
5690
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005691hash-balance-factor <factor>
5692 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
5693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5694 yes | no | no | yes
5695 Arguments :
5696 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
5697 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01005698 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005699
5700 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
5701 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
5702 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
5703 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
5704 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
5705 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
5706 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
5707
5708 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
5709 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
5710 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
5711 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
5712 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
5713
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005714 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
5715 consistent hashing mechanism.
5716
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005717 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5718
5719
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005720hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005721 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5722 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5723 yes | no | yes | yes
5724 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005725 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5726 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005727
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005728 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5729 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5730 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5731 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5732 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5733 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5734 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5735 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5736 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5737 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005738
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005739 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5740 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5741 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5742 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5743 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5744 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5745 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5746 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5747 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5748 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5749 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5750 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5751 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005752 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5753 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005754
5755 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5756
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005757 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005758 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5759 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5760 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005761 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5762 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5763 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005764
5765 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5766 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005767 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5768 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5769 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5770 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5771
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005772 wt6 this function was designed for HAProxy while testing other
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005773 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5774 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5775 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5776 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5777 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5778 parameter.
5779
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005780 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5781 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5782 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5783 used on strings.
5784
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005785 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5786
5787 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5788 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5789 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5790 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5791 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5792 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5793 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5794 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5795 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5796 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5797 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5798 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005799
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005800 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5801 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5802 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005803
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005804 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005805
5806
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005807http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5808 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5809 ones).
5810
5811 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02005812 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005813
5814 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5815 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5816 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5817 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5818 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5819 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5820
5821 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5822 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5823 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5824
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005825 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
5826 supported:
5827 - add-header <name> <fmt>
5828 - allow
Christopher Fauletba8f0632021-12-06 08:43:22 +01005829 - capture <sample> id <id>
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01005830 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005831 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01005832 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005833 - replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5834 - replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01005835 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
5836 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
5837 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
5838 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5839 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005840 - set-header <name> <fmt>
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01005841 - set-log-level <level>
5842 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005843 - set-status <status> [reason <str>]
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01005844 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
5845 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005846 - strict-mode { on | off }
5847 - unset-var(<var-name>)
5848
5849 The supported actions are described below.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005850
5851 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5852 instance.
5853
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02005854 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
5855 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
5856 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
5857 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
5858 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
5859 a defaults section defining such rules.
5860
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005861 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5862 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5863 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5864
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005865 Example:
5866 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5867 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5868 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5869
5870http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5871
5872 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005873 value is defined by <fmt>. Please refer to "http-request add-header" for a
5874 complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005875
Christopher Fauletd9d36b82023-01-05 10:25:30 +01005876http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5877
5878 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5879 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
5880
Christopher Fauletba8f0632021-12-06 08:43:22 +01005881http-after-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5882
5883 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5884 converts it to a string. Please refer to "http-response capture" for a
5885 complete description.
5886
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01005887http-after-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5888
5889 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
5890 del-acl" for a complete description.
5891
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005892http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005893
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005894 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. Please
5895 refer to "http-request del-header" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005896
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01005897http-after-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5898
5899 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
5900 del-map" for a complete description.
5901
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005902http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5903 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5904
5905 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5906
5907 Example:
5908 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5909
5910 # applied to:
5911 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5912
5913 # outputs:
5914 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5915
5916 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5917
5918http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5919 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5920
5921 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5922
5923 Example:
5924 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5925
5926 # applied to:
5927 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5928
5929 # outputs:
5930 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5931
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01005932http-after-response sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5933http-after-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5934http-after-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5935
5936 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
5937 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
5938 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
5939 description.
5940
5941http-after-response sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5942 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5943http-after-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5944 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5945
5946 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
5947 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
5948 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
5949
5950http-after-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5951
5952 This is used to change the log level of the current response. Please refer to
5953 "http-request set-log-level" for a complete description.
5954
5955http-after-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5956
5957 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
5958 set-map" for a complete description.
5959
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005960http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5961
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005962 This does the same as "http-after-response add-header" except that the header
5963 name is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
5964 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
5965 external users.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005966
5967http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5968 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5969
5970 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +05005971 between 100 and 999. Please refer to "http-response set-status" for a complete
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005972 description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005973
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01005974http-after-response set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5975http-after-response set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02005976
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005977 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5978 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
5979 for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005980
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005981http-after-response strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005982
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005983 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following
5984 rules. Please refer to "http-request strict-mode" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005985
5986http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5987
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005988 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-request set-var" for details
5989 about <var-name>.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005990
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005991
5992http-check comment <string>
5993 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5994 it fails.
5995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5996 yes | no | yes | yes
5997
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005998 Arguments :
5999 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
6000 rule fails.
6001
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006002 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
6003 user-friendly error reporting.
6004
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006005 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006006 "http-check expect".
6007
6008
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006009http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
6010 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02006011 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006012 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
6013 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6014 yes | no | yes | yes
6015
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006016 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006017 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
6018
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006019 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006020 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006021
6022 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
6023 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
6024 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
6025 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
6026
6027 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
6028
6029 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
6030
6031 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
6032
6033 ssl opens a ciphered connection
6034
6035 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
6036
6037 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
6038 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
6039 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
6040 is used.
6041
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02006042 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
6043 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
6044 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
6045 haproxy -vv.
6046
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006047 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
6048
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006049 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
6050 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
6051 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
6052 different ports or with different servers.
6053
6054 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
6055 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
6056 the port with a "http-check connect".
6057
6058 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
6059 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
6060 do.
6061
6062 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
6063 unset-var or comment rules.
6064
6065 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006066 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
6067 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
6068 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
6069 option httpchk
6070
6071 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02006072 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006073 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006074 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02006075 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006076 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006077
6078 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
6079
6080 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006081
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006082
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006083http-check disable-on-404
6084 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
6085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006086 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006087 Arguments : none
6088
6089 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
6090 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
6091 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
6092 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
6093 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
6094 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
6095 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
6096 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006097 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
6098 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01006099 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
6100 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
6101 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006102
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006103 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006104
6105
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006106http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006107 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
6108 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
6109 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006110 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006111 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02006112 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006113
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006114 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006115 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
6116
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006117 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
6118 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
6119 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
6120 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
6121 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
6122 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
6123 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
6124 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
6125 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
6126 result is always conclusive.
6127
6128 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
6129 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
6130 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006131 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
6132 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01006133 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
6134 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006135 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
6136 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
6137 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006138
6139 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
6140 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01006141 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
6142 supported :
6143 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
6144 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006145 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
6146 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
6147 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
6148 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
6149 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006150
6151 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
6152 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006153 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
6154 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
6155 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
6156 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006157 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
6158
6159 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
6160 informational message reported in logs if the expect
6161 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
6162 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
6163
6164 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
6165 informational message reported in logs if an error
6166 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
6167 log-format string.
6168
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006169 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02006170 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
6171 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006172 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
6173 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
6174 details on the supported keywords.
6175
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006176 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
6177 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
6178 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
6179 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006180
6181 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
6182 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
6183 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
6184 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
6185 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
6186
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006187 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
6188 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
6189 codes. A health check response will be considered as
6190 valid if the response's status code matches any status
6191 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
6192 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
6193 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006194
6195 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006196 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006197 response's status code matches the expression. If the
6198 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
6199 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
6200 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
6201
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02006202 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
6203 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006204 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
6205 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
6206 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
6207 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
6208 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
6209 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
6210 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
6211 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02006212 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
6213 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
6214 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
6215 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
6216 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
6217 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
6218 insensitive on the header names.
6219
6220 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
6221 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
6222 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
6223 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
6224 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
6225 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006226
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006227 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006228 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006229 response's body contains this exact string. If the
6230 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
6231 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
6232 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
6233 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006234 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006235 trace).
6236
6237 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006238 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006239 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
6240 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
6241 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
6242 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
6243 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006244 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006245
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02006246 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
6247 A health check response will be considered valid if the
6248 response's body contains the string resulting of the
6249 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
6250 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
6251 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
6252
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006253 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01006254 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006255 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
6256 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
6257 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
6258 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
6259 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
6260 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
6261
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006262 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
6263 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
6264 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
6265 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
6266 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01006267
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006268 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
6269 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
6270
6271 Examples :
6272 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006273 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006274
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006275 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
6276 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
6277
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006278 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01006279 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006280
6281 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01006282 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006283
6284 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006285 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006286
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006287 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006288 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006289
6290
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02006291http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02006292 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
6293 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006294 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
6295 health checks.
6296 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6297 yes | no | yes | yes
6298 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006299 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
6300
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006301 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
6302 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
6303 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
6304 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
6305 to invent non-standard ones.
6306
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02006307 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
6308 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
6309 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
6310 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6311
6312 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
6313 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
6314 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6315 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006316
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02006317 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006318 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006319 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006320 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
6321 to add it.
6322
6323 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
6324 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
6325 to the log-format rules.
6326
6327 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
6328 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
6329 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006330
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02006331 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
6332 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
6333 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
6334 request.
6335
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006336 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
6337 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
6338 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02006339 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
6340 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
6341 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
6342 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01006343 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006344
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006345 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01006346 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
6347 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02006348
6349 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
6350 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
6351 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
6352 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
6353 configured request authority.
6354
6355 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
6356 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006357
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006358 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006359
6360
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006361http-check send-state
6362 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
6363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6364 yes | no | yes | yes
6365 Arguments : none
6366
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006367 When this option is set, HAProxy will systematically send a special header
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006368 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006369 how they are seen by HAProxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
6370 manipulated without access to HAProxy and the operator needs to know whether
6371 HAProxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006372
6373 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
6374 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
6375 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
6376 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
6377 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08006378 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
6379 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
6380 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
6381
6382 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
6383 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
6384 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
6385
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006386 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
6387 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
6388 checked in multiple backends.
6389
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006390 - a variable "node" containing the name of the HAProxy node, as set in the
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006391 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
6392
6393 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
6394 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
6395 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
6396 one fails.
6397
6398 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
6399 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
6400 connections on all servers of the same backend.
6401
6402 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
6403 server's queue.
6404
6405 Example of a header received by the application server :
6406 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
6407 scur=13/22; qcur=0
6408
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006409 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
6410 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006411
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006412
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006413http-check set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
6414http-check set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006415 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006416 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6417 yes | no | yes | yes
6418
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006419 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006420 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6421 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
6422 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
6423 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
6424 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
6425 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6426 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
6427 and '-'.
6428
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006429 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
6430 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +05006431 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006432 conditions.
6433
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006434 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
6435
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006436 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
6437 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
6438
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006439 Examples :
6440 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006441 http-check set-var-fmt(check.port) "name=%H"
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006442
6443
6444http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006445 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006446 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6447 yes | no | yes | yes
6448
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006449 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006450 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6451 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
6452 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
6453 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
6454 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
6455 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6456 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
6457 and '-'.
6458
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006459 Examples :
6460 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006461
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006462
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006463http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
6464 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6465 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6466 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6467 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
6468 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6469 yes | yes | yes | yes
6470 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006471 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006472 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006473 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006474 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006475
6476 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
6477 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
6478 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
6479 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
6480
6481 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
6482 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
6483 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
6484 a frontend, the default error message is used.
6485
6486 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
6487 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
6488 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
6489 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
6490 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
6491 chroot is performed.
6492
6493 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
6494 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
6495 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
6496 considered.
6497
6498 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
6499 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
6500 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
6501 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
6502 considered as a raw string.
6503
6504 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
6505 The content-type must always be set as argument to
6506 "content-type".
6507
6508 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
6509 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
6510 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
6511 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
6512 evaluated as a log-format string.
6513
6514 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
6515 payload. The content-type must always be set as
6516 argument to "content-type".
6517
6518 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
6519 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
6520 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
6521 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
6522
6523 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
6524 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
6525 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
6526 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
6527 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
6528 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
6529 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
6530 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
6531
6532 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
6533 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
6534 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
6535
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01006536 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
6537 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
6538 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
6539 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
6540 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
6541
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006542 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
6543 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
6544
6545
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006546http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006547 Access control for Layer 7 requests
6548
6549 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02006550 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006551
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006552 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6553 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6554 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6555 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6556 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006557
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006558 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
6559 supported:
6560 - add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6561 - add-header <name> <fmt>
6562 - allow
6563 - auth [realm <realm>]
6564 - cache-use <name>
6565 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6566 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6567 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
6568 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6569 - deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
6570 - disable-l7-retry
6571 - do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
6572 - early-hint <name> <fmt>
6573 - normalize-uri <normalizer>
6574 - redirect <rule>
6575 - reject
6576 - replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6577 - replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6578 - replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6579 - replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6580 - replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6581 - return [status <code>] [content-type <type>] ...
6582 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
6583 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
6584 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
6585 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6586 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02006587 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit <expr>] [period <expr>]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006588 - set-dst <expr>
6589 - set-dst-port <expr>
6590 - set-header <name> <fmt>
6591 - set-log-level <level>
6592 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6593 - set-mark <mark>
6594 - set-method <fmt>
6595 - set-nice <nice>
6596 - set-path <fmt>
6597 - set-pathq <fmt>
6598 - set-priority-class <expr>
6599 - set-priority-offset <expr>
6600 - set-query <fmt>
6601 - set-src <expr>
6602 - set-src-port <expr>
6603 - set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
6604 - set-tos <tos>
6605 - set-uri <fmt>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006606 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
6607 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006608 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01006609 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006610 - strict-mode { on | off }
6611 - tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
6612 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
6613 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
6614 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
6615 - unset-var(<var-name>)
6616 - use-service <service-name>
6617 - wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
6618 - wait-for-handshake
6619 - cache-use <name>
6620
6621 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006622
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006623 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006624
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02006625 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
6626 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
6627 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
6628 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
6629 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
6630 a defaults section defining such rules.
6631
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006632 Example:
6633 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
6634 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
6635 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006636
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006637 http-request allow if nagios
6638 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
6639 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
6640 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01006641
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006642 Example:
6643 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
6644 acl add path /addacl
6645 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006646
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006647 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006648
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006649 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
6650 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006651
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006652 Example:
6653 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
6654 acl setmap path /setmap
6655 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006656
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006657 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006658
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006659 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
6660 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006661
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006662 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6663 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006664
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006665http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006666
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006667 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6668 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6669 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6670 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6671 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
6672 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6673 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6674 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006675
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006676http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006677
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006678 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
6679 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
6680 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
6681 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
6682 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
6683 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
6684 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
6685 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006686
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006687http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006688
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006689 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +01006690 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006691
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006692http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006693
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006694 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
6695 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
6696 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
6697 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
6698 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006699
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02006700 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
6701 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
6702 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
6703 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
6704 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
6705 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
6706 instead.
6707
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006708 Example:
6709 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
6710 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006711
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006712http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006713
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006714 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006715
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006716http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6717 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006718
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006719 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
6720 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
6721 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
6722 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
6723 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
6724 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
6725 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
6726 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
6727 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006728
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006729 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
6730 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
6731 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006732 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
6733
6734 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6735 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6736 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6737 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006738
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006739http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006740
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006741 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6742 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6743 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6744 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6745 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6746 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006747
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006748http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006749
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006750 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6751 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6752 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6753 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6754 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006755
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006756http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006757
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006758 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6759 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6760 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6761 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6762 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6763 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006764
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006765http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6766http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6767 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6768 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6769 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6770 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006771
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006772 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
6773 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6774 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006775 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006776 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6777 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6778 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006779 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006780 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006781
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02006782http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6783 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
6784 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
6785 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
6786
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006787http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
6788 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006789
6790 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
6791 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
6792 pointed by <resolvers>.
6793 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
6794 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
6795 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
6796 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
6797 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
6798 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
6799 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
6800 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
6801 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
6802 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
William Lallemand1ef24602022-08-26 16:38:43 +02006803 to 0.0.0.0. The do-resolve action takes an host-only parameter, any port must
6804 be removed from the string.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006805
6806 Example:
6807 resolvers mydns
6808 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
6809 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
6810 timeout retry 1s
6811 hold valid 10s
6812 hold nx 3s
6813 hold other 3s
6814 hold obsolete 0s
6815 accepted_payload_size 8192
6816
6817 frontend fe
6818 bind 10.42.0.1:80
William Lallemandb5c2cd42022-08-26 16:48:07 +02006819 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),host_only
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006820 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
6821
6822 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
6823 # which mean DNS resolution error
6824 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
6825
6826 default_backend be
6827
6828 backend b_503
6829 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6830 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6831 # 503 error page to end users
6832
6833 backend be
6834 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6835 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6836 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6837 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6838 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6839
6840 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6841 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6842
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006843http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6844
6845 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6846 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6847 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6848 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006849 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6850 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006851
6852 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6853
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006854http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006855http-request normalize-uri fragment-encode [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006856http-request normalize-uri fragment-strip [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006857http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006858http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006859http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006860http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006861http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6862http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006863
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006864 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6865
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006866 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
Amaury Denoyellea9e639a2021-05-06 15:50:12 +02006867 technical preview. As such, it requires the global directive
6868 'expose-experimental-directives' first to be able to invoke it. You should be
6869 prepared that the behavior of normalizers might change to fix possible
6870 issues, possibly breaking proper request processing in your infrastructure.
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006871
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006872 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6873 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6874 the supported backend.
6875
6876 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6877 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6878 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6879 number of segments in the path.
6880
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006881 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
6882 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
6883 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
6884 when improperly combined.
6885
6886 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
6887 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
6888 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
6889 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
6890 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
6891
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006892 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006893
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006894 - fragment-encode: Encodes "#" as "%23".
6895
6896 The "fragment-strip" normalizer should be preferred, unless it is known
6897 that broken clients do not correctly encode '#' within the path component.
6898
6899 Example:
6900 - /#foo -> /%23foo
6901
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006902 - fragment-strip: Removes the URI's "fragment" component.
6903
6904 According to RFC 3986#3.5 the "fragment" component of an URI should not
6905 be sent, but handled by the User Agent after retrieving a resource.
6906
6907 This normalizer should be applied first to ensure that the fragment is
6908 not interpreted as part of the request's path component.
6909
6910 Example:
6911 - /#foo -> /
6912
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006913 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
6914 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006915
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006916 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6917 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
6918
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02006919 Example:
6920 - /. -> /
6921 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
6922 - /a/./a -> /a/a
6923 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006924
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006925 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
6926 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
6927
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006928 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006929 their preceding segment.
6930
6931 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
6932 normalizer first if this is undesired.
6933
6934 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6935 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006936
6937 Example:
6938 - /foo/../ -> /
6939 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6940 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6941 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006942 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006943 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006944 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006945
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006946 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6947 removed as well:
6948
6949 Example:
6950 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6951 - /bar/../../ -> /
6952
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006953 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6954 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006955
6956 Example:
6957 - // -> /
6958 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6959
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006960 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
6961 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
6962
6963 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
6964 ".", "_", and "~".
6965
6966 Example:
6967 - /%61dmin -> /admin
6968 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
6969 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
6970 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
6971
6972 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6973 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6974
6975 Example:
6976 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
6977 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
6978
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006979 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02006980 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02006981
6982 Example:
6983 - /%6f -> /%6F
6984 - /%zz -> /%zz
6985
6986 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6987 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6988
6989 Example:
6990 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
6991
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006992 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02006993 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
6994 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
6995
6996 Example:
6997 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
6998 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
6999 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
7000
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007001http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007002
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007003 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
7004 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
7005 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
7006 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
7007 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007008
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007009http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007010
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007011 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
7012 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
7013 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
7014 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007015
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007016http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7017 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02007018
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007019 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007020 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
7021 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
7022 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
7023 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
7024 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02007025
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007026 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
7027 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
7028 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
7029 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
7030 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007031
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007032 Example:
7033 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
7034
7035 # applied to:
7036 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
7037
7038 # outputs:
7039 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
7040
7041 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007042
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007043 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
7044
7045 # applied to:
7046 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007047
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007048 # outputs:
7049 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007050
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01007051http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7052 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7053
7054 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
7055 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02007056 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
7057 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
7058 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01007059
7060 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
7061 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
7062 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
7063
7064 Example:
7065 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
7066 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
7067
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01007068 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
7069 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
7070 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
7071 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
7072
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02007073http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7074 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7075
7076 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
7077 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
7078 query-string are replaced.
7079
7080 Example:
7081 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
7082 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
7083
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007084http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7085 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7086
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007087 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
7088 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
7089 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
7090 against.
7091
7092 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
7093 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
7094 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007095
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01007096 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
7097 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
7098 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
7099 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
7100 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
7101 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
7102 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
7103 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
7104 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01007105 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
7106 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007107
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01007108 Example:
7109 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
7110 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007111
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01007112 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
7113 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007114
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007115http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7116 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007117
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007118 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
7119 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
7120 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
7121 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007122
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007123 Example:
7124 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007125
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007126 # applied to:
7127 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007128
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007129 # outputs:
7130 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007131
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007132http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7133 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7134 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007135 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007136 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7137
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007138 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007139 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
7140 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007141 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02007142 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007143 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007144 are followed to create the response :
7145
7146 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
7147 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
7148 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
7149 ignored.
7150
7151 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
7152 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007153 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007154 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
7155 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007156
7157 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
7158 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
7159 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007160 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007161 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007162
7163 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
7164 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
7165 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007166 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007167 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02007168 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007169
7170 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
7171 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
7172 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
7173 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
7174 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
7175 as a raw content.
7176
7177 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
7178 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
7179 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
7180 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
7181 considered as a raw string.
7182
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02007183 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007184 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
7185 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
7186 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
7187
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007188 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
7189 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02007190 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007191
7192 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
7193
7194 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007195 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007196 if { path /ping }
7197
7198 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
7199 if { path /favicon.ico }
7200
7201 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
7202 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
7203 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
7204
Willy Tarreau5a72d032023-01-02 18:15:20 +01007205http-request sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7206 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7207
7208 This action increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the
7209 array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> by the value of
7210 either integer <int> or the integer evaluation of expression <expr>. Integers
7211 and expressions are limited to unsigned 32-bit values. If an error occurs,
7212 this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues. <idx> is an
7213 integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer between 0 and 2. It also
7214 silently fails if the there is no GPC stored at this index. The entry in the
7215 table is refreshed even if the value is zero. The 'gpc_rate' is automatically
7216 adjusted to reflect the average growth rate of the gpc value.
7217
7218 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
7219 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
7220 There is no equivalent function for legacy data types, but if the value is
7221 always 1, please see 'sc-inc-gpc()', 'sc-inc-gpc0()' and 'sc-inc-gpc1()'.
7222 There is no way to decrement the value either, but it is possible to store
7223 exact values in a General Purpose Tag using 'sc-set-gpt()' instead.
7224
7225 The main use of this action is to count scores or total volumes (e.g.
7226 estimated danger per source IP reported by the server or a WAF, total
7227 uploaded bytes, etc).
7228
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02007229http-request sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7230
7231 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
7232 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
7233 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
7234 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
7235 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPC stored
7236 at this index.
7237 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
7238 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
7239
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007240http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7241http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007242
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007243 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
7244 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
7245 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007246
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02007247http-request sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7248 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7249 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the array
7250 associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the value of
7251 <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
7252 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
7253 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
7254 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPT stored
7255 at this index.
7256 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
7257 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
7258
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007259http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7260 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007261
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007262 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7263 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7264 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7265 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007266
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007267http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7268 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7269
7270 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7271 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7272 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7273 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7274 agent name must be used.
7275
7276 Arguments:
7277 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
7278
7279 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7280 configuration.
7281
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02007282http-request set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit <expr>] [period <expr>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7283
7284 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
7285 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Custom
7286 limit and period may be defined, if and only if <name> references a
7287 per-stream bandwidth limitation filter. When a set-bandwidth-limit rule is
7288 executed, it first resets all settings of the filter to their defaults prior
7289 to enabling it. As a consequence, if several "set-bandwidth-limit" actions
7290 are executed for the same filter, only the last one is considered. Several
7291 bandwidth limitation filters can be enabled on the same stream.
7292
7293 Note that this action cannot be used in a defaults section because bandwidth
7294 limitation filters cannot be defined in defaults sections. In addition, only
7295 the HTTP payload transfer is limited. The HTTP headers are not considered.
7296
7297 Arguments:
7298 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7299 by some converters. The result is converted to an integer. It is
7300 interpreted as a size in bytes for the "limit" parameter and as a
7301 duration in milliseconds for the "period" parameter.
7302
7303 Example:
7304 http-request set-bandwidth-limit global-limit
7305 http-request set-bandwidth-limit my-limit limit 1m period 10s
7306
7307 See section 9.7 about bandwidth limitation filter setup.
7308
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007309http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007310
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007311 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
7312 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
7313 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
7314 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
7315 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007316
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007317 Arguments:
7318 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7319 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007320
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007321 Example:
7322 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
7323 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007324
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007325 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
7326 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007327
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007328http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007329
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007330 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
7331 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
7332 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007333
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007334 Arguments:
7335 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7336 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007337
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007338 Example:
7339 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
7340 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007341
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007342 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
7343 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
7344 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007345
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007346http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007347
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007348 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
7349 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
7350 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
7351 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
7352 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007353
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007354 Example:
7355 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
7356 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
7357 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
7358 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
7359 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
7360 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
7361 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
7362 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
7363 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007364
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007365http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007366
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007367 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7368 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7369 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7370 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
7371 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007372
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007373http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7374 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007375
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007376 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7377 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7378 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7379 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7380 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
7381 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
7382 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
7383 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
7384 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007385
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007386http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007387
David Carlierf7f53af2021-06-26 12:04:36 +01007388 This is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK on all packets sent to the client
7389 to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7390 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter/ipfw and by the
7391 routing table or monitoring the packets through DTrace. It can be expressed
7392 both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x").
7393 This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route (for
7394 example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
David Carlierbae4cb22021-07-03 10:15:15 +01007395 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges, as well on FreeBSD
7396 and OpenBSD.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02007397
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007398http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007399
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007400 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
7401 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
7402 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007403
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007404http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007405
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007406 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
7407 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
7408 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
7409 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
7410 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
7411 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7412 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7413 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007414
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007415http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02007416
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007417 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
7418 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
7419 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
7420 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
7421 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
7422 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007423
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007424 Example :
7425 # prepend the host name before the path
7426 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007427
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02007428http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7429
7430 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
7431 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
7432 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
7433
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007434http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02007435
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007436 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
7437 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
7438 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
7439 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
7440 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007441
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007442http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007443
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007444 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
7445 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
7446 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
7447 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
7448 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
7449 values have higher priority.
7450 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
7451 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
7452 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
7453 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
7454 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007455
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007456http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007457
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007458 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
7459 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
7460 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
7461 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
7462 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
7463 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
7464 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007465
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007466 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007467
7468 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007469 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
7470 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007471
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007472http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7473 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
7474 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
7475 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007476 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
7477 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007478
7479 Arguments :
7480 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7481 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007482
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007483 See also "option forwardfor".
7484
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007485 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007486 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
7487 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
7488
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007489 # After the masking this will track connections
7490 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
7491 http-request track-sc0 src
7492
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007493 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
7494 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
7495
7496http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7497
7498 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
7499 expression.
7500
7501 Arguments:
7502 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7503 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007504
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007505 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007506 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
7507 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
7508
7509 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
7510 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
7511 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
7512
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02007513http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01007514 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7515
7516 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
7517 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
7518 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
7519 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
7520 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
7521
7522 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
7523 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
7524 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
7525 results.
7526
7527 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02007528 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
7529 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01007530
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007531http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7532
7533 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7534 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
7535 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
7536 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
7537 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
7538 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
7539 information from the request.
7540
7541 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7542
7543http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7544
7545 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
7546 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
Christopher Faulet84cdbe42022-11-22 15:41:48 +01007547 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to perform
7548 complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the path and
7549 the query string. If an absolute URI is set, it will be sent as is to
7550 HTTP/1.1 servers. If it is not the desired behavior, the host, the path
7551 and/or the query string should be set separately.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007552 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
7553
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007554http-request set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7555http-request set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007556
7557 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7558 inline.
7559
7560 Arguments:
7561 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7562 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7563 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7564 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7565 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7566 (request and response)
7567 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7568 processing
7569 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7570 processing
7571 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7572 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
7573 and '_'.
7574
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007575 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
7576 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +05007577 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007578 conditions.
7579
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007580 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7581 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007582
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02007583 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
7584 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
7585
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007586 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007587 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02007588 http-request set-var-fmt(txn.from) %[src]:%[src_port]
7589
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01007590http-request silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007591
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01007592 This stops the evaluation of the rules and removes the client-facing
7593 connection in a configurable way: When called without the rst-ttl argument,
7594 we try to prevent sending any FIN or RST packet back to the client by
7595 using TCP_REPAIR. If this fails (mainly because of missing privileges),
7596 we fall back to sending a RST packet with a TTL of 1.
7597
7598 The effect is that the client still sees an established connection while
7599 there is none on HAProxy, saving resources. However, stateful equipment
7600 placed between the HAProxy and the client (firewalls, proxies,
7601 load balancers) will also keep the established connection in their
7602 session tables.
7603
7604 The optional rst-ttl changes this behaviour: TCP_REPAIR is not used,
7605 and a RST packet with a configurable TTL is sent. When set to a
7606 reasonable value, the RST packet travels through your own equipment,
7607 deleting the connection in your middle-boxes, but does not arrive at
7608 the client. Future packets from the client will then be dropped
7609 already by your middle-boxes. These "local RST"s protect your resources,
7610 but not the client's. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007611
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007612http-request strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007613
7614 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7615 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7616 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7617 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7618 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007619 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007620 processing.
7621
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007622 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007623 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
7624 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
7625 rules evaluation.
7626
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007627http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7628http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7629 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7630 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7631 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7632 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007633
7634 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
7635 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
7636 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007637 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
7638 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
7639 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
7640 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
7641 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
7642 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007643 things worse by forcing HAProxy and the front firewall to support insane
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007644 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
7645 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
7646 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007647 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007648 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
7649 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
7650 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
7651 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
7652 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007653
7654http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7655http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7656http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7657
7658 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
7659 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +01007660 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set by the
7661 global "tune.stick-counters" setting, which defaults to MAX_SESS_STKCTR if
7662 set at build time (it is reported in haproxy -vv) and which defaults to 3,
7663 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (tune.stick-counters-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007664 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
7665 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
7666 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
7667 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
7668 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
7669 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
7670 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
7671
7672 Arguments :
7673 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
7674 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
7675 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
7676 select which table entry to update the counters.
7677
7678 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
7679 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
7680 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
7681 that table until the session ends.
7682
7683 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
7684 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
7685 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
7686 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
7687 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
7688 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
7689 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
7690 useful information.
7691
7692 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
7693 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
7694 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
7695 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
7696 checks that make use of it.
7697
7698http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7699
7700 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007701
7702 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007703 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007704
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01007705http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7706
7707 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
7708 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
7709 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
7710 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
7711 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
7712 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
7713
7714 Arguments :
7715 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
7716
7717 Example:
7718 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
7719
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007720http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7721 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7722
7723 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
7724 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7725 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7726 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7727 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
7728 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
7729 http-buffer-request".
7730
7731 Arguments :
7732
7733 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7734 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7735
7736 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007737 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007738 bytes.
7739
7740 Example:
7741 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
7742
7743 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7744
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007745http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007746
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007747 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
7748 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
7749 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007750
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01007751
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007752http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007753 Access control for Layer 7 responses
7754
7755 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02007756 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007757
7758 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
7759 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
7760 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
7761 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
7762 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
7763 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
7764
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007765 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
7766 supported:
7767 - add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7768 - add-header <name> <fmt>
7769 - allow
7770 - cache-store <name>
7771 - capture <sample> id <id>
7772 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7773 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
7774 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7775 - deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
7776 - redirect <rule>
7777 - replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7778 - replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7779 - return [status <code>] [content-type <type>] ...
7780 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
7781 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
7782 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
7783 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7784 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7785 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02007786 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit <expr>] [period <expr>]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007787 - set-header <name> <fmt>
7788 - set-log-level <level>
7789 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7790 - set-mark <mark>
7791 - set-nice <nice>
7792 - set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7793 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007794 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
7795 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +01007796 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007797 - strict-mode { on | off }
7798 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
7799 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
7800 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
7801 - unset-var(<var-name>)
7802 - wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7803
7804 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007805
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007806 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007807
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02007808 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
7809 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
7810 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
7811 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
7812 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
7813 a defaults section defining such rules.
7814
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007815 Example:
7816 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02007817
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007818 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007819
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007820 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
7821 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007822
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007823 Example:
7824 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007825
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007826 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007827
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007828 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
7829 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007830
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007831 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7832 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007833
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007834http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007835
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007836 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
7837 add-acl" for a complete description.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007838
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007839http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007840
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007841 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007842 value is defined by <fmt>. Please refer to "http-request add-header" for a
7843 complete description.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007844
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007845http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007846
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007847 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
7848 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007849
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02007850http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007851
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007852 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007853
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007854http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007855
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007856 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
7857 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
7858 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
7859 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
7860 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
7861 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
7862 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007863
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007864 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
7865 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
7866 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
7867 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
7868 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007869
7870 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7871 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7872 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7873 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007874
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007875http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007876
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007877 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
7878 del-acl" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007879
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007880http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007881
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007882 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. Please
7883 refer to "http-request del-header" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007884
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007885http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007886
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007887 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
7888 del-map" for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007889
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007890http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7891http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7892 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7893 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7894 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7895 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007896
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007897 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
7898 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7899 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007900 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007901 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
7902 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
7903 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01007904 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007905 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007906
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007907http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007908
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007909 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
7910 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
7911 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
7912 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
7913 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
7914 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007915
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007916http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7917 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007918
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007919 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
7920 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007921
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007922 Example:
7923 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02007924
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007925 # applied to:
7926 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007927
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007928 # outputs:
7929 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007930
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007931 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007932
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007933http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7934 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007935
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01007936 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007937 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007938
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007939 Example:
7940 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007941
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007942 # applied to:
7943 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007944
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007945 # outputs:
7946 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007947
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007948http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7949 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7950 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007951 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007952 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7953
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007954 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a
7955 response. Please refer to "http-request return" for a complete
7956 description. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007957
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02007958http-response sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007959http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7960http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08007961
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007962 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
7963 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
7964 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
7965 description.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007966
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02007967http-response sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007968 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007969http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7970 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007971
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007972 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
7973 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
7974 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007975
Christopher Faulet24e7f352021-08-12 09:32:07 +02007976http-response send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7977 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007978
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007979 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
7980 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007981
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02007982http-response set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit <expr>] [period <expr>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7983
7984 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
7985 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Please
7986 refer to "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" for a complete description.
7987
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007988http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007989
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007990 This does the same as "http-response add-header" except that the header name
7991 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
7992 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
7993 external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007994
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007995http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7996
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007997 This is used to change the log level of the current response. Please refer to
7998 "http-request set-log-level" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007999
8000http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
8001
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008002 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
8003 set-map" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008004
8005http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8006
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008007 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
8008 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
8009 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008010
8011http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8012
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008013 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
8014 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008015
8016http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
8017 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8018
8019 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
8020 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
8021 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
8022 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008023
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008024 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008025 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
8026 http-response set-status 431
8027 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
8028 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008029
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008030http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008031
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008032 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008033 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
8034 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008035
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01008036http-response set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8037http-response set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008038
8039 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008040 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
8041 for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008042
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01008043http-response silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008044
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008045 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
8046 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008047 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
8048 complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008049
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008050http-response strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01008051
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008052 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following
8053 rules. Please refer to "http-request strict-mode" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01008054
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008055http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8056http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8057http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008058
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008059 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
8060 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
8061 track-sc2" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008062
8063http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8064
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008065 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-request set-var" for details
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008066 about <var-name>.
8067
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008068http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
8069 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8070
8071 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008072 most <time> milliseconds. Please refer to "http-request wait-for-body" for a
8073 complete description.
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008074
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02008075
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008076http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
8077 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
8078
8079 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8080 yes | no | yes | yes
8081
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008082 By default, a connection established between HAProxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01008083 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
8084 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
8085 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008086
8087 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
8088
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01008089 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
8090 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
8091 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
8092 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
8093 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
8094 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
8095 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008096 such an application could be an old HAProxy using cookie
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01008097 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
8098 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008099
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01008100 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
8101 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
8102 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
8103 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
8104 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
8105 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
8106 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02008107 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
8108 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
8109 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
8110 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
8111 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
8112 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008113
8114 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
8115 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
8116 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
8117 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
8118 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
8119 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
8120 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
8121 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02008122 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008123 downsides of rare connection failures.
8124
8125 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
8126 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
8127 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
8128 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
8129 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
8130 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008131 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008132 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
8133 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
8134 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
8135 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
8136 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
8137
8138 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01008139 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
8140 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
8141 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
8142 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008143
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01008144 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
8145 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008146
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01008147 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008148
8149 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
8150 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
8151 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
8152
Willy Tarreau44fce8b2022-11-25 09:17:18 +01008153 The rules to decide to keep an idle connection opened or to close it after
8154 processing are also governed by the "tune.pool-low-fd-ratio" (default: 20%)
8155 and "tune.pool-high-fd-ratio" (default: 25%). These correspond to the
8156 percentage of total file descriptors spent in idle connections above which
8157 haproxy will respectively refrain from keeping a connection opened after a
8158 response, and actively kill idle connections. Some setups using a very high
8159 ratio of idle connections, either because of too low a global "maxconn", or
8160 due to a lot of HTTP/2 or HTTP/3 traffic on the frontend (few connections)
8161 but HTTP/1 connections on the backend, may observe a lower reuse rate because
8162 too few connections are kept open. It may be desirable in this case to adjust
8163 such thresholds or simply to increase the global "maxconn" value.
8164
8165 Similarly, when thread groups are explicitly enabled, it is important to
8166 understand that idle connections are only usable between threads from a same
8167 group. As such it may happen that unfair load between groups leads to more
8168 idle connections being needed, causing a lower reuse rate. The same solution
8169 may then be applied (increase global "maxconn" or increase pool ratios).
8170
8171 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn", "thread-groups",
8172 "tune.pool-high-fd-ratio", "tune.pool-low-fd-ratio"
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008173
8174
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008175http-send-name-header [<header>]
8176 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008177 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8178 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008179 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008180 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
8181
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02008182 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
8183 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
8184 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
8185 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
8186 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
8187 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
8188 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
8189 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
8190 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
8191 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
8192 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
8193 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
8194 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
8195 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
8196 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
8197 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008198
8199 See also : "server"
8200
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01008201id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02008202 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
8203 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8204 no | yes | yes | yes
8205 Arguments : none
8206
8207 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
8208 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
8209 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01008210
8211
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008212ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
8213 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
8214 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01008215 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008216
8217 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
8218 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
8219 and running).
8220
8221 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
8222 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
8223 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008224 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008225 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
8226
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008227 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
8228 "unless" condition is met.
8229
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03008230 Example:
8231 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
8232 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
8233 ignore-persist if url_static
8234
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008235 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
8236
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008237load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
8238 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
8239 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8240 yes | no | yes | yes
8241
8242 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
8243 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
8244 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008245 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008246 to tell HAProxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008247 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
8248 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
8249 over the stats socket and redirect output.
8250
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008251 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008252 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02008253 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008254
8255 Arguments:
8256 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
8257 named "server-state-file".
8258
8259 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
8260 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
8261 name is used as a file name.
8262
8263 none don't load any stat for this backend
8264
8265 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01008266 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
8267 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
8268 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008269 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01008270 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008271
8272 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
8273 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
8274
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008275 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008276
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008277 global
8278 stats socket /tmp/socket
8279 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008280
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008281 defaults
8282 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008283
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008284 backend bk
8285 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
8286 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008287
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008288
8289 Then one can run :
8290
8291 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
8292
8293 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
8294
8295 1
8296 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
8297 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8298 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8299
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008300 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008301
8302 global
8303 stats socket /tmp/socket
8304 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
8305
8306 defaults
8307 load-server-state-from-file local
8308
8309 backend bk
8310 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
8311 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
8312
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008313
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008314 Then one can run :
8315
8316 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
8317
8318 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
8319
8320 1
8321 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
8322 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8323 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8324
8325 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
8326 "show servers state"
8327
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008328
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008329log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01008330log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02008331 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02008332no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008333 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
8334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8335 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02008336
8337 Prefix :
8338 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
8339 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
8340 prefix does not allow arguments.
8341
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008342 Arguments :
8343 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
8344 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
8345 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
8346 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
8347 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
8348 parameter.
8349
8350 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
8351 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
8352
8353 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
8354 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
8355 standard syslog port).
8356
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01008357 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
8358 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
8359 standard syslog port).
8360
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008361 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
8362 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
8363 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008364 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008365
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008366 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
8367 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
8368 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
8369 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
8370 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
8371 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
8372 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
8373 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
8374 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
8375 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
8376 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
8377 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008378 significantly slow HAProxy down as non-blocking calls will be
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008379 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
8380 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
8381 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008382 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
8383 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008384
8385 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
8386 and "fd@2", see above.
8387
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02008388 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
8389 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
8390 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
8391 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
8392 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
8393 having the logs instantly available.
8394
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02008395 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
8396 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
8397 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
8398
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008399 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8400 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01008401
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02008402 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
8403 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
8404 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
8405 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
8406 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
8407 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
8408 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
8409 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
8410 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
8411 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008412 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02008413
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02008414 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
8415 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
8416 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
8417 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
8418 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
8419
8420 <sample_size>
8421 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
8422 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
8423 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
8424 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
8425 (see also <ranges> parameter).
8426
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01008427 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
8428 one of the following :
8429
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01008430 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
8431 field is stripped. This is the default.
8432 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
8433 rfc3164.
8434
8435 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01008436 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
8437
8438 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
8439 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
8440
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02008441 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
8442 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
8443 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
8444 designed to be used with a local log server.
8445
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01008446 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
8447 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
8448 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
8449 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
8450 systemd logger consumes.
8451
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02008452 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
8453 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
8454 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
8455 used with a local log server.
8456
8457 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
8458 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
8459 designed to be used with a local log server.
8460
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008461 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
8462 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
8463 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
8464 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
8465
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008466 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
8467
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01008468 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
8469 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
8470 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
8471
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008472 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
8473 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
8474 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
8475 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008476
8477 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
8478 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
8479 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02008480 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
8481 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
8482 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
8483 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
8484 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008485
8486 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
8487
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02008488 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
8489 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
8490 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008491
8492 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
8493 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
8494 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
8495 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
8496
8497 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
8498 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008499
8500 Example :
8501 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008502 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
8503 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
8504 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02008505 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02008506 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
8507 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008508 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01008509
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008510
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008511log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01008512 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
8513 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8514 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008515
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01008516 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
8517 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
8518 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
8519 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
8520 string in depth.
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02008521 A specific log-format used only in case of connection error can also be
8522 defined, see the "error-log-format" option.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008523
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02008524 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format",
8525 "option httplog" and "option httpslog" directives.
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008526
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02008527log-format-sd <string>
8528 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
8529 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8530 yes | yes | yes | no
8531
8532 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
8533 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
8534 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
8535 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
8536 which covers the log format string in depth.
8537
8538 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
8539 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
8540
8541 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
8542 log format to "rfc5424".
8543
8544 Example :
8545 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
8546
8547
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01008548log-tag <string>
8549 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
8550 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8551 yes | yes | yes | yes
8552
8553 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
8554 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008555 from the command line, which usually is "HAProxy". Sometimes it can be useful
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01008556 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
8557 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
8558 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
8559 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
8560 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
8561 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008562
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008563max-keep-alive-queue <value>
8564 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
8565 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8566 yes | no | yes | yes
8567
8568 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
8569 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
8570 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
8571 servers.
8572
8573 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008574 connections at which HAProxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008575 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
8576 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
8577 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008578 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008579 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
8580 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
8581 picking a different server.
8582
8583 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
8584 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
8585 even if they have to be queued.
8586
8587 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
8588 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
8589
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01008590max-session-srv-conns <nb>
8591 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
8592 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
8593 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008594
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008595maxconn <conns>
8596 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
8597 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8598 yes | yes | yes | no
8599 Arguments :
8600 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
8601 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
8602 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
8603 closes.
8604
8605 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008606 very high so that HAProxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008607 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
8608 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01008609 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
8610 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
8611 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
8612 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008613
8614 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
8615 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
8616 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
8617
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01008618 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
8619 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02008620
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008621 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
8622
8623
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02008624mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008625 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
8626 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8627 yes | yes | yes | yes
8628 Arguments :
8629 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
8630 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
8631 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
8632 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
8633
8634 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
8635 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
8636 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
8637 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
8638 brings HAProxy most of its value.
8639
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008640 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
8641 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
8642 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008643
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008644 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008645 defaults http_instances
8646 mode http
8647
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008648
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008649monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008650 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008651 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8652 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008653 Arguments :
8654 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
8655 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008656 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008657 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
8658 backend and its backup.
8659
8660 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
8661 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
8662 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
8663 servers in a list of backends.
8664
8665 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
8666 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
8667 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008668 conditions above is met, HAProxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008669 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
8670 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008671 HAProxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02008672 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
8673 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008674
8675 Example:
8676 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008677 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008678 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8679 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8680 monitor-uri /site_alive
8681 monitor fail if site_dead
8682
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008683 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008684
8685
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008686monitor-uri <uri>
8687 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
8688 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8689 yes | yes | yes | no
8690 Arguments :
8691 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
8692 health status instead of forwarding the request.
8693
8694 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
8695 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
8696 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
8697 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
8698 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
8699 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
8700 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
8701 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
8702
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01008703 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008704 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
8705 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
Willy Tarreau7fe0c622022-11-25 10:24:44 +01008706 purpose. Only one URI may be configured for monitoring; when multiple
8707 "monitor-uri" statements are present, the last one will define the URI to
8708 be used. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008709 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
8710 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
8711 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008712
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01008713 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
8714 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
8715 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
8716 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
8717
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008718 Example :
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008719 # Use /haproxy_test to report HAProxy's status
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008720 frontend www
8721 mode http
8722 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
8723
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008724 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008725
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008726
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008727option abortonclose
8728no option abortonclose
8729 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
8730 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8731 yes | no | yes | yes
8732 Arguments : none
8733
8734 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
8735 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
8736 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
8737 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008738 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008739 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
8740 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
8741 encountered while delivering the response.
8742
8743 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
8744 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
8745 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
8746 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
8747 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
8748 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008749 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008750 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008751 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008752 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
8753 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
8754 still not served and not pollute the servers.
8755
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008756 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
8757 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008758 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
8759 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
8760 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
8761 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
8762 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
8763 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008764 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008765
8766 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8767 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8768
8769 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
8770
8771
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008772option accept-invalid-http-request
8773no option accept-invalid-http-request
8774 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
8775 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8776 yes | yes | yes | no
8777 Arguments : none
8778
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008779 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008780 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008781 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008782 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8783 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8784 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8785 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8786 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008787 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
8788 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
8789 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
8790 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008791 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008792 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02008793 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
Willy Tarreau1ba30162022-05-24 15:34:26 +02008794 to pass through (no version specified), as well as different protocol names
8795 (e.g. RTSP), and multiple digits for both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008796
8797 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8798 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8799 been confirmed.
8800
8801 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8802 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008803 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
8804 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008805 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8806
8807 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8808 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8809
8810 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
8811 stats socket.
8812
8813
8814option accept-invalid-http-response
8815no option accept-invalid-http-response
8816 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
8817 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8818 yes | no | yes | yes
8819 Arguments : none
8820
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008821 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008822 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008823 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008824 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8825 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8826 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8827 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8828 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008829 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
8830 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
8831 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008832
8833 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8834 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8835 been confirmed.
8836
8837 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8838 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
8839 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
8840 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8841
8842 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8843 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8844
8845 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
8846 stats socket.
8847
8848
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008849option allbackups
8850no option allbackups
8851 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
8852 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8853 yes | no | yes | yes
8854 Arguments : none
8855
8856 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
8857 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
8858 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
8859 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
8860 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
8861 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
8862 order between the backup servers anymore.
8863
8864 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
8865 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
8866
8867 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8868 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8869
8870
8871option checkcache
8872no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08008873 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008874 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8875 yes | no | yes | yes
8876 Arguments : none
8877
8878 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
8879 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008880 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008881 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
8882 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008883 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008884
8885 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008886 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008887 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008888 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8889 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008890 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008891 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008892 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
8893 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008894 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01008895 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
8896 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008897 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008898 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8899 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8900 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8901 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
8902 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
8903 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
8904 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
8905 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
8906 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
8907
8908 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008909 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
8910 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
8911 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
8912 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008913
8914 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8915 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008916 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008917 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008918
8919 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8920 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8921
8922
8923option clitcpka
8924no option clitcpka
8925 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8926 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8927 yes | yes | yes | no
8928 Arguments : none
8929
8930 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8931 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008932 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008933 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8934
8935 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8936 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8937 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8938 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8939
8940 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8941 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8942 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8943 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8944 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8945
8946 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8947
8948 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8949 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8950 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8951
8952 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8953 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8954
8955 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8956
8957
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008958option contstats
8959 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
8960 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8961 yes | yes | yes | no
8962 Arguments : none
8963
8964 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
8965 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
8966 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008967 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from HAProxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01008968 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
8969 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
8970 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
8971 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
8972 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008973
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008974option disable-h2-upgrade
8975no option disable-h2-upgrade
8976 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
8977 connection.
8978 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8979 yes | yes | yes | no
8980 Arguments : none
8981
8982 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
8983 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
8984 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
8985 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01008986 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
8987 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
8988 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
8989 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
8990 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
8991 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008992
8993 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8994 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008995
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008996option dontlog-normal
8997no option dontlog-normal
8998 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
8999 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9000 yes | yes | yes | no
9001 Arguments : none
9002
9003 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
9004 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
9005 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
9006 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
9007 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
9008 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
9009 logged.
9010
9011 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
9012 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
9013 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
9014
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009015 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009016 logging.
9017
9018
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009019option dontlognull
9020no option dontlognull
9021 Enable or disable logging of null connections
9022 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9023 yes | yes | yes | no
9024 Arguments : none
9025
9026 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
9027 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
9028 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
9029 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
9030 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
9031 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009032 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
9033 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
9034 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009035
9036 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009037 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009038 would not be logged.
9039
9040 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9041 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9042
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02009043 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009044 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009045
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009046
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009047option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009048 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
9049 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9050 yes | yes | yes | yes
9051 Arguments :
9052 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9053 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009054 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009055 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009056
9057 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
9058 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
9059 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
9060 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
9061 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
9062 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
9063 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009064 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
9065 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9066 possible that the client has already brought one.
9067
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009068 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009069 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009070 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009071 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009072 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009073 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009074
9075 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9076 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9077 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
9078 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
9079 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
9080 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01009081 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009082
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009083 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
9084 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009085 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching HAProxy
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009086 are under the control of the end-user.
9087
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009088 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009089 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9090 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009091 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
9092 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
9093 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009094
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02009095 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009096 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
9097 frontend www
9098 mode http
9099 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
9100
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009101 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
9102 backend www
9103 mode http
9104 option forwardfor header X-Client
9105
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009106 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009107 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009108
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009109
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02009110option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
9111no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
9112 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
9113 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9114 yes | yes | yes | no
9115 Arguments : none
9116
9117 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
9118 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
9119 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
9120 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
9121 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
9122 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
9123 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
9124
9125 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
9126 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
9127 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
9128 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
9129 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
9130 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
9131 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
9132 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
9133 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
9134 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
9135
9136 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
9137
9138 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9139 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9140
9141 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
9142 "h1-case-adjust-file".
9143
9144
9145option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
9146no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
9147 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
9148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9149 yes | no | yes | yes
9150 Arguments : none
9151
9152 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
9153 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
9154 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
9155 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
9156 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
9157 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
9158 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
9159
9160 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
9161 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
9162 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
9163 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
9164 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
9165 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
9166 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
9167 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
9168 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
9169 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
9170
9171 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
9172
9173 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9174 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9175
9176 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
9177 "h1-case-adjust-file".
9178
9179
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009180option http-buffer-request
9181no option http-buffer-request
9182 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
9183 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9184 yes | yes | yes | yes
9185 Arguments : none
9186
9187 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
9188 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
9189 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
9190 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
9191 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
9192 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01009193 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
9194 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
9195 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
9196 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009197
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02009198 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
9199 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009200
9201
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009202option http-ignore-probes
9203no option http-ignore-probes
9204 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
9205 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9206 yes | yes | yes | no
9207 Arguments : none
9208
9209 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
9210 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
9211 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
9212 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
9213 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
9214 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
9215 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
9216 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
9217 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009218 was received over a connection before it was closed;
9219 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009220 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
9221
9222 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
9223 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
9224 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
9225 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
9226 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
9227 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
9228 are often the only way to detect them.
9229
9230 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9231 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9232
9233 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
9234
9235
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009236option http-keep-alive
9237no option http-keep-alive
9238 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
9239 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9240 yes | yes | yes | yes
9241 Arguments : none
9242
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009243 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
9244 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009245 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
9246 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009247 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
9248 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
9249 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009250
9251 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
9252 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009253 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
9254 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
9255 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
9256 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
9257 situations where this option may be useful :
9258
9259 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009260 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009261
9262 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
9263 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
9264
9265 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
9266 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
9267 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
9268 request.
9269
9270 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
9271 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009272 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
9273 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
9274 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009275
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009276 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
9277 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
9278 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
9279 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
9280 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
9281 not set.
9282
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009283 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
9284 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
9285 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009286
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009287 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009288 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01009289 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009290
9291
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02009292option http-no-delay
9293no option http-no-delay
9294 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
9295 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9296 yes | yes | yes | yes
9297 Arguments : none
9298
9299 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
9300 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
9301 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
9302 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
9303 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
9304 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
9305 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009306 HAProxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02009307 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
9308 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
9309 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
9310 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
9311 affected.
9312
9313 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
9314 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
9315 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
9316 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
9317 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
9318 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
9319 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
9320 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
9321 latency environments.
9322
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009323 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
9324
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02009325
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009326option http-pretend-keepalive
9327no option http-pretend-keepalive
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009328 Define whether HAProxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009329 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02009330 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009331 Arguments : none
9332
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009333 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", HAProxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009334 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
9335 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
9336 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009337 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents HAProxy from
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009338 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
9339 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
9340 consider the response complete.
9341
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009342 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", HAProxy will make the server
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009343 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009344 to the abnormal undesired above. When HAProxy gets the whole response, it
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009345 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009346 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009347 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
9348
9349 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
9350 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
9351 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
9352 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009353 worth noting that when this option is enabled, HAProxy will have slightly
9354 less work to do. So if HAProxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009355 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
9356
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02009357 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
9358 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
9359 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
9360 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
9361 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
9362 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009363
9364 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9365 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9366
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009367 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009368 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009369
Christopher Faulet18c13d32022-05-16 11:43:10 +02009370option http-restrict-req-hdr-names { preserve | delete | reject }
9371 Set HAProxy policy about HTTP request header names containing characters
9372 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset
9373 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9374 yes | yes | yes | yes
9375 Arguments :
9376 preserve disable the filtering. It is the default mode for HTTP proxies
9377 with no FastCGI application configured.
9378
9379 delete remove request headers with a name containing a character
9380 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset. It is the default mode for
9381 HTTP backends with a configured FastCGI application.
9382
9383 reject reject the request with a 403-Forbidden response if it contains a
9384 header name with a character outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset.
9385
9386 This option may be used to restrict the request header names to alphanumeric
9387 and hyphen characters ([A-Za-z0-9-]). This may be mandatory to interoperate
9388 with non-HTTP compliant servers that fail to handle some characters in header
9389 names. It may also be mandatory for FastCGI applications because all
9390 non-alphanumeric characters in header names are replaced by an underscore
9391 ('_'). Thus, it is easily possible to mix up header names and bypass some
9392 rules. For instance, "X-Forwarded-For" and "X_Forwarded-For" headers are both
9393 converted to "HTTP_X_FORWARDED_FOR" in FastCGI.
9394
9395 Note this option is evaluated per proxy and after the http-request rules
9396 evaluation.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009397
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009398option http-server-close
9399no option http-server-close
9400 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
9401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9402 yes | yes | yes | yes
9403 Arguments : none
9404
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009405 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
9406 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
9407 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
9408 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009409 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
9410 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
9411 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
9412 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
9413 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
9414 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
9415 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
9416 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
9417 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
9418 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
9419 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009420
9421 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
9422 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
9423 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
9424 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009425 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
9426 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009427
9428 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
9429 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009430 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
9431 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
9432 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009433
9434 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9435 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9436
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009437 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
9438 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009439
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009440option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009441no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009442 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
9443 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9444 yes | yes | yes | no
9445 Arguments : none
9446
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00009447 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009448 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
9449 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
9450 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
9451 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
9452 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009453 HAProxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009454
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009455 By setting this option in a frontend, HAProxy can automatically switch to use
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009456 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01009457 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
9458 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
9459 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009460
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01009461 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
9462 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
9463 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
9464 front of an existing proxy.
9465
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009466 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
9467
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009468 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009469
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009470option httpchk
9471option httpchk <uri>
9472option httpchk <method> <uri>
9473option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009474 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009475 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9476 yes | no | yes | yes
9477 Arguments :
9478 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
9479 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
9480 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
9481 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
9482 ones.
9483
9484 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
9485 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
9486 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
9487
9488 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
9489 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
9490 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02009491 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009492
9493 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
9494 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
9495 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
9496 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
9497 the lack of any response.
9498
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02009499 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
9500 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
9501 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
9502 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
9503
9504 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
9505 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
9506 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009507
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02009508 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
9509 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02009510 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04009511 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02009512 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009513
9514 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009515 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
9516 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
9517 backend https_relay
9518 mode tcp
9519 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
9520 http-check send hdr Host www
9521 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009522
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09009523 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
9524 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
9525 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009526
9527
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009528option httpclose
9529no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009530 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009531 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9532 yes | yes | yes | yes
9533 Arguments : none
9534
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009535 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
9536 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
9537 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
9538 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009539 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009540
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009541 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
9542 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05009543 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009544 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
9545 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009546
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009547 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
9548 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
9549 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009550
9551 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
9552 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009553 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
9554 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
9555 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009556
9557 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9558 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9559
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009560 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009561
9562
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009563option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009564 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
9565 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009566 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009567 Arguments :
9568 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
9569 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
9570 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009571 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009572 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009573
9574 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9575 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9576 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
9577 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
9578 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
9579 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
9580 ports.
9581
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01009582 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
9583 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009584
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009585 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9586
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009587 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009588
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02009589option httpslog
9590 Enable logging of HTTPS request, session state and timers
9591 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9592 yes | yes | yes | no
9593
9594 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9595 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9596 "option httpslog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
9597 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
9598 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
9599 frontend, backend and server name, the SSL certificate verification and SSL
9600 handshake statuses, and of course the source address and ports.
9601
9602 "option httpslog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9603
9604 See also : section 8 about logging.
9605
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009606
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009607option independent-streams
9608no option independent-streams
9609 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009610 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9611 yes | yes | yes | yes
9612 Arguments : none
9613
9614 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
9615 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
9616 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
9617 receive data or not.
9618
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009619 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009620 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
9621 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
9622 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
9623 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
9624 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
9625 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
9626 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
9627 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
9628 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
9629 socket buffers.
9630
9631 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
9632 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
9633 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
9634 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
9635 slow lines, so use it with caution.
9636
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009637 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009638
9639
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02009640option ldap-check
9641 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
9642 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9643 yes | no | yes | yes
9644 Arguments : none
9645
9646 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
9647 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
9648 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
9649 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
9650
9651 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
9652 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
9653
9654 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
9655 configure it.
9656
9657 Example :
9658 option ldap-check
9659
9660 See also : "option httpchk"
9661
9662
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009663option external-check
9664 Use external processes for server health checks
9665 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9666 yes | no | yes | yes
9667
9668 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
9669 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
9670 command".
9671
9672 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
9673
9674 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
9675
9676
William Dauchya9dd9012022-01-05 22:53:24 +01009677option idle-close-on-response
9678no option idle-close-on-response
9679 Avoid closing idle frontend connections if a soft stop is in progress
9680 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9681 yes | yes | yes | no
9682 Arguments : none
9683
9684 By default, idle connections will be closed during a soft stop. In some
9685 environments, a client talking to the proxy may have prepared some idle
9686 connections in order to send requests later. If there is no proper retry on
9687 write errors, this can result in errors while haproxy is reloading. Even
9688 though a proper implementation should retry on connection/write errors, this
9689 option was introduced to support backwards compatibility with haproxy prior
9690 to version 2.4. Indeed before v2.4, haproxy used to wait for a last request
9691 and response to add a "connection: close" header before closing, thus
9692 notifying the client that the connection would not be reusable.
9693
9694 In a real life example, this behavior was seen in AWS using the ALB in front
9695 of a haproxy. The end result was ALB sending 502 during haproxy reloads.
9696
9697 Users are warned that using this option may increase the number of old
9698 processes if connections remain idle for too long. Adjusting the client
9699 timeouts and/or the "hard-stop-after" parameter accordingly might be
9700 needed in case of frequent reloads.
9701
9702 See also: "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout http-request",
9703 "hard-stop-after"
9704
9705
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009706option log-health-checks
9707no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009708 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9710 yes | no | yes | yes
9711 Arguments : none
9712
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009713 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
9714 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
9715 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009716
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009717 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
9718 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
9719 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
9720 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
9721 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
9722
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009723 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009724 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009725
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009726 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
9727 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
9728 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009729
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009730
9731option log-separate-errors
9732no option log-separate-errors
9733 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
9734 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9735 yes | yes | yes | no
9736 Arguments : none
9737
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009738 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes HAProxy
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009739 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
9740 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
9741 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
9742 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
9743 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
9744 provides very important information.
9745
9746 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
9747 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
9748 error logs.
9749
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009750 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009751 logging.
9752
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009753
9754option logasap
9755no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009756 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009757 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9758 yes | yes | yes | no
9759 Arguments : none
9760
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009761 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
9762 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
9763 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
9764 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
9765
9766 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
9767 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
9768 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
9769 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
9770 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009771 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009772 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
9773 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
9774 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
9775 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009776 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009777
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009778 Examples :
9779 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
9780 mode http
9781 option httplog
9782 option logasap
9783 log 192.168.2.200 local3
9784
9785 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9786 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9787 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
9788 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9789
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009790 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009791 logging.
9792
9793
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009794option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009795 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009796 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9797 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009798 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009799 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
9800 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009801 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
9802 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009803
9804 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
9805 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009806 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009807 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009808 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires an unlocked authorised
9809 user without a password. To create a basic limited user in MySQL with
9810 optional resource limits:
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009811
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009812 CREATE USER '<username>'@'<ip_of_haproxy|network_of_haproxy/netmask>'
9813 /*!50701 WITH MAX_QUERIES_PER_HOUR 1 MAX_UPDATES_PER_HOUR 0 */
9814 /*M!100201 MAX_STATEMENT_TIME 0.0001 */;
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009815
9816 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009817 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009818 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
9819 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
9820 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
9821 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
9822 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
9823 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
9824 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
9825
9826 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
9827 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009828
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02009829 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009830
9831 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
9832 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
9833 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9834 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009835 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009836 server to route the client via the machine hosting HAProxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009837
9838 See also: "option httpchk"
9839
9840
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009841option nolinger
9842no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009843 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009844 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9845 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009846 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009847
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009848 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009849 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
9850 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
9851 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
9852 connections.
9853
9854 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
9855 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009856 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
9857 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
9858 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
9859 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
9860 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
9861 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
9862 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
9863 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
9864 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
9865 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
9866 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
9867 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
9868 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009869
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009870 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
9871 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
9872 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
9873 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
9874 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009875
9876 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
9877 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009878 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05009879 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009880 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009881
9882 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9883 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9884
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009885 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
9886 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009887
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009888option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
9889 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
9890 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9891 yes | yes | yes | yes
9892 Arguments :
9893 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9894 matching <network>
9895 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
9896 header name.
9897
9898 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
9899 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
9900 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
9901 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
9902 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
9903 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
9904 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
9905 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
9906 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9907 possible that the client has already brought one.
9908
9909 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
9910 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
9911 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
9912 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
9913 header and requires different one.
9914
9915 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9916 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9917 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01009918 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
9919 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
9920 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
9921 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
9922 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009923
9924 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
9925 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9926 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
9927 both are defined.
9928
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009929 Examples :
9930 # Original Destination address
9931 frontend www
9932 mode http
9933 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
9934
9935 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
9936 backend www
9937 mode http
9938 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
9939
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009940 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009941
9942
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009943option persist
9944no option persist
9945 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
9946 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9947 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009948 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009949
9950 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
9951 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
9952 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
9953 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
9954 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
9955 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
9956 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
9957 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
9958 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
9959 redirected to another valid server.
9960
9961 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9962 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9963
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01009964 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009965
9966
Christopher Faulet59307b32022-10-03 15:00:59 +02009967option pgsql-check user <username>
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01009968 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
9969 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9970 yes | no | yes | yes
9971 Arguments :
9972 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
9973 PostgreSQL server.
9974
9975 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
9976 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
9977 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
9978 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
9979
9980 See also: "option httpchk"
9981
9982
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009983option prefer-last-server
9984no option prefer-last-server
9985 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
9986 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9987 yes | no | yes | yes
9988 Arguments : none
9989
9990 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009991 request was sent to a server to which HAProxy still holds a connection, it is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009992 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
9993 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009994 we only indicate a preference which HAProxy tries to apply without any form
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009995 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009996 this option is used, HAProxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009997 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
9998 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009999 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010000 HAProxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +020010001 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
10002 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
10003 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +010010004 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
10005 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
10006 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010007
10008 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10009 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10010
10011 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
10012
10013
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010014option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010015option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010016no option redispatch
10017 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
10018 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10019 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010020 Arguments :
10021 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
10022 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
10023 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010024 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010025 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010026 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010027 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
10028 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
10029 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
10030
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010031
10032 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
10033 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
10034 be able to access the service anymore.
10035
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +010010036 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
10037 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010038
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +020010039 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
10040 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
10041 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
10042 following order:
10043
10044 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
10045
10046 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
10047 list, or
10048
10049 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
10050
10051 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
10052 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
10053
10054 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
10055 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
10056 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
10057 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
10058
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010059 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010060 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
10061 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010062
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010063 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10064 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10065
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020010066 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010067
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010068
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +020010069option redis-check
10070 Use redis health checks for server testing
10071 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10072 yes | no | yes | yes
10073 Arguments : none
10074
10075 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
10076 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
10077 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
10078 find the "+PONG" response message.
10079
10080 Example :
10081 option redis-check
10082
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010083 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +020010084
10085
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010086option smtpchk
10087option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
10088 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
10089 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10090 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010091 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010092 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +020010093 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010094 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
10095
10096 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
10097 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
10098 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
10099
10100 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
10101 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
10102 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
10103 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
10104 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
10105 dead server.
10106
10107 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
10108 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010109 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010110 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
10111
10112 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
10113 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
10114 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
10115 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +020010116 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010117
10118 Example :
10119 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
10120
10121 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
10122
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010123
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020010124option socket-stats
10125no option socket-stats
10126
10127 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
10128 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10129 yes | yes | yes | no
10130
10131 Arguments : none
10132
10133
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010134option splice-auto
10135no option splice-auto
10136 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
10137 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10138 yes | yes | yes | yes
10139 Arguments : none
10140
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010141 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010142 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010143 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010144 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010145 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010146 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
10147 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
10148 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
10149 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
10150
10151 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
10152 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
10153 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
10154 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
10155 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
10156 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
10157 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
10158 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
10159 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
10160 keyword.
10161
10162 Example :
10163 option splice-auto
10164
10165 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10166 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10167
10168 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
10169 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
10170
10171
10172option splice-request
10173no option splice-request
10174 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
10175 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10176 yes | yes | yes | yes
10177 Arguments : none
10178
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010179 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010180 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010181 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
10182 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
10183 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
10184 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
10185
10186 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
10187
10188 Example :
10189 option splice-request
10190
10191 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10192 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10193
10194 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
10195 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
10196
10197
10198option splice-response
10199no option splice-response
10200 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
10201 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10202 yes | yes | yes | yes
10203 Arguments : none
10204
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010205 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010206 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010207 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
10208 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
10209 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
10210 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
10211
10212 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
10213
10214 Example :
10215 option splice-response
10216
10217 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10218 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10219
10220 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
10221 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
10222
10223
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +010010224option spop-check
10225 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
10226 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10227 no | no | no | yes
10228 Arguments : none
10229
10230 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
10231 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
10232 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
10233 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
10234
10235 Example :
10236 option spop-check
10237
10238 See also : "option httpchk"
10239
10240
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010241option srvtcpka
10242no option srvtcpka
10243 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
10244 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10245 yes | no | yes | yes
10246 Arguments : none
10247
10248 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
10249 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010250 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010251 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
10252
10253 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
10254 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
10255 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
10256 operating system and its tuning parameters.
10257
10258 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
10259 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
10260 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
10261 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
10262 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
10263
10264 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
10265
10266 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
10267 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
10268 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
10269
10270 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10271 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10272
10273 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
10274
10275
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010276option ssl-hello-chk
10277 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
10278 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10279 yes | no | yes | yes
10280 Arguments : none
10281
10282 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
10283 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
10284 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
10285 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
10286 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
10287 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
10288 hello message.
10289
10290 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
10291 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
10292 messages, which is appreciable.
10293
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010294 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into HAProxy
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010295 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
10296 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010297
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010298 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
10299
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010300
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010301option tcp-check
10302 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
10303 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10304 yes | no | yes | yes
10305
10306 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
10307 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
10308
10309 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
10310 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
10311 attempt, which remains the default mode.
10312
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010313 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010314 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
10315 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
10316 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
10317 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
10318 only.
10319
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010320 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010321 The connection is opened and HAProxy waits for the server to present some
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010322 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
10323 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
10324 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
10325
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010326 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010327 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
10328 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010329 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010330 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
10331 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
10332 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
10333 the respective protocols.
10334 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010335 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010336
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010337 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010338
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010339 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
10340 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
10341 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
10342 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010343
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010344 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
10345 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
10346 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010347
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010348
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010349 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010350 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010351 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010352 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010353
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010354 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010355 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010356 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010357
10358 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
10359 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010360 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010361 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010362 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010363 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020010364 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010365 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010366 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10367 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010368 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010369 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
10370 tcp-check expect string +OK
10371
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010372 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010373 (send many headers before analyzing)
10374 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010375 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010376 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
10377 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
10378 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
10379 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010380 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010381
10382
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010383 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010384
10385
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +020010386option tcp-smart-accept
10387no option tcp-smart-accept
10388 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
10389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10390 yes | yes | yes | no
10391 Arguments : none
10392
10393 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
10394 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
10395 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
10396 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
10397 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
10398 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
10399
10400 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
10401 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
10402 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
10403 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
10404
10405 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
10406 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
10407 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010408 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +020010409
10410 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
10411 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
10412 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
10413
10414 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
10415 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
10416 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
10417
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +020010418 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
10419
10420
10421option tcp-smart-connect
10422no option tcp-smart-connect
10423 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
10424 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10425 yes | no | yes | yes
10426 Arguments : none
10427
10428 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
10429 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
10430 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
10431 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
10432 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
10433
10434 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
10435 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
10436 complex.
10437
10438 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
10439 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
10440 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
10441
10442 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10443 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10444
10445 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
10446
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +020010447
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010448option tcpka
10449 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
10450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10451 yes | yes | yes | yes
10452 Arguments : none
10453
10454 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
10455 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010456 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010457 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
10458
10459 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
10460 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
10461 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
10462 operating system and its tuning parameters.
10463
10464 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
10465 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
10466 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
10467 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
10468 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
10469
10470 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
10471
10472 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
10473 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
10474 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
10475 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
10476 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
10477 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
10478 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
10479 backends.
10480
10481 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
10482
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010483
10484option tcplog
10485 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
10486 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +010010487 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010488 Arguments : none
10489
10490 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
10491 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
10492 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
10493 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
10494 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
10495 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
10496 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
10497 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
10498
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +020010499 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
10500
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010501 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010502
10503
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010504option transparent
10505no option transparent
10506 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10507 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010508 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010509 Arguments : none
10510
10511 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
10512 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10513 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10514 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10515 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10516 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10517 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10518 appropriate server.
10519
10520 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10521 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10522
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +010010523 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010524 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010525
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010526
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010527external-check command <command>
10528 Executable to run when performing an external-check
10529 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10530 yes | no | yes | yes
10531
10532 Arguments :
10533 <command> is the external command to run
10534
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010535 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
10536
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +010010537 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010538
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +010010539 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
10540 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
10541 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
10542 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
10543 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
10544 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010545
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +010010546 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
10547
10548 Environment variables :
10549 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
10550 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
10551
10552 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
10553
10554 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
10555
10556 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
10557 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
10558 for a UNIX socket).
10559
10560 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
10561
10562 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
10563
10564 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
10565
10566 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
10567
10568 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
10569
10570 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
10571 socket).
10572
Willy Tarreau973cf902022-05-13 15:58:35 +020010573 HAPROXY_SERVER_SSL "0" when SSL is not used, "1" when it is used
10574
10575 HAPROXY_SERVER_PROTO The protocol used by this server, which can be one
10576 of "cli" (the haproxy CLI), "syslog" (syslog TCP
10577 server), "peers" (peers TCP server), "h1" (HTTP/1.x
10578 server), "h2" (HTTP/2 server), or "tcp" (any other
10579 TCP server).
10580
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +010010581 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
10582 the command may be set using "external-check path".
10583
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +020010584 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
10585
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010586 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
10587 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
10588 failed.
10589
10590 Example :
10591 external-check command /bin/true
10592
10593 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
10594
10595
10596external-check path <path>
10597 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
10598 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10599 yes | no | yes | yes
10600
10601 Arguments :
10602 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
10603
10604 The default path is "".
10605
10606 Example :
10607 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
10608
10609 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
10610 "external-check command"
10611
10612
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010613persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +020010614persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010615 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
10616 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10617 yes | no | yes | yes
10618 Arguments :
10619 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020010620 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
10621 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010622
10623 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
10624 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010625 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010626 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
10627 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
10628 forwarded to this server.
10629
10630 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
10631 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
10632 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010633 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010634 a single "listen" section.
10635
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020010636 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
10637 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
10638 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
10639
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010640 Example :
10641 listen tse-farm
10642 bind :3389
10643 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
10644 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10645 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
10646 # apply RDP cookie persistence
10647 persist rdp-cookie
10648 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010649 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010650 balance rdp-cookie
10651 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
10652 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
10653
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010010654 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010655
10656
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010657rate-limit sessions <rate>
10658 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
10659 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10660 yes | yes | yes | no
10661 Arguments :
10662 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
10663 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
10664
10665 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
10666 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
10667 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010668 (in system buffers) and HAProxy will not even be aware that sessions are
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010669 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
10670 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
10671
10672 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
10673 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
10674 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
10675 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
10676
10677 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
10678 listen smtp
10679 mode tcp
10680 bind :25
10681 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +020010682 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010683
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +020010684 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
10685 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
10686 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010687
10688 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
10689
10690
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010691redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10692redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10693redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010694 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
10695 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10696 no | yes | yes | yes
10697
10698 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +010010699 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010700
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010701 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010702 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010703 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
10704 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
10705 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010706
10707 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
10708 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
10709 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
10710 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
10711 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010712 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
10713 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
10714 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
10715 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010716
10717 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
10718 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
10719 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
10720 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
10721 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
10722 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010723 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010724 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010725 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
10726 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
10727 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010728
10729 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010730 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
10731 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
10732 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +020010733 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010734 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
10735 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
10736 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
10737 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010738
10739 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010740 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010741
10742 - "drop-query"
10743 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
10744 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
10745 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
10746 with a location-type redirect.
10747
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010748 - "append-slash"
10749 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
10750 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
10751 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
10752 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
10753
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020010754 - "ignore-empty"
10755 This keyword only has effect when a location is produced using a log
10756 format expression (i.e. when used in http-request or http-response).
10757 It indicates that if the result of the expression is empty, the rule
10758 should silently be skipped. The main use is to allow mass-redirects
10759 of known paths using a simple map.
10760
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010761 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
10762 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
10763 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
10764 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
10765 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
10766 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
10767 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
10768
10769 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
10770 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
10771 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
10772 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
10773 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
10774 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
10775 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010776
10777 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
10778 acl clear dst_port 80
10779 acl secure dst_port 8080
10780 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010781 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010782 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010783 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
10784
10785 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010786 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
10787 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
10788 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010789 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010790
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010791 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
10792 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
10793 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
10794
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010795 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by HAProxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010010796 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010797
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010798 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020010799 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10800 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
10801 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010802
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020010803 Example: permanently redirect only old URLs to new ones
10804 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10805 %[path,map_str(old-blog-articles.map)] ignore-empty
10806
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010807 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010808
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010010809
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010810retries <value>
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010811 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a failure
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010812 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10813 yes | no | yes | yes
10814 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010815 <value> is the number of times a request or connection attempt should be
10816 retried on a server after a failure.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010817
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010818 By default, retries apply only to new connection attempts. However, when
10819 the "retry-on" directive is used, other conditions might trigger a retry
10820 (e.g. empty response, undesired status code), and each of them will count
10821 one attempt, and when the total number attempts reaches the value here, an
10822 error will be returned.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010823
10824 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010825 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010826 a retry occurs on the same server.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010827
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010828 When "option redispatch" is set, some retries may be performed on another
10829 server even if a cookie references a different server. By default this will
10830 only be the last retry unless an argument is passed to "option redispatch".
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010831
10832 See also : "option redispatch"
10833
10834
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010835retry-on [space-delimited list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020010836 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
10837 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
10838 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010839 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10840 yes | no | yes | yes
10841 Arguments :
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010842 <keywords> is a space-delimited list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each
10843 representing a type of failure event on which an attempt to
10844 retry the request is desired. Please read the notes at the
10845 bottom before changing this setting. The following keywords are
10846 supported :
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010847
10848 none never retry
10849
10850 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
10851 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
10852
10853 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
10854 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
10855 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
10856 request timeout on the server side, poor network
10857 condition, or a server crash or restart while
10858 processing the request.
10859
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020010860 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
10861 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
10862 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
10863 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
10864 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
10865 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
10866 overflow attack for example).
10867
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010868 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
10869 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
10870 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
10871 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
10872 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
10873 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
10874 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
10875 amplify denial of service attacks.
10876
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020010877 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
10878 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
10879 considered to be safe to retry.
10880
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010010881 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
10882 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
10883 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
10884 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
10885 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010886
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020010887 all-retryable-errors
10888 retry request for any error that are considered
10889 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
10890 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
10891 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
10892
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010893 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
10894 not cumulative.
10895
10896 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
10897 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
10898 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
10899 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
10900
10901 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
10902 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
10903 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
10904 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
10905 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
10906 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
10907 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
10908 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
10909 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
10910 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
10911 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
10912 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
10913
10914 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
10915 should not use this directive.
10916
10917 The default is "conn-failure".
10918
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010919 Example:
10920 retry-on 503 504
10921
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010922 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
10923
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010924server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010925 Declare a server in a backend
10926 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10927 no | no | yes | yes
10928 Arguments :
10929 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010930 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010931 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010932
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010933 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
10934 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
10935 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
10936 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010937 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
10938 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010939 intercepted and HAProxy must forward to the original destination
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010940 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
10941 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010942 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
10943 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
10944 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
10945 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
10946 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10947 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10948 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010949 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020010950 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
10951 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
10952 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
10953 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
10954 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
10955 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010956 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10957 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010958 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
10959 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010960
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010961 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010962 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
10963 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
10964 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
10965 adding this value to the client's port.
10966
10967 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
10968 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010969 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010970
10971 Examples :
10972 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
10973 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010974 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010975 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
10976 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
10977 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010978
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020010979 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
10980 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
10981 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
10982 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
10983 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
10984
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010985 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
10986 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010987
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010988server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010989 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010990 this backend.
10991 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10992 no | no | yes | yes
10993
10994 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
10995 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
10996 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
10997 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
10998 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010999
11000 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
11001 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
11002
11003 global
11004 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
11005
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010011006 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020011007 load-server-state-from-file
11008
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010011009 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020011010 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011011
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020011012server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
11013 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
11014 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
11015 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11016 no | no | yes | yes
11017
11018 Arguments:
11019 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
11020
11021 <num | range>
11022 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
11023 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
11024 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
11025 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
11026
11027 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
11028
11029 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
11030
11031 <params*>
11032 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
11033 keyword.
11034
11035 Examples:
11036 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
11037 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
11038 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
11039
11040 # or
11041 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
11042
11043 # would be equivalent to:
11044 server srv1 google.com:80 check
11045 server srv2 google.com:80 check
11046 server srv3 google.com:80 check
11047
11048
11049
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011050source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011051source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010011052source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011053 Set the source address for outgoing connections
11054 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11055 yes | no | yes | yes
11056 Arguments :
11057 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
11058 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010011059
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011060 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010011061 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
11062 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
11063 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
11064 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
11065 supported prefixes are :
11066 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
11067 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
11068 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020011069 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020011070 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
11071 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011072
11073 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
11074 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011075 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
11076 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
11077 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011078
11079 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
11080 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
11081 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
11082 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
11083 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
11084 <addr>.
11085
11086 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
11087 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
11088 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
11089 port.
11090
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011091 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
11092 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
11093 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
11094 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010011095 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011096 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
11097 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
11098 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
11099 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
11100 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
11101 HTTP header.
11102
11103 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
11104 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011105 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011106 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
11107 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11108 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
11109 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
11110 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
11111 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
11112 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
11113
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010011114 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
11115 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
11116 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
11117 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
11118 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
11119 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
11120
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011121 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
11122 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
11123 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
11124 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
11125
11126 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
11127 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
11128 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
11129 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
11130 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
11131 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
11132
11133 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
11134 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
11135 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
11136 there are two methods :
11137
11138 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
11139 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
11140 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
11141 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
11142 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
11143 of the client ranges may be used.
11144
11145 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
11146 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
11147 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
11148 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
11149 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
11150 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
11151 same session.
11152
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011153 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
11154 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
11155 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011156 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011157
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020011158 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
11159
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011160 Examples :
11161 backend private
11162 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
11163 source 192.168.1.200
11164
11165 backend transparent_ssl1
11166 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
11167 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
11168
11169 backend transparent_ssl2
11170 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
11171 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
11172 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
11173
11174 backend transparent_ssl3
11175 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
11176 # is more conntrack-friendly.
11177 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
11178
11179 backend transparent_smtp
11180 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
11181 # with Tproxy version 4.
11182 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
11183
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011184 backend transparent_http
11185 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
11186 # proxy.
11187 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
11188
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011189 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011190 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
11191
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011192
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011193srvtcpka-cnt <count>
11194 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
11195 the connection on the server side.
11196 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11197 yes | no | yes | yes
11198 Arguments :
11199 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
11200
11201 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
11202 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020011203 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
11204 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011205
11206 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
11207
11208
11209srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
11210 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
11211 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
11212 server side.
11213 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11214 yes | no | yes | yes
11215 Arguments :
11216 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
11217 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
11218 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
11219 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
11220
11221 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
11222 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020011223 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
11224 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011225
11226 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
11227
11228
11229srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
11230 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
11231 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11232 yes | no | yes | yes
11233 Arguments :
11234 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
11235 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
11236 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
11237 document.
11238
11239 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
11240 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020011241 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
11242 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011243
11244 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
11245
11246
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011247stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
11248 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
11249 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011250 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011251
11252 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
11253 matched.
11254
11255 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
11256 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
11257
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010011258 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
11259 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
11260 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
11261 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011262
11263 Example :
11264 # statistics admin level only for localhost
11265 backend stats_localhost
11266 stats enable
11267 stats admin if LOCALHOST
11268
11269 Example :
11270 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
11271 backend stats_auth
11272 stats enable
11273 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
11274 stats admin if TRUE
11275
11276 Example :
11277 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
11278 userlist stats-auth
11279 group admin users admin
11280 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
11281 group readonly users haproxy
11282 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
11283
11284 backend stats_auth
11285 stats enable
11286 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
11287 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
11288 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
11289 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
11290
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011291 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", section 3.4
11292 about userlists and section 7 about ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011293
11294
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011295stats auth <user>:<passwd>
11296 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
11297 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011298 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011299 Arguments :
11300 <user> is a user name to grant access to
11301
11302 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
11303
11304 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
11305 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
11306 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
11307 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
11308 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
11309 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
11310
11311 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
11312 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
11313 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020011314 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011315
11316 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
11317 report using "stats scope".
11318
11319 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11320 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11321 unobvious parameters.
11322
11323 Example :
11324 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11325 backend public_www
11326 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11327 stats enable
11328 stats hide-version
11329 stats scope .
11330 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011331 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011332 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11333 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11334
11335 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11336 backend private_monitoring
11337 stats enable
11338 stats uri /admin?stats
11339 stats refresh 5s
11340
11341 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
11342
11343
11344stats enable
11345 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
11346 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011347 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011348 Arguments : none
11349
11350 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
11351 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
11352 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
11353 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
11354 - stats auth : no authentication
11355 - stats scope : no restriction
11356
11357 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11358 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11359 unobvious parameters.
11360
11361 Example :
11362 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11363 backend public_www
11364 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11365 stats enable
11366 stats hide-version
11367 stats scope .
11368 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011369 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011370 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11371 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11372
11373 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11374 backend private_monitoring
11375 stats enable
11376 stats uri /admin?stats
11377 stats refresh 5s
11378
11379 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
11380
11381
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011382stats hide-version
11383 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011384 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011385 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011386 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011387
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011388 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
11389 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
11390 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
11391 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
11392 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
11393 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011394
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020011395 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11396 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11397 unobvious parameters.
11398
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011399 Example :
11400 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11401 backend public_www
11402 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020011403 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011404 stats hide-version
11405 stats scope .
11406 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011407 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011408 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11409 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011410
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011411 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11412 backend private_monitoring
11413 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011414 stats uri /admin?stats
11415 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010011416
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011417 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011418
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011419
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020011420stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
11421 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
11422 Access control for statistics
11423
11424 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11425 no | no | yes | yes
11426
11427 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
11428 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
11429 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
11430 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
11431 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
11432 should be asked to enter a username and password.
11433
11434 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
11435 instance.
11436
11437 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
11438 about ACL usage.
11439
11440
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011441stats realm <realm>
11442 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
11443 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011444 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011445 Arguments :
11446 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
11447 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
11448 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
11449
11450 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
11451 using a backslash ('\').
11452
11453 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
11454 only related to authentication.
11455
11456 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11457 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11458 unobvious parameters.
11459
11460 Example :
11461 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11462 backend public_www
11463 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11464 stats enable
11465 stats hide-version
11466 stats scope .
11467 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011468 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011469 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11470 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11471
11472 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11473 backend private_monitoring
11474 stats enable
11475 stats uri /admin?stats
11476 stats refresh 5s
11477
11478 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
11479
11480
11481stats refresh <delay>
11482 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
11483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011484 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011485 Arguments :
11486 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
11487 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
11488 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
11489 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
11490 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
11491 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
11492
11493 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
11494 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
11495 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050011496 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011497
11498 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11499 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11500 unobvious parameters.
11501
11502 Example :
11503 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11504 backend public_www
11505 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11506 stats enable
11507 stats hide-version
11508 stats scope .
11509 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011510 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011511 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11512 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11513
11514 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11515 backend private_monitoring
11516 stats enable
11517 stats uri /admin?stats
11518 stats refresh 5s
11519
11520 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
11521
11522
11523stats scope { <name> | "." }
11524 Enable statistics and limit access scope
11525 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011526 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011527 Arguments :
11528 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
11529 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
11530 section in which the statement appears.
11531
11532 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
11533 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
11534 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
11535 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
11536 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
11537 exists.
11538
11539 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11540 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11541 unobvious parameters.
11542
11543 Example :
11544 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11545 backend public_www
11546 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11547 stats enable
11548 stats hide-version
11549 stats scope .
11550 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011551 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011552 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11553 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11554
11555 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11556 backend private_monitoring
11557 stats enable
11558 stats uri /admin?stats
11559 stats refresh 5s
11560
11561 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
11562
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011563
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011564stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011565 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
11566 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011567 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011568
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011569 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011570 description from global section is automatically used instead.
11571
11572 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
11573 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
11574
11575 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11576 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011577 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011578
11579 Example :
11580 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11581 backend private_monitoring
11582 stats enable
11583 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
11584 stats uri /admin?stats
11585 stats refresh 5s
11586
11587 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
11588 global section.
11589
11590
11591stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011592 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
11593 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11594 yes | yes | yes | yes
11595 Arguments : none
11596
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011597 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011598 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
11599 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
11600 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
11601 - IP (socket, server)
11602 - cookie (backend, server)
11603
11604 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11605 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011606 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011607
11608 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
11609
11610
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020011611stats show-modules
11612 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
11613 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11614 yes | yes | yes | yes
11615 Arguments : none
11616
11617 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
11618 values as a tooltip.
11619
11620 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11621 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11622 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
11623
11624 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
11625
11626
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011627stats show-node [ <name> ]
11628 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
11629 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011630 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011631 Arguments:
11632 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
11633 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
11634
11635 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
11636 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011637 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011638
11639 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11640 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11641 unobvious parameters.
11642
11643 Example:
11644 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11645 backend private_monitoring
11646 stats enable
11647 stats show-node Europe-1
11648 stats uri /admin?stats
11649 stats refresh 5s
11650
11651 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
11652 section.
11653
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011654
11655stats uri <prefix>
11656 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
11657 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011658 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011659 Arguments :
11660 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
11661 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
11662 query string.
11663
11664 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
11665 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
11666 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
11667 possible to reach it in the application.
11668
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011669 The default URI compiled in HAProxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011670 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011671 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
11672 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
11673 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
11674 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
11675
11676 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
11677 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
11678 an address or a port to statistics only.
11679
11680 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11681 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11682 unobvious parameters.
11683
11684 Example :
11685 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11686 backend public_www
11687 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11688 stats enable
11689 stats hide-version
11690 stats scope .
11691 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011692 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011693 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11694 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11695
11696 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11697 backend private_monitoring
11698 stats enable
11699 stats uri /admin?stats
11700 stats refresh 5s
11701
11702 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
11703
11704
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011705stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
11706 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011707 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011708 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011709
11710 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011711 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011712 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011713 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011714 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
11715
11716 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11717 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11718 the "stick-table" statement.
11719
11720 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
11721 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
11722 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
11723 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
11724 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
11725
11726 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11727 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
11728 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
11729 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
11730 transformation rules.
11731
11732 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11733 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11734 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11735 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11736 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11737 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11738 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11739
11740 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
11741 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
11742 ACL based conditions.
11743
11744 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
11745 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
11746 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
11747 matches can be used as fallbacks.
11748
11749 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
11750 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
11751 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
11752 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
11753
11754 Example :
11755 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11756 # last 30 minutes
11757 backend pop
11758 mode tcp
11759 balance roundrobin
11760 stick store-request src
11761 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11762 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11763 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11764
11765 backend smtp
11766 mode tcp
11767 balance roundrobin
11768 stick match src table pop
11769 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11770 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11771
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011772 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and samples
11773 fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011774
11775
11776stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11777 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
11778 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11779 no | no | yes | yes
11780
11781 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
11782 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
11783 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
11784 for writing more maintainable configurations.
11785
11786 Examples :
11787 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010011788 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011789
11790 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
11791 stick match src table pop if !localhost
11792 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
11793
11794
11795 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
11796 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
11797 backend http
11798 mode http
11799 balance roundrobin
11800 stick on src table https
11801 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
11802 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
11803 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
11804
11805 backend https
11806 mode tcp
11807 balance roundrobin
11808 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11809 stick on src
11810 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11811 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11812
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011813 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011814
11815
11816stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11817 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
11818 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11819 no | no | yes | yes
11820
11821 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011822 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011823 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011824 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011825 server is selected.
11826
11827 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11828 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11829 the "stick-table" statement.
11830
11831 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11832 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11833 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
11834 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
11835 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
11836 address.
11837
11838 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11839 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
11840 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
11841 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
11842 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
11843 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
11844 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
11845 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
11846 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
11847 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
11848
11849 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11850 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11851 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11852 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11853 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11854 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11855 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11856
11857 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
11858 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11859 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
11860 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11861
11862 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
11863 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11864 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11865 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11866 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11867 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011868 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
11869 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11870 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11871 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11872 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11873 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011874
11875 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
11876 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
11877 the request.
11878
11879 Example :
11880 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11881 # last 30 minutes
11882 backend pop
11883 mode tcp
11884 balance roundrobin
11885 stick store-request src
11886 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11887 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11888 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11889
11890 backend smtp
11891 mode tcp
11892 balance roundrobin
11893 stick match src table pop
11894 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11895 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11896
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011897 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011898
11899
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011900stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011901 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011902 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080011903 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011904 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011905 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011906
11907 Arguments :
11908 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
11909 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
11910 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11911 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11912
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010011913 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
11914 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
11915 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11916 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11917
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011918 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
11919 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
11920 instance.
11921
11922 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
11923 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
11924 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
11925 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
11926 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
11927 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011928 to 32 characters.
11929
11930 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
11931 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
11932 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011933 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011934 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
11935 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011936
11937 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011938 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
11939 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011940 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
11941 increase.
11942
11943 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011944 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
11945 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
11946 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011947
11948 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011949 is full. When not specified and the table is full when HAProxy
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011950 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
11951 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011952 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011953 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
11954 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
11955 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
11956 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
11957 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
11958 parameter (see below).
11959
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011960 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
11961 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
11962 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
11963 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
11964 soft restart.
11965
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011966 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
Emeric Brun423ed382022-05-30 18:08:28 +020011967 was last created, refreshed using 'track-sc' or matched using
11968 'stick match' or 'stick on' rule. The expiration delay is
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011969 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
11970 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011971 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011972 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011973 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
11974 if not expiration delay is specified.
Emeric Brun423ed382022-05-30 18:08:28 +020011975 Note: 'table_*' converters performs lookups but won't update touch
11976 expire since they don't require 'track-sc'.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011977
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011978 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
11979 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
11980 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
11981 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
11982 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
11983 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
11984 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
11985 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
11986 token.
11987
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011988 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
11989 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
11990 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
11991 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011992 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
11993 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
11994 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
11995 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
11996 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
11997 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
11998 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
11999 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
12000 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
12001 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
12002 types and their arguments.
12003
12004 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
12005 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
12006 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
12007 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
12008
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012009 - gpc(<nb>) : General Purpose Counters Array of <nb> elements. This is an
12010 array of positive 32-bit integers which may be used to count anything.
12011 Most of the time they will be used as a incremental counters on some
12012 entries, for instance to note that a limit is reached and trigger some
12013 actions. This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements:
12014 gpc0 to gpc99, to ensure that the build of a peer update
12015 message can fit into the buffer. Users should take in consideration
12016 that a large amount of counters will increase the data size and the
12017 traffic load using peers protocol since all data/counters are pushed
12018 each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020012019 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types 'gpc0'
12020 and 'gpc1' on the same table. Using the 'gpc' array data_type, all 'gpc0'
12021 and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions will apply to the two first
12022 elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012023
12024 - gpc_rate(<nb>,<period>) : Array of increment rates of General Purpose
12025 Counters over a period. Those elements are positive 32-bit integers which
12026 may be used for anything. Just like <gpc>, the count events, but instead
12027 of keeping a cumulative number, they maintain the rate at which the
12028 counter is incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the
12029 frequency of occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific
Emeric Brun5e349e72022-03-25 14:13:23 +010012030 URL). This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements: gpt(100)
12031 allowing the storage of gpc0 to gpc99, to ensure that the build of a peer
12032 update message can fit into the buffer.
12033 The array cannot contain less than 1 element: use gpc(1) if you want to
12034 store only the counter gpc0.
12035 Users should take in consideration that a large amount of
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012036 counters will increase the data size and the traffic load using peers
12037 protocol since all data/counters are pushed each time any of them is
12038 updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020012039 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types
12040 'gpc0_rate' and 'gpc1_rate' on the same table. Using the 'gpc_rate'
12041 array data_type, all 'gpc0' and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions
12042 will apply to the two first elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012043
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012044 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
12045 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
12046 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012047 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012048
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012049 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
12050 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
12051 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012052 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012053 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012054 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012055
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012056 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
12057 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
12058 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
12059 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
12060
12061 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
12062 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
12063 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
12064 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
12065 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
12066 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
12067
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012068 - gpt(<nb>) : General Purpose Tags Array of <nb> elements. This is an array
12069 of positive 32-bit integers which may be used for anything.
12070 Most of the time they will be used to put a special tags on some entries,
12071 for instance to note that a specific behavior was detected and must be
12072 known for future matches. This array is limited to a maximum of 100
Emeric Brun5e349e72022-03-25 14:13:23 +010012073 elements: gpt(100) allowing the storage of gpt0 to gpt99, to ensure that
12074 the build of a peer update message can fit into the buffer.
12075 The array cannot contain less than 1 element: use gpt(1) if you want to
12076 to store only the tag gpt0.
12077 Users should take in consideration that a large amount of counters will
12078 increase the data size and the traffic load using peers protocol since
12079 all data/counters are pushed each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brunf7ab0bf2021-06-30 18:58:22 +020012080 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_type 'gpt0'
12081 on the same table. Using the 'gpt' array data_type, all 'gpt0' related
12082 fetches and actions will apply to the first element of this array.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012083
Emeric Brun1a6b7252021-07-01 18:34:48 +020012084 - gpt0 : first General Purpose Tag. It is a positive 32-bit integer
12085 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
12086 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
12087 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches
12088
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012089 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
12090 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
12091 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
12092 they were received.
12093
12094 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12095 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
12096 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
12097 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
12098 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
12099
12100 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12101 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12102 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12103 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
12104 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12105
12106 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
12107 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
12108 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
12109
12110 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12111 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12112 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12113 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
12114 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12115
12116 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12117 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
12118 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
12119 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
12120 the client side.
12121
12122 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12123 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12124 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12125 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
12126 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
12127 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
12128 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
12129
12130 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12131 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
12132 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
12133 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
12134 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
12135 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012136 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012137
12138 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12139 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12140 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12141 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
12142 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
12143 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12144
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010012145 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12146 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
12147 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
12148 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
12149 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
12150
12151 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
12152 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12153 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12154 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
12155 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
12156 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12157
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012158 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012159 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012160 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
12161 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
12162
12163 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12164 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12165 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12166 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
12167 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
12168 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
12169 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
12170 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
12171 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
12172 recommended for better fairness.
12173
12174 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012175 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012176 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
12177 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
12178
12179 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
12180 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12181 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12182 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
12183 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
12184 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
12185 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
12186 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
12187 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
12188 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020012189
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020012190 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
12191 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012192 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
12193 reference it.
12194
12195 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
12196 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010012197 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
12198 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
12199 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012200
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012201 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
12202 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
12203 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
12204 something that can be ignored.
12205
12206 Example:
12207 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
12208 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
12209 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
12210 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
12211
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010012212 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010012213 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012214
12215
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012216stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010012217 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12219 no | no | yes | yes
12220
12221 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012222 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012223 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012224 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012225 server is selected.
12226
12227 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
12228 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
12229 the "stick-table" statement.
12230
12231 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
12232 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
12233 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
12234 when the response is a SSL server hello.
12235
12236 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
12237 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
12238 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
12239 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
12240 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
12241 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012242 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012243 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
12244 rules.
12245
12246 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
12247 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
12248 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
12249 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
12250 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
12251 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
12252 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
12253
12254 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
12255 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
12256 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
12257 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
12258
12259 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
12260 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
12261 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
12262 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
12263 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
12264 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010012265 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
12266 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
12267 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
12268 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
12269 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
12270 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
12271 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
12272 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
12273 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012274
12275 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
12276
12277 Example :
12278 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
12279 backend https
12280 mode tcp
12281 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012282 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012283 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012284
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012285 acl clienthello req.ssl_hello_type 1
12286 acl serverhello rep.ssl_hello_type 2
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012287
12288 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
12289 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12290 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
12291
12292 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
12293 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012294
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012295 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
12296 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
12297 # at offset 44.
12298
12299 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012300 stick on req.payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012301
12302 # Learn on response if server hello.
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012303 stick store-response resp.payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012304
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012305 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
12306 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
12307
12308 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
12309 extraction.
12310
12311
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012312tcp-check comment <string>
12313 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
12314 it fails.
12315 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12316 yes | no | yes | yes
12317
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012318 Arguments :
12319 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
12320 rule fails.
12321
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012322 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
12323 user-friendly error reporting.
12324
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012325 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
12326 "tcp-check expect".
12327
12328
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012329tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
12330 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020012331 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012332 Opens a new connection
12333 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012334 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012335
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012336 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012337 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
12338
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020012339 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040012340 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020012341
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020012342 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020012343 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
12344 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020012345 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020012346
12347 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012348
12349 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
12350
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020012351 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
12352
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012353 ssl opens a ciphered connection
12354
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020012355 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
12356
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020012357 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
12358 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
12359 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
12360 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
12361
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020012362 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
12363 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
12364 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
12365 haproxy -vv.
12366
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020012367 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012368
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012369 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
12370 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
12371 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
12372
12373 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
12374 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
12375 of the sequence.
12376
12377 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
12378 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
12379 do.
12380
12381 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
12382 unset-var or comment rules.
12383
12384 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012385 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
12386 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
12387 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
12388 option tcp-check
12389 tcp-check connect
12390 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
12391 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
12392 tcp-check send \r\n
12393 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
12394 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
12395 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
12396 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
12397 tcp-check send \r\n
12398 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
12399 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
12400
12401 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
12402 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012403 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012404 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
12405 tcp-check connect port 143
12406 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
12407 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
12408
12409 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
12410
12411
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012412tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020012413 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020012414 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012415 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012416 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012417 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012418 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012419
12420 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012421 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
12422
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012423 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
12424 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
12425 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
12426 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
12427 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
12428 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
12429 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
12430 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
12431 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
12432 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
12433
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012434 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012435 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
12436 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012437 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
12438 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
12439 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
12440
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020012441 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
12442 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
12443 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020012444 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
12445 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010012446 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
12447 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020012448 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
12449 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020012450 By default "L7OK" is used.
12451
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012452 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
12453 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010012454 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
12455 supported :
12456 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
12457 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020012458 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
12459 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
12460 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
12461 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
12462 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012463
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020012464 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012465 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020012466 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
12467 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
12468 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
12469 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012470 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
12471
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020012472 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
12473 informational message reported in logs if the expect
12474 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
12475 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
12476
12477 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
12478 informational message reported in logs if an error
12479 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
12480 log-format string.
12481
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020012482 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
12483 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
12484 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12485 followed by some converters.
12486
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012487 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
12488 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
12489 with the usual backslash ('\').
12490 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012491 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012492 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
12493 used upper or lower case.
12494
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012495 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
12496
12497 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
12498 A health check response will be considered valid if the
12499 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
12500 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
12501 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
12502 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
12503 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
12504 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
12505
12506 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
12507 A health check response will be considered valid if the
12508 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
12509 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
12510 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
12511 expression.
12512
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020012513 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
12514 A health check response will be considered valid if the
12515 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
12516 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
12517 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
12518 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
12519
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012520 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
12521 in the response buffer. A health check response will
12522 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
12523 this exact hexadecimal string.
12524 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
12525
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012526 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
12527 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
12528 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
12529 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
12530 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
12531 size of the original response. As such, the expected
12532 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
12533 size.
12534
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020012535 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
12536 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
12537 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
12538 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
12539 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
12540 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
12541 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
12542 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
12543 in a binary string before matching the response's
12544 buffer.
12545
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012546 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012547 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012548 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
12549 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
12550 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
12551 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
12552 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
12553 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
12554 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
12555 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
12556 the null character.
12557
12558 Examples :
12559 # perform a POP check
12560 option tcp-check
12561 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
12562
12563 # perform an IMAP check
12564 option tcp-check
12565 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
12566
12567 # look for the redis master server
12568 option tcp-check
12569 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020012570 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012571 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
12572 tcp-check expect string role:master
12573 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
12574 tcp-check expect string +OK
12575
12576
12577 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012578 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012579
12580
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012581tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
12582tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
12583 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
12584 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012585 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012586 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012587
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012588 Arguments :
12589 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
12590
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012591 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
12592 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020012593
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012594 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
12595 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012596
12597 Examples :
12598 # look for the redis master server
12599 option tcp-check
12600 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
12601 tcp-check expect string role:master
12602
12603 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012604 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012605
12606
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012607tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
12608tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
12609 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
12610 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012611 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012612 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012613
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012614 Arguments :
12615 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012616
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012617 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
12618 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020012619
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012620 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
12621 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
12622 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012623
12624 Examples :
12625 # redis check in binary
12626 option tcp-check
12627 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
12628 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
12629
12630
12631 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012632 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012633
12634
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012635tcp-check set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
12636tcp-check set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012637 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012638 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012639 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012640
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012641 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012642 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12643 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
12644 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
12645 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
12646 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
12647 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
12648 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
12649 and '-'.
12650
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012651 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
12652 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +050012653 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012654 conditions.
12655
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012656 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
12657
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012658 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
12659 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
12660
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012661 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012662 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012663 tcp-check set-var-fmt(check.name) "%H"
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012664
12665
12666tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012667 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012668 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012669 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012670
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012671 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012672 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12673 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
12674 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
12675 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
12676 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
12677 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
12678 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
12679 and '-'.
12680
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012681 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012682 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
12683
12684
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012685tcp-request connection <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012686 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012687 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012688 yes(!) | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012689 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012690 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12691 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012692
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012693 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012694
12695 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
12696 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012697 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
12698 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
12699 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
12700 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
12701 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
12702 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012703
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012704 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12705 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12706 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012707 rules which may be inserted. Any rule may optionally be followed by an
12708 ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition
12709 is true.
12710
12711 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
12712 supported:
12713 - accept
12714 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4
12715 - expect-proxy layer4
12716 - reject
12717 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
12718 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
12719 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
12720 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12721 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12722 - set-dst <expr>
12723 - set-dst-port <expr>
12724 - set-mark <mark>
12725 - set-src <expr>
12726 - set-src-port <expr>
12727 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012728 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
12729 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +010012730 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012731 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
12732 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
12733 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010012734 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012735
12736 The supported actions are described below.
12737
12738 There is no limit to the number of "tcp-request connection" statements per
12739 instance.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012740
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012741 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
12742 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
12743 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
12744 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
12745 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
12746 a defaults section defining such rules.
12747
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012748 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12749 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12750 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012751
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012752 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12753 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
12754 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012755
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012756 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12757 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
12758 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012759
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012760 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
12761 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12762 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012763
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012764 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12765 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12766 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012767
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012768 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012769
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012770 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012771
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012772 See section 7 about ACL usage.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012773
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012774 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012775
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012776tcp-request connection accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012777
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012778 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request connection"
12779 rules are evaluated.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012780
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012781tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip layer4
12782 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012783
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012784 This configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client IP
12785 insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket. This is
12786 equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the "bind" line,
12787 except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only
12788 for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple
12789 layers of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
12790 hosts.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012791
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012792tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012793
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012794 This configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
12795 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to having
12796 the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule
12797 allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges
12798 using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are
12799 passed through by traffic coming from public hosts.
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012800
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012801tcp-request connection reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012802
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012803 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request connection"
12804 rules are evaluated. Rejected connections do not even become a session, which
12805 is why they are accounted separately for in the stats, as "denied
12806 connections". They are not considered for the session rate-limit and are not
12807 logged either. The reason is that these rules should only be used to filter
12808 extremely high connection rates such as the ones encountered during a massive
12809 DDoS attack. Under these extreme conditions, the simple action of logging
12810 each event would make the system collapse and would considerably lower the
12811 filtering capacity. If logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request
12812 content" rules should be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will
12813 not log either.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012814
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012815tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12816tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12817tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012818
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012819 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
12820 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
12821 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
12822 description.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012823
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012824tcp-request connection sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12825 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12826tcp-request connection sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12827 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012828
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012829 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
12830 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
12831 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012832
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012833tcp-request connection set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12834tcp-request connection set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012835
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012836 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
12837 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
12838 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012839
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012840tcp-request connection set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012841
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012842 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
12843 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
12844 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012845
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012846tcp-request connection set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12847tcp-request connection set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012848
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012849 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
12850 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
12851 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012852
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012853tcp-request connection set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012854
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012855 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
12856 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
12857 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012858
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012859tcp-request connection set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12860tcp-request connection set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010012861
12862 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
12863 inline. "tcp-request connection" can set variables in the "proc" and "sess"
12864 scopes. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
12865 for a complete description.
12866
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010012867tcp-request connection silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012868
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012869 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
12870 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
12871 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
12872 complete description.
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012873
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012874tcp-request connection track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12875tcp-request connection track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12876tcp-request connection track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012877
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012878 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
12879 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
12880 track-sc2" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012881
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010012882tcp-request connection unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12883
12884 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
12885 details about variables.
12886
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012887
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012888tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12889 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012890 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012891 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012892 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012893 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12894 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012895
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012896 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012897
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012898 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012899 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12900 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012901 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
12902 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012903
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012904 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
12905 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
12906 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
12907 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012908 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012909 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so HAProxy keeps a record of
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012910 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
12911 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
12912 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
12913 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012914 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012915 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012916
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012917 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12918 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12919 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12920 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012921
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012922 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
12923 supported:
12924 - accept
12925 - capture <sample> len <length>
12926 - do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
12927 - reject
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012928 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012929 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012930 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012931 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012932 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012933 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020012934 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit <expr>] [period <expr>]
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012935 - set-dst <expr>
12936 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020012937 - set-log-level <level>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012938 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020012939 - set-nice <nice>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012940 - set-priority-class <expr>
12941 - set-priority-offset <expr>
Christopher Faulet1e83b702021-06-23 12:07:21 +020012942 - set-src <expr>
12943 - set-src-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012944 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012945 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
12946 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +010012947 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012948 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012949 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
12950 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
12951 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012952 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012953 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012954
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012955 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012956
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012957 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
12958 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
12959 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
12960 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
12961 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
12962 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012963
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012964 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
12965 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
12966 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
12967 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
12968 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
12969 a defaults section defining such rules.
12970
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012971 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012972 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12973 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012974
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020012975 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
12976 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
12977 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
12978 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
12979 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
12980 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
12981
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012982 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020012983 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
12984 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
12985 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
12986 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
12987 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
12988 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
12989 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
12990 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
12991 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
12992 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012993
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012994 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012995 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
12996 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
12997 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012998
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012999 Example:
Aurelien DARRAGONd49b5592022-10-05 18:09:33 +020013000 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010013001
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013002 Example:
13003
13004 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020013005 tcp-request content set-var-fmt(sess.from) %[src]:%[src_port]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013006 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013007
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013008 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013009 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010013010 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013011 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
13012 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020013013 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013014 tcp-request content reject
13015
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010013016 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
13017 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
13018 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
13019 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
13020 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
13021 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
13022 ...
13023 http-request reject unless is_host_com
13024
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013025 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013026 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
13027 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010013028 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013029 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013030
13031 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
13032 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010013033 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013034 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013035 tcp-request content reject
13036
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013037 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030013038 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013039 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020013040 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030013041 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
13042 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013043
13044 Example:
13045 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
13046 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020013047 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013048
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013049 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030013050 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013051
13052 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013053 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013054 # protecting all our sites
13055 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013056 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
13057 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013058 ...
13059 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
13060
13061 backend http_dynamic
13062 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013063 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013064 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013065 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030013066 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013067 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013068 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013069
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013070 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013071
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030013072 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
13073 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013074
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013075tcp-request content accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13076
13077 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +010013078 rules are evaluated for the current section.
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013079
13080tcp-request content capture <sample> len <length>
13081 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13082
13083 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
13084 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
13085 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
13086 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
13087 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
13088 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
13089 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life. Please
13090 check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for more
13091 information.
13092
13093tcp-request content do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
13094
13095 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores the
13096 result in the variable <var>. Please refer to "http-request do-resolve" for a
13097 complete description.
13098
13099tcp-request content reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13100
13101 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request content" rules
13102 are evaluated.
13103
13104tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13105tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13106tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13107
13108 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
13109 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
13110 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
13111 description.
13112
13113tcp-request content sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13114 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13115tcp-request content sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13116 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13117
13118 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
13119 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
13120 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
13121
13122tcp-request content send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
13123 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13124
13125 Thaction is is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
13126 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
13127
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020013128tcp-request content set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit <expr>] [period <expr>]
13129 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13130
13131 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
13132 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Please
13133 refer to "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" for a complete description.
13134
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013135tcp-request content set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13136tcp-request content set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13137
13138 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
13139 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
13140 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
13141
13142tcp-request content set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13143
13144 This action is used to set the log level of the current session. Please refer
13145 to "http-request set-log-level". for a complete description.
13146
13147tcp-request content set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13148
13149 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
13150 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
13151 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
13152
13153tcp-request content set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13154
13155 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
13156 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
13157
13158tcp-request content set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13159
13160 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request. Please
13161 refer to "http-request set-priority-class" for a complete description.
13162
13163tcp-request content set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13164
13165 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
13166 request. Please refer to "http-request set-priority-offset" for a complete
13167 description.
13168
Christopher Faulet1e83b702021-06-23 12:07:21 +020013169tcp-request content set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13170tcp-request content set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13171
13172 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
13173 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
13174 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
13175
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013176tcp-request content set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13177
13178 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
13179 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
13180 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
13181
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013182tcp-request content set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13183tcp-request content set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013184
13185 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
13186 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
13187 for a complete description.
13188
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010013189tcp-request content silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013190
13191 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
13192 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
13193 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
13194 complete description.
13195
13196tcp-request content switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
13197 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13198
13199 This action is used to perform a connection upgrade. Only HTTP upgrades are
13200 supported for now. The protocol may optionally be specified. This action is
13201 only available for a proxy with the frontend capability. The connection
13202 upgrade is immediately performed, following "tcp-request content" rules are
13203 not evaluated. This upgrade method should be preferred to the implicit one
13204 consisting to rely on the backend mode. When used, it is possible to set HTTP
13205 directives in a frontend without any warning. These directives will be
13206 conditionally evaluated if the HTTP upgrade is performed. However, an HTTP
13207 backend must still be selected. It remains unsupported to route an HTTP
13208 connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
13209
13210 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
13211
13212tcp-request content track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13213tcp-request content track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13214tcp-request content track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13215
13216 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
13217 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
13218 track-sc2" for a complete description.
13219
13220tcp-request content unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13221
13222 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
13223 details about variables.
13224
Aleksandar Lazic332258a2022-03-30 00:11:40 +020013225tcp-request content use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013226
13227 This action is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the request
13228 and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to reply by
13229 sending any valid response or it may immediately close the connection without
13230 sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible to write your own
13231 services in Lua. No further "tcp-request content" rules are evaluated.
13232
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013233
13234tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
13235 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
13236 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013237 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013238 Arguments :
13239 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13240 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13241 as explained at the top of this document.
13242
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013243 People using HAProxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013244 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
13245 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
13246 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
13247 data for at most the specified amount of time.
13248
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020013249 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
13250 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
13251 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
13252 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
13253
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013254 Note that when performing content inspection, HAProxy will evaluate the whole
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013255 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013256 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013257 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013258 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, HAProxy will not wait at all
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010013259 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
13260 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
13261 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013262
13263 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
13264 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
13265 it pass through unaffected.
13266
13267 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
13268 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
13269 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013270 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013271 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
13272 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020013273 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
13274 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
13275 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013276
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013277 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13278 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
13279
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013280 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013281 "timeout client".
13282
13283
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013284tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
13285 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
13286 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013287 yes(!) | yes | yes | no
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013288 Arguments :
13289 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
13290 below.
13291
13292 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
13293
13294 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
13295 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
13296 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
13297 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
Anubhave09efaa2021-10-14 22:28:25 +053013298 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case is to copy some
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013299 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
13300 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
13301 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
13302 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
13303 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
13304 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
13305 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
13306 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
13307 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
13308 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
13309 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
13310 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
13311 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
13312 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
13313 instead.
13314
13315 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
13316 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
13317 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
13318 rules which may be inserted.
13319
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013320 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
13321 supported:
13322 - accept
13323 - reject
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013324 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
13325 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
13326 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
13327 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13328 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013329 - set-dst <expr>
13330 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013331 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013332 - set-src <expr>
13333 - set-src-port <expr>
13334 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013335 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
13336 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +010013337 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013338 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
13339 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
13340 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
13341 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013342
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013343 The supported actions are described below.
13344
13345 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13346 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
13347 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
13348 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
13349 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
13350 a defaults section defining such rules.
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013351
13352 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
13353 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
13354 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
13355
13356 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
13357 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
13358 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
13359 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
13360 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
13361
13362 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
13363 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
13364
13365 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
13366 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
13367 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
13368
13369 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
13370 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
13371 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
13372
13373 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
13374 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
13375 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
13376
13377 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
13378 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
13379 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
13380
13381 See section 7 about ACL usage.
13382
13383 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
13384
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013385tcp-request session accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13386
13387 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request session"
13388 rules are evaluated.
13389
13390tcp-request session reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13391
13392 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request session" rules
13393 are evaluated.
13394
13395tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13396tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13397tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13398
13399 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
13400 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
13401 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
13402 description.
13403
13404tcp-request session sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13405 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13406tcp-request session sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13407 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13408
13409 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
13410 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "tcp-request connection
13411 sc-inc-gpt" and "tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete
13412 description.
13413
13414tcp-request session set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13415tcp-request session set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13416
13417 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
13418 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
13419 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
13420
13421tcp-request session set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13422
13423 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
13424 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
13425 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
13426
13427tcp-request session set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13428tcp-request session set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13429
13430 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
13431 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
13432 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
13433
13434tcp-request session set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13435
13436 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
13437 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
13438 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
13439
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013440tcp-request session set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13441tcp-request session set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013442
13443 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
13444 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
13445 for a complete description.
13446
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010013447tcp-request session silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013448
13449 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
13450 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
13451 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
13452 complete description.
13453
13454tcp-request session track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13455tcp-request session track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13456tcp-request session track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13457
13458 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
13459 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
13460 track-sc2" for a complete description.
13461
13462tcp-request session unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13463
13464 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
13465 details about variables.
13466
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013467
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013468tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
13469 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
13470 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013471 yes(!) | no | yes | yes
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013472 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020013473 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
13474 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013475
13476 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
13477
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013478 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013479 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
13480 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020013481 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
13482 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013483
13484 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
13485
13486 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
13487 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
13488 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
13489 inserted.
13490
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013491 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
13492 supported:
13493 - accept
13494 - close
13495 - reject
13496 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
13497 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
13498 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
13499 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13500 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13501 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020013502 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit <expr>] [period <expr>]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013503 - set-log-level <level>
13504 - set-mark <mark>
13505 - set-nice <nice>
13506 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013507 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
13508 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +010013509 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013510 - unset-var(<var-name>)
13511
13512 The supported actions are described below.
13513
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013514 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13515 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
13516 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
13517 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
13518 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
13519 a defaults section defining such rules.
13520
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013521 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
13522 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
13523 for changing the default action to a reject.
13524
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013525 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013526
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013527 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
13528 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
13529 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
13530 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
13531 period.
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020013532
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013533 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013534
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013535 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020013536
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013537tcp-response content accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013538
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013539 This is used to accept the response. No further "tcp-response content" rules
13540 are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020013541
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013542tcp-response content close [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013543
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013544 This is used to immediately closes the connection with the server. No further
13545 "tcp-response content" rules are evaluated. The main purpose of this action
13546 is to force a connection to be finished between a client and a server after
13547 an exchange when the application protocol expects some long time outs to
13548 elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle connections which take
13549 significant resources on servers with certain protocols.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013550
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013551tcp-response content reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020013552
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013553 This is used to reject the response. No further "tcp-response content" rules
13554 are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013555
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013556tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13557tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13558tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020013559
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013560 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
13561 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
13562 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
13563 description.
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020013564
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013565tcp-response content sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13566 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13567tcp-resposne content sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13568 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013569
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013570 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
13571 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
13572 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020013573
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013574tcp-response content send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
13575 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013576
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013577 Thaction is is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
13578 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020013579
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020013580
13581tcp-response content set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit <expr>] [period <expr>]
13582 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13583
13584 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
13585 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Please
13586 refer to "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" for a complete description.
13587
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013588tcp-response content set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020013589
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013590 This action is used to set the log level of the current session. Please refer
13591 to "http-request set-log-level". for a complete description.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013592
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013593tcp-response content set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013594
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013595 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
13596 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
13597 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013598
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013599tcp-response content set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013600
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013601 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
13602 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013603
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013604tcp-response content set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020013605
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013606 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
13607 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
13608 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013609
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013610tcp-response content set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13611tcp-response content set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020013612
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013613 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
13614 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
13615 for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020013616
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010013617tcp-response content silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020013618
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013619 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
13620 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
13621 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
13622 complete description.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013623
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013624tcp-response content unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013625
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013626 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
13627 details about variables.
13628
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013629
13630tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
13631 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
13632 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013633 yes(!) | no | yes | yes
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013634 Arguments :
13635 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13636 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13637 as explained at the top of this document.
13638
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013639 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13640 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013641
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013642 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
13643
13644
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013645timeout check <timeout>
13646 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
13647 established.
13648
13649 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13650 yes | no | yes | yes
13651 Arguments:
13652 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13653 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13654 as explained at the top of this document.
13655
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013656 If set, HAProxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013657 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013658 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013659 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010013660 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
13661 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
13662 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013663
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013664 If "timeout check" is not set HAProxy uses "inter" for complete check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013665 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
13666
13667 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
13668 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010013669 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013670
13671 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13672 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13673 forget about it.
13674
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013675 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13676 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
13677
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010013678 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
13679 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013680
13681
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013682timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013683 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
13684 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13685 yes | yes | yes | no
13686 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013687 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013688 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13689 as explained at the top of this document.
13690
13691 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
13692 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
13693 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010013694 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
13695 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
13696 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
13697 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013698 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
13699 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
13700 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013701 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013702 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013703 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
13704 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013705 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
13706 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013707
13708 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
13709 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13710 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13711 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013712 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013713 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13714
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013715 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013716
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013717
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013718timeout client-fin <timeout>
13719 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
13720 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13721 yes | yes | yes | no
13722 Arguments :
13723 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13724 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13725 as explained at the top of this document.
13726
13727 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
13728 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
13729 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
13730 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
13731 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
13732 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
13733 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010013734 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
13735 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
13736 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013737
13738 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
13739 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
13740 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
13741
13742 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
13743
13744
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013745timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013746 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
13747 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13748 yes | no | yes | yes
13749 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013750 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013751 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13752 as explained at the top of this document.
13753
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013754 If the server is located on the same LAN as HAProxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013755 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013756 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013757 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013758 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
13759 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013760
13761 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13762 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13763 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13764 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013765 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013766 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13767
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013768 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013769
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013770
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013771timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
13772 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
13773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13774 yes | yes | yes | yes
13775 Arguments :
13776 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13777 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13778 as explained at the top of this document.
13779
13780 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
13781 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
13782 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
13783 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
13784 once the request has started to present itself.
13785
13786 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
13787 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
13788 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
13789 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
13790 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
13791
13792 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
13793 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
13794 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
13795 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
13796
13797 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
13798 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013799 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013800 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
13801 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020013802 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013803
13804 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
13805 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
13806 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
13807 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
13808
13809 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
13810
13811
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013812timeout http-request <timeout>
13813 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
13814 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020013815 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013816 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013817 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013818 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13819 as explained at the top of this document.
13820
13821 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
13822 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
13823 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
13824 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
13825 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
13826 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
13827 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020013828 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
13829 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
13830 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
13831 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013832 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013833 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
13834 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013835
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013836 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
13837 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
13838 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
13839 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
13840 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013841 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013842
13843 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
13844 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013845 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013846 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
13847 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
13848
13849 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020013850 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
13851 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
13852 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013853
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013854 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013855 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013856
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013857
13858timeout queue <timeout>
13859 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
13860 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13861 yes | no | yes | yes
13862 Arguments :
13863 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13864 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13865 as explained at the top of this document.
13866
13867 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
13868 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
13869 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
13870 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
13871 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
13872
13873 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
13874 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
13875 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
13876 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
13877
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013878 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013879
13880
13881timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013882 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
13883 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13884 yes | no | yes | yes
13885 Arguments :
13886 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13887 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13888 as explained at the top of this document.
13889
13890 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13891 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
13892 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
13893 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
13894 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
13895 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
13896 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
13897
13898 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13899 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13900 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
13901 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
13902 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013903 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013904 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013905 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
13906 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013907 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
13908 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013909
13910 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13911 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13912 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13913 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013914 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013915 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13916
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013917 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013918
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013919
13920timeout server-fin <timeout>
13921 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
13922 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13923 yes | no | yes | yes
13924 Arguments :
13925 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13926 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13927 as explained at the top of this document.
13928
13929 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13930 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
13931 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
13932 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
13933 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
13934 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
13935 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
13936 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
13937 situations, it should not be needed.
13938
13939 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13940 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
13941 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
13942
13943 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
13944
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013945
13946timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013947 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013948 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13949 yes | yes | yes | yes
13950 Arguments :
13951 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
13952 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13953 as explained at the top of this document.
13954
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020013955 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
13956 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
13957 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013958
13959 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13960 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13961 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
13962 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013963 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013964
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013965 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013966
13967
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013968timeout tunnel <timeout>
13969 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
13970 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13971 yes | no | yes | yes
13972 Arguments :
13973 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13974 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13975 as explained at the top of this document.
13976
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013977 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013978 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
13979 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
13980 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013981 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
13982 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013983 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
13984 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
13985 specified.
13986
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013987 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
13988 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
13989 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
13990 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
13991 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
13992 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
13993 state.
13994
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013995 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13996 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13997 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
13998 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013999 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014000
14001 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
14002 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
14003 forget about it.
14004
14005 Example :
14006 defaults http
14007 option http-server-close
14008 timeout connect 5s
14009 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014010 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014011 timeout server 30s
14012 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
14013
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014014 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014015
14016
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014017transparent (deprecated)
14018 Enable client-side transparent proxying
14019 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010014020 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014021 Arguments : none
14022
14023 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
14024 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
14025 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
14026 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
14027 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
14028 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
14029 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
14030 appropriate server.
14031
14032 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
14033
14034 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
14035 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
14036
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014037 See also: "option transparent"
14038
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014039unique-id-format <string>
14040 Generate a unique ID for each request.
14041 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14042 yes | yes | yes | no
14043 Arguments :
14044 <string> is a log-format string.
14045
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014046 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
14047 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
14048 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
14049 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014050
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014051 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014052 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple HAProxy instances
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014053 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
14054 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
14055 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
14056 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
14057 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
14058 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014059
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014060 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
14061 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014062
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014063 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014064
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050014065 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014066
14067 will generate:
14068
14069 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
14070
14071 See also: "unique-id-header"
14072
14073unique-id-header <name>
14074 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
14075 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14076 yes | yes | yes | no
14077 Arguments :
14078 <name> is the name of the header.
14079
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014080 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
14081 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014082
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014083 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014084
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050014085 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014086 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
14087
14088 will generate:
14089
14090 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
14091
14092 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014093
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020014094use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020014095 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014096 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14097 no | yes | yes | no
14098 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010014099 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
14100 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014101
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020014102 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
14103 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014104
14105 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
14106 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
14107 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020014108 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014109 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020014110 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
14111 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014112
14113 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
14114 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
14115 assign the backend.
14116
14117 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
14118 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
14119 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
14120 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
14121 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
14122 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
14123
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020014124 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014125 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020014126 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
14127 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
14128 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
14129
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010014130 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
14131 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
14132 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
14133 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
14134 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
14135 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
14136 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
14137 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
14138 cannot be forced from the request.
14139
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014140 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010014141 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
14142 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
14143
14144 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
14145 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014146
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020014147use-fcgi-app <name>
14148 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
14149 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14150 no | no | yes | yes
14151 Arguments :
14152 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
14153
14154 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014155
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014156use-server <server> if <condition>
14157use-server <server> unless <condition>
14158 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
14159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14160 no | no | yes | yes
14161 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020014162 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
14163 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014164
14165 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
14166
14167 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
14168 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
14169 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
14170
14171 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
14172 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
14173 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
14174 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
14175 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
14176 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
14177 matches will assign the server.
14178
14179 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
14180 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
14181 with the next rules until one matches.
14182
14183 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
14184 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
14185 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
14186 according to other persistence mechanisms.
14187
14188 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
14189 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
14190 stripped.
14191
14192 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
14193 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020014194 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014195 implicit TLS (also see "req.ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020014196 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014197
14198 Example :
14199 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014200 use-server www if { req.ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014201 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014202 use-server mail if { req.ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020014203 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014204 use-server imap if { req.ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000014205 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014206 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
14207 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
14208
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020014209 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
14210 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
14211 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
14212 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050014213 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020014214 and we fall back to load balancing.
14215
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014216 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014217
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014218
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100142195. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014220--------------------------
14221
14222The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
14223depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
14224settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
14225written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
14226described in this section.
14227
14228
142295.1. Bind options
14230-----------------
14231
14232The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
14233as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
14234no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
14235parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
14236while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
14237provided immediately after the setting name.
14238
14239The currently supported settings are the following ones.
14240
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014241accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
14242 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
14243 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
14244 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
14245 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
14246 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
14247 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
14248 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
14249 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
14250 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010014251 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
14252 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
14253 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014254
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014255accept-proxy
14256 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020014257 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
14258 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014259 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
14260 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
14261 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
14262 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014263 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014264 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
14265 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020014266 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
14267 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014268
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020014269allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010014270 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010014271 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014272 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010014273 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
14274 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020014275
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014276alpn <protocols>
14277 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14278 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14279 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014280 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014281 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010014282 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
14283 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
14284 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
14285 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
14286 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
14287 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
14288 preference, like below :
14289
14290 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014291
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +020014292 QUIC supports only h3 and hq-interop as ALPN. h3 is for HTTP/3 and hq-interop
14293 is used for http/0.9 and QUIC interop runner (see https://interop.seemann.io).
14294
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014295backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010014296 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014297 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
14298
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010014299curves <curves>
14300 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
14301 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
14302 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
14303 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
14304 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
14305 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
14306
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020014307ecdhe <named curve>
14308 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010014309 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
14310 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020014311
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014312ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014313 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14314 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020014315 client's certificate. It is possible to load a directory containing multiple
14316 CAs, in this case HAProxy will try to load every ".pem", ".crt", ".cer", and
William Lallemande4b93eb2022-05-09 09:29:00 +020014317 .crl" available in the directory, files starting with a dot are ignored.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014318
William Lallemand1639d6c2022-05-26 00:18:46 +020014319 Warning: The "@system-ca" parameter could be used in place of the cafile
14320 in order to use the trusted CAs of your system, like its done with the server
14321 directive. But you mustn't use it unless you know what you are doing.
14322 Configuring it this way basically mean that the bind will accept any client
14323 certificate generated from one of the CA present on your system, which is
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +050014324 extremely insecure.
William Lallemand1639d6c2022-05-26 00:18:46 +020014325
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020014326ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
14327 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14328 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
William Lallemand960fb742022-11-03 16:31:50 +010014329 It could be a numerical ID, or the constant name (X509_V_ERR) which is
14330 available in the OpenSSL documentation:
14331 https://www.openssl.org/docs/manmaster/man3/X509_STORE_CTX_get_error.html#ERROR-CODES
14332 It is recommended to use the constant name as the numerical value can change
14333 in new version of OpenSSL.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020014334 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
14335 error is ignored.
14336
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020014337ca-sign-file <cafile>
14338 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14339 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
14340 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
14341 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
14342 'generate-certificates' for details.
14343
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000014344ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020014345 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
14346 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
14347 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
14348 'generate-certificates' for details.
14349
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010014350ca-verify-file <cafile>
14351 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
14352 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
14353 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
14354 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
14355 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
14356
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014357ciphers <ciphers>
14358 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
14359 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000014360 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014361 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014362 information and recommendations see e.g.
14363 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14364 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14365 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
14366
14367ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14368 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14369 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
14370 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
14371 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014372 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
14373 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014374
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014375crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014376 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14377 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
Remi Tricot-Le Breton02bd6842021-05-04 12:22:34 +020014378 to verify client's certificate. You need to provide a certificate revocation
14379 list for every certificate of your certificate authority chain.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014380
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014381crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014382 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14383 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
14384 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
14385 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
14386 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010014387 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
14388 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014389
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010014390 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
14391 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
14392
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014393 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
14394 are loaded.
14395
14396 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010014397 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
William Lallemand589570d2022-05-09 10:30:51 +020014398 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). Files
14399 starting with a dot are also ignored. This directive may be specified multiple
14400 times in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
14401 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
14402 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
14403 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
14404 hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
14405 www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014406
14407 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
14408 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
14409 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
14410 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010014411 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
14412 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014413
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020014414 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014415
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014416 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014417 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014418 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
14419 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014420 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
14421 clients).
14422
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014423 For each PEM file, HAProxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020014424 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
14425 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
14426 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
14427 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
14428 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
14429 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
14430 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
14431 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
14432 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
14433 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
14434 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
14435 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
14436
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014437 For each PEM file, HAProxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010014438 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
14439 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
14440 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
14441 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
14442
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050014443 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
14444 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
14445 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
14446 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050014447
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020014448 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
14449 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
14450 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050014451
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020014452crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014453 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
William Lallemand960fb742022-11-03 16:31:50 +010014454 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0.
14455 It could be a numerical ID, or the constant name (X509_V_ERR) which is
14456 available in the OpenSSL documentation:
14457 https://www.openssl.org/docs/manmaster/man3/X509_STORE_CTX_get_error.html#ERROR-CODES
14458 It is recommended to use the constant name as the numerical value can change
14459 in new version of OpenSSL.
14460 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
14461 error is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020014462
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010014463crt-list <file>
14464 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010014465 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
14466 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010014467
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010014468 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
14469
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020014470 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
14471 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
14472 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
14473 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
14474 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010014475
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020014476 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030014477 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
14478 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
14479 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
14480 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
14481 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020014482 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
14483 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
14484 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010014485
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020014486 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
14487 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
14488 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050014489
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020014490 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
14491
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030014492 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014493 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which HAProxy should use in
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030014494 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
14495 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
14496 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
14497 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
14498 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
14499 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030014500
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010014501 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030014502 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020014503 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010014504 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010014505 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010014506 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010014507
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014508defer-accept
14509 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
14510 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
14511 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014512 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014513 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
14514 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
14515 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
14516 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
14517 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
14518 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
14519 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
14520
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020014521expose-fd listeners
14522 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
14523 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemand2be557f2021-11-24 18:45:37 +010014524 In master-worker mode, this is not required anymore, the listeners will be
14525 passed using the internal socketpairs between the master and the workers.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014526 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020014527
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014528force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014529 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014530 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014531 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014532 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014533
14534force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014535 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014536 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014537 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014538
14539force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014540 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014541 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014542 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014543
14544force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014545 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014546 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014547 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014548
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014549force-tlsv13
14550 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
14551 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014552 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014553
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020014554generate-certificates
14555 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14556 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
14557 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
14558 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
14559 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
14560 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
14561 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
14562 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
14563 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
14564 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
14565 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
14566
14567 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
14568 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014569 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020014570 certificate is used many times.
14571
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014572gid <gid>
14573 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
14574 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14575 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
14576 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
14577 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14578
14579group <group>
14580 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
14581 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
14582 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
14583 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
14584 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14585
14586id <id>
14587 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
14588 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
14589 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
14590 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
14591
14592interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010014593 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
14594 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
14595 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
14596 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
14597 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
14598 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010014599 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
14600 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
14601 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
14602 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
14603 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
14604 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014605
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020014606level <level>
14607 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
14608 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
14609 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014610 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020014611 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
14612 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
14613 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014614 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020014615 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014616 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020014617 all counters).
14618
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020014619severity-output <format>
14620 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
14621 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
14622 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
14623 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
14624 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
14625 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
14626 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
14627 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
14628 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
14629 rfc5424 convention.
14630
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014631maxconn <maxconn>
14632 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
14633 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
14634 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
14635 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
14636 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
14637 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
14638 eat all memory.
14639
14640mode <mode>
14641 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
14642 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
14643 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
14644 UNIX sockets.
14645
14646mss <maxseg>
14647 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
14648 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
14649 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
14650 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
14651 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
14652 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
14653 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
14654 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
14655 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
14656 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
14657 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
14658
14659name <name>
14660 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
14661 page.
14662
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014663namespace <name>
14664 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14665 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
14666 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14667 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14668
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014669nice <nice>
14670 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
14671 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
14672 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
14673 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
14674 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
14675 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
14676 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
14677 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
14678 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
14679 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
14680 one for an RDP socket.
14681
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020014682no-ca-names
14683 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14684 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010014685 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020014686
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014687no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014688 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014689 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014690 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014691 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014692 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
14693 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014694
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020014695no-tls-tickets
14696 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14697 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14698 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014699 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
14700 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014701 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14702 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14703 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020014704
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014705no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014706 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014707 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014708 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014709 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014710 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14711 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014712
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014713no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014714 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014715 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014716 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014717 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014718 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14719 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014720
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014721no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014722 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014723 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014724 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014725 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014726 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14727 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014728
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014729no-tlsv13
14730 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14731 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
14732 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
14733 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014734 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14735 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014736
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020014737npn <protocols>
14738 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14739 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14740 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014741 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014742 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010014743 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14744 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
14745 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
14746 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
14747 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020014748
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond5d77962022-12-20 11:11:15 +010014749ocsp-update [ off | on ]
14750 Enable automatic OCSP response update when set to 'on', disable it otherwise.
14751 Its value defaults to 'off'.
14752 This option can only be used in a crt-list line so that is applies to only
14753 one certificate at a time. If a given certificate is used in multiple
14754 crt-lists with different values of the 'ocsp-update' set, an error will be
14755 raised.
14756 When the option is set to 'on', we will try to get an ocsp response whenever
14757 an ocsp uri is found in the frontend's certificate. The only limitation of
14758 this mode is that the certificate's issuer will have to be known in order for
14759 the OCSP certid to be built.
14760 Each OCSP response will be updated at least once an hour, and even more
14761 frequently if a given OCSP response has an expire date earlier than this one
14762 hour limit. A minimum update interval of 5 minutes will still exist in order
14763 to avoid updating too often responses that have a really short expire time or
14764 even no 'Next Update' at all. Because of this hard limit, please note that
14765 when auto update is set to 'on' or 'auto', any OCSP response loaded during
14766 init will not be updated until at least 5 minutes, even if its expire time
14767 ends before now+5m. This should not be too much of a hassle since an OCSP
14768 response must be valid when it gets loaded during init (its expire time must
14769 be in the future) so it is unlikely that this response expires in such a
14770 short time after init.
14771 On the other hand, if a certificate has an OCSP uri specified and no OCSP
14772 response, setting this option to 'on' for the given certificate will ensure
14773 that the OCSP response gets fetched automatically right after init.
14774
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000014775prefer-client-ciphers
14776 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
14777 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
14778 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020014779 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
14780 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
14781 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000014782
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020014783proto <name>
14784 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
14785 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
14786 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014787 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
14788 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14789
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020014790 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
14791 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
14792 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014793
14794 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14795 a bind line :
14796
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020014797 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014798 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14799 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14800
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014801 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020014802 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080014803 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020014804 h2" on the bind line.
14805
Frédéric Lécaille43910a92022-07-11 10:24:21 +020014806quic-cc-algo [ cubic | newreno ]
14807 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
14808
14809 This is a QUIC specific setting to select the congestion control algorithm
14810 for any connection attempts to the configured QUIC listeners. They are similar
14811 to those used by TCP.
14812
14813 Default value: cubic
14814
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +020014815quic-force-retry
14816 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
14817 change without deprecation in the future.
14818
14819 This is a QUIC specific setting which forces the use of the QUIC Retry feature
14820 for all the connection attempts to the configured QUIC listeners. It consists
14821 in veryfying the peers are able to receive packets at the transport address
14822 they used to initiate a new connection, sending them a Retry packet which
14823 contains a token. This token must be sent back to the Retry packet sender,
14824 this latter being the only one to be able to validate the token. Note that QUIC
14825 Retry will always be used even if a Retry threshold was set (see
Amaury Denoyelle996ca7d2022-11-14 16:17:13 +010014826 "tune.quic.retry-threshold" setting).
14827
14828 This setting requires the cluster secret to be set or else an error will be
14829 reported on startup (see "cluster-secret").
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +020014830
14831 See https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc9000.html#section-8.1.2 for more
14832 information about QUIC retry.
14833
Willy Tarreau6dfbef42021-10-12 15:23:03 +020014834shards <number> | by-thread
14835 In multi-threaded mode, on operating systems supporting multiple listeners on
14836 the same IP:port, this will automatically create this number of multiple
14837 identical listeners for the same line, all bound to a fair share of the number
14838 of the threads attached to this listener. This can sometimes be useful when
14839 using very large thread counts where the in-kernel locking on a single socket
14840 starts to cause a significant overhead. In this case the incoming traffic is
14841 distributed over multiple sockets and the contention is reduced. Note that
14842 doing this can easily increase the CPU usage by making more threads work a
14843 little bit.
14844
14845 If the number of shards is higher than the number of available threads, it
14846 will automatically be trimmed to the number of threads (i.e. one shard per
14847 thread). The special "by-thread" value also creates as many shards as there
14848 are threads on the "bind" line. Since the system will evenly distribute the
14849 incoming traffic between all these shards, it is important that this number
14850 is an integral divisor of the number of threads.
14851
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014852ssl
14853 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014854 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014855 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
14856 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020014857 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
14858 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014859
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014860ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14861 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020014862 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
14863 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
14864 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014865 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
14866
14867ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020014868 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
14869 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
14870 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
14871 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014872
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010014873strict-sni
14874 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
14875 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
14876 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
14877 See the "crt" option for more information.
14878
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010014879tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014880 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010014881 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014882 allows HAProxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014883 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010014884 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
14885 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
14886 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
14887 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
14888 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
14889 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
14890 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14891
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014892tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010014893 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014894 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
14895 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
14896 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
14897 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
14898 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
14899 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
14900 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020014901 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
14902 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
14903 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014904
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020014905thread [<thread-group>/]<thread-set>
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014906 This restricts the list of threads on which this listener is allowed to run.
14907 It does not enforce any of them but eliminates those which do not match. It
14908 limits the threads allowed to process incoming connections for this listener.
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020014909
14910 There are two numbering schemes. By default, thread numbers are absolute in
14911 the process, comprised between 1 and the value specified in global.nbthread.
14912 When thread groups are enabled, the number of a single desired thread group
14913 (starting at 1) may be specified before a slash ('/') before the thread
14914 range. In this case, the thread numbers in the range are relative to the
14915 thread group instead, and start at 1 for each thread group. Absolute and
14916 relative thread numbers may be used interchangeably but they must not be
14917 mixed on a single "bind" line, as those not set will be resolved at the end
14918 of the parsing.
14919
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014920 For the unlikely case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020014921 repeated. It is not permitted to use different thread groups even when using
14922 multiple directives. The <thread-set> specification must use the format:
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014923
14924 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
14925
14926 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such a
14927 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose is
14928 to have multiple bind lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same thread
14929 in a listener, so that the system can distribute the incoming connections
14930 into multiple queues, bypassing haproxy's internal queue load balancing.
14931 Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known for supporting this.
14932
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010014933tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
14934 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010014935 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
14936 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
14937 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
14938 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
14939 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
14940 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
14941 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
14942 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
14943 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
14944 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010014945 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
14946 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
14947
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014948transparent
14949 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
14950 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
14951 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
14952 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
14953 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
14954 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
14955 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
14956 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
14957 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
14958 so check for support with your vendor.
14959
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014960v4v6
14961 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14962 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
14963 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
14964 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014965 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014966
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014967v6only
14968 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14969 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
14970 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014971 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
14972 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014973
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014974uid <uid>
14975 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
14976 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14977 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
14978 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
14979 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14980
14981user <user>
14982 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
14983 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14984 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
14985 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
14986 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14987
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014988verify [none|optional|required]
14989 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
14990 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
14991 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
14992 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
14993 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014994 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
14995 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
14996 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
14997 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014998
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200149995.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010015000------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015001
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010015002The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
15003which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
15004arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
15005settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
15006after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
15007Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
15008address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015009
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015010 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010015011 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015012
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015013Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
15014keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
15015
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015016The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015017
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015018addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015019 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010015020 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
15021 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
15022 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
15023 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
15024 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015025
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015026agent-check
15027 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015028 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010015029 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
15030 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
15031 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015032
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015033 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015034 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015035 weight of a server as configured when HAProxy starts. Note that a zero
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020015036 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
15037 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015038
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015039 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
15040 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
15041 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
15042 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
15043 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020015044
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015045 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015046 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015047
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015048 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
15049 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
15050 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015051
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015052 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
15053 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
15054 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015055
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020015056 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015057 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
15058 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
15059 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
15060 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015061 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015062 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015063
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015064 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
15065 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015066
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015067 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
15068 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
15069 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
15070 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
15071 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
15072 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
15073 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
15074 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
15075 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015076
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090015077 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
15078 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015079 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
15080 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
15081 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010015082 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090015083
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015084 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015085 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015086
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070015087agent-send <string>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015088 If this option is specified, HAProxy will send the given string (verbatim)
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070015089 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
15090 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
15091 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
15092 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
15093
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015094agent-inter <delay>
15095 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
15096 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
15097
15098 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
15099 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
15100 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
15101 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
15102 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
15103 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
15104 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
15105 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
15106 of backends use the same servers.
15107
15108 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
15109
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010015110agent-addr <addr>
15111 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
15112
15113 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015114 managing status and weights of servers defined in HAProxy in case you can't
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010015115 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
15116 hostname, it will be resolved.
15117
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015118agent-port <port>
15119 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
15120
15121 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
15122
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020015123allow-0rtt
15124 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020015125 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
15126 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020015127
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010015128alpn <protocols>
15129 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
15130 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
15131 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015132 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010015133 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
15134 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
15135 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
15136 now obsolete NPN extension.
15137 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
15138 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
15139
15140 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
15141
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020015142 See also "ws" to use an alternative ALPN for websocket streams.
15143
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015144backup
15145 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
15146 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
15147 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
15148 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015149 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
15150 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015151
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015152ca-file <cafile>
15153 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15154 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020015155 server's certificate. It is possible to load a directory containing multiple
15156 CAs, in this case HAProxy will try to load every ".pem", ".crt", ".cer", and
William Lallemande4b93eb2022-05-09 09:29:00 +020015157 .crl" available in the directory, files starting with a dot are ignored.
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020015158
15159 In order to use the trusted CAs of your system, the "@system-ca" parameter
15160 could be used in place of the cafile. The location of this directory could be
15161 overwritten by setting the SSL_CERT_DIR environment variable.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015162
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015163check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020015164 This option enables health checks on a server:
15165 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
15166 considered available.
15167 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
15168 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
15169 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
15170 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
15171 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
Amaury Denoyelle7d098be2022-03-09 14:20:10 +010015172 set. This behavior is slightly different for dynamic servers, read the
15173 following paragraphs for more details.
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020015174 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
15175 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
15176 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
15177 exchanges succeed.
15178
15179 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
15180 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
15181 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
15182 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
15183 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050015184 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020015185 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
15186
Amaury Denoyelle7d098be2022-03-09 14:20:10 +010015187 Note that the implicit configuration of ssl and PROXY protocol is not
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +020015188 performed for dynamic servers. In this case, it is required to explicitly
Amaury Denoyelle7d098be2022-03-09 14:20:10 +010015189 use "check-ssl" and "check-send-proxy" when wanted, even if the check port is
15190 not overridden.
15191
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020015192 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
15193 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
15194
15195 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
15196 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
15197
15198 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
15199 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
15200 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
15201 available.
15202
15203 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
15204 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
15205 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
15206
15207 Example:
15208 # simple tcp check
15209 backend foo
15210 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
15211 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
15212 backend foo
15213 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
15214 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
15215 backend foo
15216 option tcp-check
15217 tcp-check connect
15218 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015219
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020015220check-send-proxy
15221 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
15222 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
15223 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
15224 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
15225 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
15226 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
15227 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
15228
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010015229check-alpn <protocols>
15230 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
15231 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
15232 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
15233
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020015234check-proto <name>
15235 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
15236 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
15237 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015238 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
15239 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
15240
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015241 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
15242 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
15243 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015244
15245 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
15246 directive on a server line:
15247
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015248 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015249 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
15250 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
15251 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
15252
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015253 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020015254 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
15255 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
15256
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010015257check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020015258 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010015259 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
15260 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020015261
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015262check-ssl
15263 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
15264 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
15265 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
15266 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015267 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015268 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
15269 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015270 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015271 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
15272 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015273
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015274check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015275 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015276 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
15277 for normal traffic.
15278
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015279ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020015280 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
15281 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
15282 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000015283 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
15284 information and recommendations see e.g.
15285 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
15286 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
15287 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015288
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020015289ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
15290 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
15291 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
15292 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
15293 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000015294 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
15295 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
15296 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020015297
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015298cookie <value>
15299 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
15300 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
15301 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
15302 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
15303 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
15304 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
15305 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
15306
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015307crl-file <crlfile>
15308 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15309 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
15310 to verify server's certificate.
15311
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020015312crt <cert>
15313 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
15314 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
15315 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
15316 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
15317 certificate request.
15318
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +020015319 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load the key
15320 at the same path suffixed by a ".key" (provided the "ssl-load-extra-files"
15321 option is set accordingly).
15322
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020015323disabled
15324 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
15325 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
15326 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
15327 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
15328 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015329 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020015330
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015331enabled
15332 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
15333 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
15334 default value.
15335 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
15336 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020015337
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015338error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010015339 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
15340 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
15341 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015342
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015343 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015344
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015345fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015346 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
15347 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
15348 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
15349
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015350force-sslv3
15351 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
15352 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015353 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015354 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015355
15356force-tlsv10
15357 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015358 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015359 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015360
15361force-tlsv11
15362 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015363 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015364 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015365
15366force-tlsv12
15367 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015368 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015369 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015370
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015371force-tlsv13
15372 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
15373 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015374 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015375
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015376id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020015377 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
15378 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
15379 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015380
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010015381init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
15382 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
15383 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015384 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010015385 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
15386 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
15387 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
15388 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
15389 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
15390 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
15391 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
15392 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
15393 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015394 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010015395 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
15396 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
15397 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
15398 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
15399 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
15400 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015401 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010015402
15403 Example:
15404 defaults
15405 # never fail on address resolution
15406 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
15407
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015408inter <delay>
15409fastinter <delay>
15410downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015411 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
15412 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
15413 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
15414 between checks depending on the server state :
15415
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020015416 Server state | Interval used
15417 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
15418 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
15419 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
15420 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
15421 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
15422 or yet unchecked. |
15423 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
15424 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
15425 | "inter" otherwise.
15426 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015427
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015428 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
15429 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
15430 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
15431 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015432 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
15433 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
15434 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
15435 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
15436 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015437
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020015438log-proto <logproto>
15439 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
15440 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
15441 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
15442 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
15443
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015444maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015445 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
15446 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010015447 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
15448 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015449 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
15450 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
15451 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
15452 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
15453
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010015454 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
15455 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
15456 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
15457 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
15458 than 50 concurrent requests.
15459
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015460maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015461 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
15462 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
15463 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
15464 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020015465 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
15466 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
15467 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
15468 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
15469 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
15470 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
15471 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015472
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010015473max-reuse <count>
15474 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
15475 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
15476 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
15477 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
15478 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
15479 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
15480 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
15481 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
15482
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015483minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015484 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
15485 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
15486 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
15487 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
15488 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
15489 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015490 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015491 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015492
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020015493namespace <name>
15494 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
15495 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
15496 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
15497 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
15498
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015499no-agent-check
15500 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
15501 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15502 default value.
15503 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15504 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
15505
15506no-backup
15507 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
15508 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15509 default value.
15510 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15511 "default-server" "backup" setting.
15512
15513no-check
15514 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
15515 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15516 default value.
15517 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15518 "default-server" "check" setting.
15519
15520no-check-ssl
15521 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
15522 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15523 default value.
15524 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15525 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
15526
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015527no-send-proxy
15528 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
15529 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15530 default value.
15531 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15532 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
15533
15534no-send-proxy-v2
15535 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
15536 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15537 default value.
15538 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15539 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
15540
15541no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
15542 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
15543 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15544 default value.
15545 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15546 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
15547
15548no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
15549 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
15550 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15551 default value.
15552 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15553 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
15554
15555no-ssl
15556 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
15557 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15558 default value.
15559 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15560 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
15561
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010015562 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
15563 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
15564 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
15565
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010015566no-ssl-reuse
15567 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
15568 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
15569 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
15570 and for paranoid users.
15571
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015572no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015573 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
15574 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015575 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015576
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020015577 Supported in default-server: No
15578
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020015579no-tls-tickets
15580 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15581 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
15582 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015583 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
15584 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015585 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15586 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15587 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015588 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020015589
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015590no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015591 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020015592 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
15593 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015594 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
15595 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015596 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015597
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020015598 Supported in default-server: No
15599
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015600no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015601 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020015602 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
15603 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015604 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
15605 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015606 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015607
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020015608 Supported in default-server: No
15609
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015610no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015611 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015612 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
15613 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015614 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
15615 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015616 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015617
15618 Supported in default-server: No
15619
15620no-tlsv13
15621 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
15622 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
15623 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
15624 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
15625 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015626 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015627
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020015628 Supported in default-server: No
15629
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015630no-verifyhost
15631 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
15632 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15633 default value.
15634 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15635 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015636
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020015637no-tfo
15638 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
15639 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15640 default value.
15641 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15642 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
15643
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090015644non-stick
15645 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
15646 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
15647 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
15648
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010015649npn <protocols>
15650 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
15651 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
15652 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015653 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010015654 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
15655 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
15656 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
15657
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015658observe <mode>
15659 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
15660 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
15661 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
15662 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
15663 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
15664 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010015665 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015666
15667 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
15668
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015669on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015670 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
15671 Currently, four modes are available:
15672 - fastinter: force fastinter
15673 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
15674 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
15675 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
15676 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
15677
15678 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
15679
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090015680on-marked-down <action>
15681 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
15682 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015683 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
15684 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
15685 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
15686 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
15687 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
15688 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
15689 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
15690 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090015691
15692 Actions are disabled by default
15693
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015694on-marked-up <action>
15695 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
15696 Currently one action is available:
15697 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
15698 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
15699 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
15700 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015701 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
15702 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015703 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
15704 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
15705
15706 Actions are disabled by default
15707
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020015708pool-low-conn <max>
15709 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
15710 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
15711 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
15712 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
15713 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
15714 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
15715 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
15716 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
15717 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
15718 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010015719 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
15720 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
15721 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
15722 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020015723
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010015724pool-max-conn <max>
15725 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
15726 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
15727 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
15728 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
15729 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
15730 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
15731
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010015732pool-purge-delay <delay>
15733 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010015734 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020015735 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010015736
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015737port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015738 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010015739 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
15740 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
15741 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
15742 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
15743 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015744
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020015745proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020015746 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
15747 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
15748 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015749 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
15750 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
15751
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015752 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
15753 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
15754 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015755
15756 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
15757 a server line :
15758
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015759 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015760 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
15761 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
15762 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
15763
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015764 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020015765 protocol for all connections established to this server.
15766
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020015767 See also "ws" to use an alternative protocol for websocket streams.
15768
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015769redir <prefix>
15770 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
15771 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
15772 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
15773 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
15774 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
15775 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
15776 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
15777 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015778 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015779 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015780 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
15781 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
15782 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
15783 loop between the client and HAProxy!
15784
15785 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
15786
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015787rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015788 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
15789 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
15790 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
15791
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020015792resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
15793 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
15794 server.
15795
15796 Available options:
15797
15798 * allow-dup-ip
15799 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
15800 resolution at runtime is in operation.
15801 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
15802 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
15803 For such case, simply enable this option.
15804 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
15805
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050015806 * ignore-weight
15807 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
15808 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
15809 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
15810
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020015811 * prevent-dup-ip
15812 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
15813 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
15814 same fqdn.
15815 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
15816
15817 Example:
15818 backend b_myapp
15819 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
15820 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
15821 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
15822
15823 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
15824 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
15825 it
15826 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
15827 different address
15828
15829 Default value: not set
15830
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015831resolve-prefer <family>
15832 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
15833 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
15834 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
15835 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
15836
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020015837 Default value: ipv6
15838
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015839 Example:
15840
15841 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015842
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010015843resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015844 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010015845 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015846 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015847 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
15848 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010015849 configured network, another address is selected.
15850
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015851 Example:
15852
15853 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010015854
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015855resolvers <id>
15856 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
15857 hostname.
15858
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015859 Example:
15860
15861 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015862
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015863 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015864
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010015865send-proxy
15866 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
15867 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
15868 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
15869 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015870 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
15871 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
15872 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
15873 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015874 fully be chained to another instance of HAProxy listening with an
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015875 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
15876 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
15877 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
15878 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
15879 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015880 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
15881 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010015882
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015883send-proxy-v2
15884 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
15885 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
15886 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
15887 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020015888 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
15889 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
15890 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
15891 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015892
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010015893proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010015894 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
15895 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
15896
15897 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
15898 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
15899 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
15900 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
15901 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
15902 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
15903 connection is supported).
15904 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
15905 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
15906 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
15907 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
15908 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
15909 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
15910 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010015911
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015912send-proxy-v2-ssl
15913 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
15914 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
15915 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
15916 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
15917 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
15918 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
15919 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015920 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
15921 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015922
15923send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
15924 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
15925 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
15926 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
15927 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
15928 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
15929 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
15930 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
15931 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015932 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
15933 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015934
Frédéric Lécaille36d15652022-10-17 14:58:19 +020015935shard <shard>
15936 This parameter in used only in the context of stick-tables synchronisation
15937 with peers protocol. The "shard" parameter identifies the peers which will
15938 receive all the stick-table updates for keys with this shard as distribution
15939 hash. The accepted values are 0 up to "shards" parameter value specified in
15940 the "peers" section. 0 value is the default value meaning that the peer will
15941 receive all the key updates. Greater values than "shards" will be ignored.
15942 This is also the case for any value provided to the local peer.
15943
15944 Example :
15945
15946 peers mypeers
15947 shards 3
15948 peer A 127.0.0.1:40001 # local peer without shard value (0 internally)
15949 peer B 127.0.0.1:40002 shard 1
15950 peer C 127.0.0.1:40003 shard 2
15951 peer D 127.0.0.1:40004 shard 3
15952
15953
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015954slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015955 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
15956 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
15957 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
15958 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
15959 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
15960 parameters :
15961
15962 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
15963 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
15964
15965 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
15966 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
15967 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
15968 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
15969
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015970 The slowstart never applies when HAProxy starts, otherwise it would cause
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015971 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
15972 seen as failed.
15973
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015974sni <expression>
15975 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
15976 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
15977 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
Willy Tarreaud26fb572022-11-25 10:12:12 +010015978 a bridged TCP/SSL scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
15979 expression. THIS MUST NOT BE USED FOR HTTPS, where req.hdr(host) should be
15980 used instead, since SNI in HTTPS must always match the Host field and clients
15981 are allowed to use different host names over the same connection). If
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020015982 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015983 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010015984 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
15985 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015986
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015987source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020015988source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015989source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015990 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
15991 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
15992 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
15993 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
15994
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015995 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
15996 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
15997 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
15998 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
15999 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
16000 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
16001 server.
16002
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000016003 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
16004 specifying the source address without port(s).
16005
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016006ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020016007 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
16008 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
16009 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
16010 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
16011 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
16012 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016013 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
16014 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020016015
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016016ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
16017 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
16018 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
16019 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
16020
16021ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
16022 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
16023 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
16024 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
16025
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016026ssl-reuse
16027 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
16028 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16029 default value.
16030 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16031 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
16032
16033stick
16034 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
16035 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16036 default value.
16037 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16038 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016039
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080016040socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016041 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080016042 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
16043 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
16044
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020016045tcp-ut <delay>
16046 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016047 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows HAProxy to
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020016048 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016049 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020016050 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
16051 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
16052 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
16053 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
16054 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
16055 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
16056 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
16057 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
16058 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
16059
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010016060tfo
16061 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
16062 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
16063 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
16064 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016065 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or HAProxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020016066 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010016067
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016068track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020016069 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
16070 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
16071 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
16072 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016073 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
16074
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016075tls-tickets
16076 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
16077 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16078 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010016079 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
16080 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
16081 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016082 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010016083 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016084
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020016085verify [none|required]
16086 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010016087 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020016088 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
16089 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016090 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020016091 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
16092 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
16093 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
16094 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
16095 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
16096 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
16097 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
16098 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020016099
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070016100verifyhost <hostname>
16101 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020016102 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
16103 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
16104 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
16105 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
16106 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
16107 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
16108 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
16109 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070016110
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016111weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016112 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
16113 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
16114 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020016115 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
16116 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
16117 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
16118 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
16119 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
16120 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016121
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020016122ws { auto | h1 | h2 }
16123 This option allows to configure the protocol used when relaying websocket
16124 streams. This is most notably useful when using an HTTP/2 backend without the
16125 support for H2 websockets through the RFC8441.
16126
16127 The default mode is "auto". This will reuse the same protocol as the main
16128 one. The only difference is when using ALPN. In this case, it can try to
16129 downgrade the ALPN to "http/1.1" only for websocket streams if the configured
16130 server ALPN contains it.
16131
16132 The value "h1" is used to force HTTP/1.1 for websockets streams, through ALPN
16133 if SSL ALPN is activated for the server. Similarly, "h2" can be used to
16134 force HTTP/2.0 websockets. Use this value with care : the server must support
16135 RFC8441 or an error will be reported by haproxy when relaying websockets.
16136
16137 Note that NPN is not taken into account as its usage has been deprecated in
16138 favor of the ALPN extension.
16139
16140 See also "alpn" and "proto".
16141
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016142
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200161435.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
16144-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016145
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016146HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
16147using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070016148configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016149This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
16150can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
16151workload.
16152This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
16153resolution at run time.
16154Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
16155carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
16156
16157
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200161585.3.1. Global overview
16159----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016160
16161As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
16162different steps of the process life:
16163
16164 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
16165 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
16166 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
16167
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016168 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
16169 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016170
16171A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
16172 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
16173 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
16174 resolution to know this new IP.
16175
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016176When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016177HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016178SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
16179from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016180will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, HAProxy
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016181will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020016182
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016183A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016184 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016185 first valid response.
16186
16187 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
16188 servers return an error.
16189
16190
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200161915.3.2. The resolvers section
16192----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016193
16194This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016195HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
16196contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016197
William Lallemandc33df2e2022-05-06 17:14:00 +020016198At startup, HAProxy tries to generate a resolvers section named "default", if
16199no section was named this way in the configuration. This section is used by
16200default by the httpclient and uses the parse-resolv-conf keyword. If HAProxy
16201failed to generate automatically this section, no error or warning are emitted.
16202
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016203When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
16204uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
16205is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
16206answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
16207
16208When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016209used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016210
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016211 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
16212 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
16213 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016214
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016215 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
16216 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016217
Thierry Fournier55c40ea2021-12-15 19:03:52 +010016218 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retries> times. If no valid
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016219 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
16220 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016221
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016222For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
16223following scenarios are possible:
16224
16225 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
16226 ignored
16227
16228 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
16229 applied
16230
16231 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
16232 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
16233
16234 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
16235 retries the query with a new type
16236
16237 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
16238 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016239
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016240As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, HAProxy keeps
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020016241a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016242<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020016243
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016244
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016245resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016246 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016247
16248A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
16249
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020016250accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016251 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016252 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020016253 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
16254 by RFC 6891)
16255
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010016256 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
16257 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
16258 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
16259 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
16260 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
16261 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020016262
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020016263nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
16264 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
16265 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
16266 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
16267 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
16268 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
16269 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
16270 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
16271 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
16272 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010016273 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
16274
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060016275parse-resolv-conf
16276 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
16277 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
16278 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
16279
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016280hold <status> <period>
16281 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
16282 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010016283 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020016284 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016285 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
16286 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
16287 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
16288
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020016289 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016290
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016291resolve_retries <nb>
16292 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
16293 giving up.
16294 Default value: 3
16295
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016296 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
16297 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
16298 type.
16299
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016300timeout <event> <time>
16301 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
16302 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
16303 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016304 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
16305 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016306 Default value: 1s
16307 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016308 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016309 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016310 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
16311 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
16312
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020016313 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016314
16315 resolvers mydns
16316 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
16317 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020016318 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060016319 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016320 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016321 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016322 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010016323 hold other 30s
16324 hold refused 30s
16325 hold nx 30s
16326 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016327 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020016328 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016329
16330
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200163316. Cache
16332---------
16333
16334HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
16335(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
16336RAM.
16337
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020016338The cache is based on a memory area shared between all threads, and split in 1kB
16339blocks.
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020016340
16341If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
16342independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
16343when we try to allocate a new one.
16344
16345The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
16346
16347It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
16348"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
16349for more details.
16350
16351When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
16352replaced by "<CACHE>".
16353
16354
163556.1. Limitation
16356----------------
16357
16358The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
16359
16360- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010016361- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
16362 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
16363 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020016364- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
16365- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010016366- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
16367 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
16368 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010016369- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
16370 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010016371- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
16372 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
16373 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020016374
16375- If the request is not a GET
16376- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
16377- If the request contains an Authorization header
16378
16379
163806.2. Setup
16381-----------
16382
16383To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
16384the corresponding http-request and response actions.
16385
16386
163876.2.1. Cache section
16388---------------------
16389
16390cache <name>
16391 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
16392 size of cache is mandatory.
16393
16394total-max-size <megabytes>
16395 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
16396 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
16397
16398max-object-size <bytes>
16399 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
16400 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
16401 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
16402
16403max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010016404 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020016405 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
16406 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
16407 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
16408 default.
16409
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010016410process-vary <on/off>
16411 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010016412 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
16413 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
16414 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010016415 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010016416
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010016417max-secondary-entries <number>
16418 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
16419 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
16420 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
16421
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020016422
164236.2.2. Proxy section
16424---------------------
16425
16426http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
16427 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
16428 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
16429 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
16430 after this one.
16431
16432http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
16433 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
16434 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
16435 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
16436 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
16437
16438
16439Example:
16440
16441 backend bck1
16442 mode http
16443
16444 http-request cache-use foobar
16445 http-response cache-store foobar
16446 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
16447
16448 cache foobar
16449 total-max-size 4
16450 max-age 240
16451
16452
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200164537. Using ACLs and fetching samples
16454----------------------------------
16455
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016456HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016457client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
16458The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
16459these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
16460but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
16461data called patterns.
16462
16463
164647.1. ACL basics
16465---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016466
16467The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
16468content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
16469from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
16470simple :
16471
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016472 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016473 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016474 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
16475 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016477The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
16478adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016479
16480In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
16481
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016482 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016483
16484This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
16485Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
16486and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016487an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
16488conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
16489as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
16490are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016491
16492ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
16493'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
16494which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
16495
16496There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
16497performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
16498
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016499The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
16500specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
16501this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016502methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
16503ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016504
16505Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
16506 - boolean
16507 - integer (signed or unsigned)
16508 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
16509 - string
16510 - data block
16511
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016512Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
16513converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
16514would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
16515The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
16516which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
16517
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016518Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
16519keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
16520fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
16521which are summarized in the table below :
16522
16523 +---------------------+-----------------+
16524 | Sample or converter | Default |
16525 | output type | matching method |
16526 +---------------------+-----------------+
16527 | boolean | bool |
16528 +---------------------+-----------------+
16529 | integer | int |
16530 +---------------------+-----------------+
16531 | ip | ip |
16532 +---------------------+-----------------+
16533 | string | str |
16534 +---------------------+-----------------+
16535 | binary | none, use "-m" |
16536 +---------------------+-----------------+
16537
16538Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
16539matching method, see below.
16540
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016541The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
16542 - boolean
16543 - integer or integer range
16544 - IP address / network
16545 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
16546 - regular expression
16547 - hex block
16548
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016549The following ACL flags are currently supported :
16550
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020016551 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
16552 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016553 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010016554 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010016555 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010016556 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016557 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
16558
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016559The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
16560read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
16561if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
16562lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
16563will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
16564beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016565a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, HAProxy may load the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016566lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
16567exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
16568
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010016569The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
16570parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
16571ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
16572a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
16573check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
16574
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010016575The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
16576socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
16577file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
16578
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016579Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
16580loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
16581
16582 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
16583
16584In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
16585the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
16586case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
16587as well.
16588
16589The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
16590sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
16591do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
16592methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
16593is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016594obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016595followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
16596default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
16597that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
16598string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
16599
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010016600The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
16601By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
16602string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
16603resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016604server is not reachable, the HAProxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016605waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010016606flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
16607function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
16608
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016609There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
16610sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
16611be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016612
16613 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
16614 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016615 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
16616 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
16617 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
16618 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016619
16620 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
16621 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016622 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016623
16624 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016625 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016626
16627 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016628 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016629
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016630 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016631 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
16632
16633 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
16634 binary or string samples.
16635
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016636 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
16637 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016639 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
16640 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
16641 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016642
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016643 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
16644 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016645
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016646 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
16647 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016649 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
16650 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016652 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
16653 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016654 This may be used with binary or string samples.
16655
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016656 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
16657 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
16658 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016659
16660For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
16661request, it is possible to do :
16662
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016663 acl jsess_present req.cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016664
16665In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
16666buffer, one would use the following acl :
16667
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016668 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016669
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016670On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
16671possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
16672
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016673 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016675All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
16676criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
16677method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
Willy Tarreau4f4fea42022-11-25 10:49:41 +010016678to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. This matching method is only
16679usable when the keyword is used alone, without any converter. In case any such
16680converter were to be applied after such an ACL keyword, the default matching
16681method from the ACL keyword is simply ignored since what will matter for the
16682matching is the output type of the last converter. Since all ACL-specific
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016683criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
16684the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020016685
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016686If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016687the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
16688For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020016689
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016690 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
16691 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
16692 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
16693 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020016694
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020016695
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016696The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
16697types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
16698combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
16699brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
16700default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016701
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016702 +-------------------------------------------------+
16703 | Input sample type |
16704 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016705 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016706 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
16707 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
16708 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016709 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016710 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016711 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016712 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016713 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016714 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016715 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016716 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016717 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016718 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016719 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016720 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016721 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016722 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016723 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016724 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016725 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016726 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016727 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016728 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016729 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016730 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
16731 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
16732 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016733
16734
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200167357.1.1. Matching booleans
16736------------------------
16737
16738In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
16739Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
16740When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
16741that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
16742
16743Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
16744return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
16745"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
16746
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016747
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200167487.1.2. Matching integers
16749------------------------
16750
16751Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
16752enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
16753to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
16754
16755Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
16756matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
16757lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016758
16759For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
16760unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
16761representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
16762
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016763As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
16764two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
16765instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
16766ranges and operators.
16767
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016768For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016769operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
16770Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
16771of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016772
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016773Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016774
16775 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
16776 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
16777 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
16778 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
16779 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
16780
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016781For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016782
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016783 acl negative-length req.hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016784
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016785This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
16786
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016787 acl sslv3 req.ssl_ver 3:3.1
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016788
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016789
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200167907.1.3. Matching strings
16791-----------------------
16792
16793String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
16794different forms :
16795
16796 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016797 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016798
16799 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016800 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016801
16802 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
16803 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
16804
16805 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
16806 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
16807
Willy Tarreauf386a2d2022-11-25 12:02:25 +010016808 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up anywhere inside the
16809 extracted string, delimited with slashes ("/"), the beginning or the end
16810 of the string. The ACL matches if any of them matches. As such, the string
16811 "/images/png/logo/32x32.png", would match "/images", "/images/png",
16812 "images/png", "/png/logo", "logo/32x32.png" or "32x32.png" but not "png"
16813 nor "32x32".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016814
Willy Tarreauf386a2d2022-11-25 12:02:25 +010016815 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up anywhere inside the
16816 extracted string, delimited with dots ("."), colons (":"), slashes ("/"),
16817 question marks ("?"), the beginning or the end of the string. This is made
16818 to be used with URLs. Leading and trailing delimiters in the pattern are
16819 ignored. The ACL matches if any of them matches. As such, in the example
16820 string "http://www1.dc-eu.example.com:80/blah", the patterns "http",
16821 "www1", ".www1", "dc-eu", "example", "com", "80", "dc-eu.example",
16822 "blah", ":www1:", "dc-eu.example:80" would match, but not "eu" nor "dc".
16823 Using it to match domain suffixes for filtering or routing is generally
16824 not a good idea, as the routing could easily be fooled by prepending the
16825 matching prefix in front of another domain for example.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016826
16827String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
16828exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
16829characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
16830string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
16831to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016832before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016833
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010016834Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
16835(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
16836Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
16837
16838Example:
16839 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
16840 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
16841
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016842
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200168437.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
16844---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016845
16846Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
16847they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
16848possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
16849passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
16850the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016851the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
16852match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016853
16854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200168557.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
16856-------------------------------------
16857
16858It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
16859not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
16860a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
16861to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
16862digits may be used upper or lower case.
16863
16864Example :
16865 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016866 acl hello req.payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016867
16868
168697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
16870---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016871
16872IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
16873netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
16874within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010016875host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016876difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
16877at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
16878does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
16879parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016880
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020016881The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
16882abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
16883
16884 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
16885 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
16886 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
16887 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
16888 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
16889 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
16890 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
16891 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
16892
16893Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
16894192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
16895
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020016896IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
16897Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
16898trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
16899IPv6 patterns.
16900
16901HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
16902following situations :
16903 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
16904 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
16905 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
16906 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
16907 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
16908 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
16909 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
16910 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
16911 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
16912 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
16913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016914
169157.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
16916----------------------------------
16917
16918Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
16919combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
16920
16921 - AND (implicit)
16922 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
16923 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016924
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016925A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016926
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016927 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020016928
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016929Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
16930indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020016931
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016932For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
16933"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
16934requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
16935is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
16936
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016937 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016938 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
16939 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
16940 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016941
16942To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
16943and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
16944
16945 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
16946 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
16947 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
16948 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
16949
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016950 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016951 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
16952 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
16953 use_backend www if host_www
16954
16955It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
16956expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
16957be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
16958the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
16959
16960 The following rule :
16961
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016962 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016963 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016964
16965 Can also be written that way :
16966
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016967 http-request deny if METH_POST { req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016968
16969It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
16970to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
16971simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
16972sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
16973good use is the following :
16974
16975 With named ACLs :
16976
16977 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
16978 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
16979 monitor fail if site_dead
16980
16981 With anonymous ACLs :
16982
16983 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
16984
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016985See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
16986keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016987
16988
169897.3. Fetching samples
16990---------------------
16991
16992Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
16993against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
16994sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
16995ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
16996of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
16997available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
16998
16999This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
17000Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
17001compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
17002deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
17003
17004The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
17005matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
17006method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
17007indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
17008
17009As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
17010when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
17011mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
17012the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
17013ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
17014
17015Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
17016multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
17017when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017018incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
17019are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017020is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
17021all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
17022
17023Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
17024 - name
17025 - name(arg1)
17026 - name(arg1,arg2)
17027
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017028
170297.3.1. Converters
17030-----------------
17031
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017032Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
17033of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
17034is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
17035was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017036has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017037unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
17038
17039These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
17040sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
17041the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017042support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017043
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017044A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
17045support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
17046supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
17047(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
17048bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
17049
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017050The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017051
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001705251d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
17053 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
17054 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
17055 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
17056 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
17057 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
17058
17059 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017060 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
17061 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000017062 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
17063 frontend http-in
17064 bind *:8081
17065 default_backend servers
17066 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
17067 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
17068
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017069add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017070 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017071 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017072 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
17073 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017074 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017075 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17076 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
17077 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
17078 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017079 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017080 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017081
Nikola Sale0dbf0382022-04-03 18:11:53 +020017082add_item(<delim>,[<var>][,<suff>]])
17083 Concatenates a minimum of 2 and up to 3 fields after the current sample which
17084 is then turned into a string. The first one, <delim>, is a constant string,
17085 that will be appended immediately after the existing sample if an existing
17086 sample is not empty and either the <var> or the <suff> is not empty. The
17087 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
17088 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after
17089 the <delim> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It is
17090 optional and may optionally be followed by a constant string <suff>, however
17091 if <var> is omitted, then <suff> is mandatory. This converter is similar to
17092 the concat converter and can be used to build new variables made of a
17093 succession of other variables but the main difference is that it does the
17094 checks if adding a delimiter makes sense as wouldn't be the case if e.g. the
17095 current sample is empty. That situation would require 2 separate rules using
17096 concat converter where the first rule would have to check if the current
17097 sample string is empty before adding a delimiter. If commas or closing
17098 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
17099 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
Willy Tarreaub143d112022-11-25 09:27:15 +010017100 level parser (please see section 2.2 for quoting and escaping). See examples
17101 below.
Nikola Sale0dbf0382022-04-03 18:11:53 +020017102
17103 Example:
17104 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score1,"(site1)") if src,in_table(site1)'
17105 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score2,"(site2)") if src,in_table(site2)'
17106 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score3,"(site3)") if src,in_table(site3)'
17107 http-request set-header x-tagged %[var(req.tagged)]
17108
17109 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score1),add_item(",",req.score2)'
17110 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",,(site1))' if src,in_table(site1)
17111
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010017112aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
17113 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
17114 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
17115 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
17116 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
17117 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
17118 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
17119
17120 Example:
17121 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
17122 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
17123
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017124and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017125 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017126 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017127 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
17128 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017129 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017130 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17131 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
17132 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
17133 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017134 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017135 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017136
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020017137b64dec
17138 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
17139 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017140 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
17141 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020017142
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020017143base64
17144 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017145 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017146 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
17147 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020017148
Marcin Deranek40ca09c2021-07-13 14:05:24 +020017149be2dec(<separator>,<chunk_size>,[<truncate>])
17150 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a string containing an unsigned
17151 integer number per <chunk_size> input bytes. <separator> is put every
17152 <chunk_size> binary input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates
17153 whatever binary input is truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries. <chunk_size>
17154 maximum value is limited by the size of long long int (8 bytes).
17155
17156 Example:
17157 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(:,2) # 258:772:1286:7
17158 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(-,2,1) # 258-772-1286
17159 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(,2,1) # 2587721286
17160 bin(7f000001),be2dec(.,1) # 127.0.0.1
17161
Marcin Deranekda0264a2021-07-13 14:08:56 +020017162be2hex([<separator>],[<chunk_size>],[<truncate>])
17163 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex
17164 digits per input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some
17165 binary input data in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID
17166 can be copied in a header). <separator> is put every <chunk_size> binary
17167 input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates whatever binary input is
17168 truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries.
17169
17170 Example:
17171 bin(01020304050607),be2hex # 01020304050607
17172 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(:,2) # 0102:0304:0506:07
17173 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(--,2,1) # 0102--0304--0506
17174 bin(0102030405060708),be2hex(,3,1) # 010203040506
17175
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017176bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017177 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017178 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017179 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017180 presence of a flag).
17181
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010017182bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
17183 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
17184 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017185 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010017186
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010017187concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
17188 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
17189 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
17190 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
17191 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
17192 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
17193 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
17194 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
17195 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
17196 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
17197 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010017198 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040017199 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010017200 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020017201 level parser. This is often used to build composite variables from other
17202 ones, but sometimes using a format string with multiple fields may be more
17203 convenient. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010017204
17205 Example:
17206 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
17207 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
17208 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010017209 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020017210 tcp-request session set-var-fmt(txn.ipport) "addr=(%[sess.ip],%[sess.port])" ## does the same
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010017211 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
17212
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017213cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017214 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
17215 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017216
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010017217crc32([<avalanche>])
17218 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
17219 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17220 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17221 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17222 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17223 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
17224 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
17225 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
17226 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
17227 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017228 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
17229
17230crc32c([<avalanche>])
17231 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
17232 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17233 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17234 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
17235 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
17236 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
17237 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
17238 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010017239
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020017240cut_crlf
17241 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
17242 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
17243 updated.
17244
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010017245da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020017246 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
17247 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
17248 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
17249 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017250 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the HAProxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020017251 configuration language.
17252
17253 Example:
17254 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020017255 bind *:8881
17256 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000017257 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020017258
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010017259debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
17260 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
17261 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
17262 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
17263 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
17264 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
17265 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
17266 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
17267 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
17268 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
17269 printable sample types.
17270
17271 Example:
17272 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020017273
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020017274digest(<algorithm>)
17275 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
17276 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
17277
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017278 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020017279 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17280
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017281div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017282 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
17283 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017284 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017285 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
17286 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017287 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017288 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17289 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
17290 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
17291 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017292 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017293 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017294
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017295djb2([<avalanche>])
17296 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
17297 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17298 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17299 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17300 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17301 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17302 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017303 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
17304 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017305
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017306even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017307 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017308 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
17309
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017310field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
17311 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
17312 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
17313 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
17314 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
17315 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
17316 fields.
17317
17318 Example :
17319 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
17320 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
17321 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
17322 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
17323 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010017324
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020017325fix_is_valid
17326 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
17327 Information eXchange):
17328
17329 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
17330 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050017331 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020017332 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010017333 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020017334 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
17335 checksum
17336
17337 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
17338 the server can be parsed.
17339
17340 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
17341 message, false if not.
17342
17343 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
17344
17345 Example:
17346 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17347 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
17348
17349fix_tag_value(<tag>)
17350 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
17351 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
17352 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
17353 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050017354 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020017355 added.
17356
17357 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
17358 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
17359 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
17360 fix_is_valid converter.
17361
17362 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
17363
17364 Example:
17365 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17366 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
17367 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
17368 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
17369 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
17370
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017371hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017372 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017373 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017374 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017375 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010017376
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020017377hex2i
17378 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017379 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020017380
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020017381htonl
17382 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
17383 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
17384 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
17385 unsigned 32-bit integer.
17386
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010017387hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020017388 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
17389 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
17390 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
17391 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
17392
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017393 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020017394 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17395
William Lallemanddd754cb2022-08-26 16:21:28 +020017396host_only
17397 Converts a string which contains a Host header value and removes its port.
17398 The input must respect the format of the host header value
17399 (rfc9110#section-7.2). It will support that kind of input: hostname,
17400 hostname:80, 127.0.0.1, 127.0.0.1:80, [::1], [::1]:80.
17401
17402 This converter also sets the string in lowercase.
17403
17404 See also: "port_only" converter which will return the port.
17405
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010017406http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017407 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
17408 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017409 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
17410 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
17411 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
17412 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
17413 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
17414 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
17415 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
17416 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017417
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020017418iif(<true>,<false>)
17419 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
17420 string otherwise.
17421
17422 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020017423 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020017424
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017425in_table(<table>)
17426 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17427 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
17428 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017429 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017430 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
17431
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010017432ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010017433 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017434 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010017435 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
17436 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
17437 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
17438 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
17439 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017440
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017441json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017442 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017443 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020017444 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017445 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
17446 of errors:
17447 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
17448 bytes, ...)
17449 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
17450 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
17451
17452 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
17453 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
17454 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
17455 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
17456 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
17457 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017458 - "ascii" : never fails;
17459 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
17460 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017461 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017462 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017463 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
17464 characters corresponding to the other errors.
17465
17466 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017467 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017468
17469 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017470 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020017471 capture request header user-agent len 150
17472 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017473
17474 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
17475 GET / HTTP/1.0
17476 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
17477
17478 Output log:
17479 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
17480
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020017481json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
17482 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
17483 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
17484 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
17485 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
17486
17487 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
17488 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
17489
17490 Example:
17491 # get a integer value from the request body
17492 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
17493 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
17494
17495 # get a key with '.' in the name
17496 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
17497 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
17498
17499 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
17500 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
17501
17502 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
17503 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
17504
Remi Tricot-Le Breton0a72f5e2021-10-01 15:36:57 +020017505jwt_header_query([<json_path>],[<output_type>])
17506 When given a JSON Web Token (JWT) in input, either returns the decoded header
17507 part of the token (the first base64-url encoded part of the JWT) if no
17508 parameter is given, or performs a json_query on the decoded header part of
17509 the token. See "json_query" converter for details about the accepted
17510 json_path and output_type parameters.
17511
17512 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
17513 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17514
17515jwt_payload_query([<json_path>],[<output_type>])
17516 When given a JSON Web Token (JWT) in input, either returns the decoded
17517 payload part of the token (the second base64-url encoded part of the JWT) if
17518 no parameter is given, or performs a json_query on the decoded payload part
17519 of the token. See "json_query" converter for details about the accepted
17520 json_path and output_type parameters.
17521
17522 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
17523 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17524
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020017525jwt_verify(<alg>,<key>)
17526 Performs a signature verification for the JSON Web Token (JWT) given in input
17527 by using the <alg> algorithm and the <key> parameter, which should either
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020017528 hold a secret or a path to a public certificate. Returns 1 in case of
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020017529 verification success, 0 in case of verification error and a strictly negative
17530 value for any other error. Because of all those non-null error return values,
17531 the result of this converter should never be converted to a boolean. See
17532 below for a full list of the possible return values.
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020017533
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020017534 For now, only JWS tokens using the Compact Serialization format can be
17535 processed (three dot-separated base64-url encoded strings). Among the
17536 accepted algorithms for a JWS (see section 3.1 of RFC7518), the PSXXX ones
17537 are not managed yet.
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020017538
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020017539 If the used algorithm is of the HMAC family, <key> should be the secret used
17540 in the HMAC signature calculation. Otherwise, <key> should be the path to the
17541 public certificate that can be used to validate the token's signature. All
17542 the certificates that might be used to verify JWTs must be known during init
17543 in order to be added into a dedicated certificate cache so that no disk
17544 access is required during runtime. For this reason, any used certificate must
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +050017545 be mentioned explicitly at least once in a jwt_verify call. Passing an
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020017546 intermediate variable as second parameter is then not advised.
17547
17548 This converter only verifies the signature of the token and does not perform
17549 a full JWT validation as specified in section 7.2 of RFC7519. We do not
17550 ensure that the header and payload contents are fully valid JSON's once
17551 decoded for instance, and no checks are performed regarding their respective
17552 contents.
17553
17554 The possible return values are the following :
17555
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020017556 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
17557 | ID | message |
17558 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020017559 | 0 | "Verification failure" |
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +050017560 | 1 | "Verification success" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020017561 | -1 | "Unknown algorithm (not mentioned in RFC7518)" |
17562 | -2 | "Unmanaged algorithm (PSXXX algorithm family)" |
17563 | -3 | "Invalid token" |
17564 | -4 | "Out of memory" |
17565 | -5 | "Unknown certificate" |
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020017566 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020017567
17568 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
17569 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17570
17571 Example:
17572 # Get a JWT from the authorization header, extract the "alg" field of its
17573 # JOSE header and use a public certificate to verify a signature
17574 http-request set-var(txn.bearer) http_auth_bearer
17575 http-request set-var(txn.jwt_alg) var(txn.bearer),jwt_header_query('$.alg')
17576 http-request deny unless { var(txn.jwt_alg) "RS256" }
17577 http-request deny unless { var(txn.bearer),jwt_verify(txn.jwt_alg,"/path/to/crt.pem") 1 }
17578
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017579language(<value>[,<default>])
17580 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
17581 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
17582 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
17583 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
17584 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
17585 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
17586 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
17587 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
17588 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017589 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017590 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
17591 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020017592
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017593 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020017594
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017595 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
17596 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020017597
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017598 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
17599 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
17600 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
17601 use_backend spanish if es
17602 use_backend french if fr
17603 use_backend english if en
17604 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020017605
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010017606length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010017607 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
17608 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
17609 type. The result is of type integer.
17610
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017611lower
17612 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
17613 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
17614 type. The result is of type string.
17615
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017616ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
17617 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
17618 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
17619 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
17620 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
17621 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
17622 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
17623
17624 Example :
17625
17626 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017627 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017628 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
17629
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020017630ltrim(<chars>)
17631 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
17632 representation of the input sample.
17633
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017634map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
17635map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
17636map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
17637 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
17638 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
17639 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
17640 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
17641 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
17642 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
17643 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
17644 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017645
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017646 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
17647 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
17648 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017649
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017650 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017651 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017652
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017653 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
17654 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17655 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
17656 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020017657 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
17658 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017659 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
17660 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17661 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
17662 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17663 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
17664 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17665 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
17666 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080017667 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
17668 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17669 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017670 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17671 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
17672 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17673 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
17674 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017675
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010017676 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
17677 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
17678 the corresponding match text.
17679
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017680 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
17681 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
17682 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
17683 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
17684 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017685
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017686 Example :
17687
17688 # this is a comment and is ignored
17689 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
17690 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
17691 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
17692 | | | `---------- value
17693 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
17694 | `---------------------------- key
17695 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
17696
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017697mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017698 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
17699 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017700 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017701 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017702 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017703 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17704 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
17705 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
17706 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017707 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017708 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017709
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017710mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010017711 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
17712 <packettype>.
17713 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
17714 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
17715 from.
17716 Supported string and integers can be found here:
17717 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
17718 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
17719
17720 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
17721 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
17722 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
17723 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
17724
17725 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
17726 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
17727 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
17728 packets only):
17729 17: Session Expiry Interval
17730 33: Receive Maximum
17731 39: Maximum Packet Size
17732 34: Topic Alias Maximum
17733 25: Request Response Information
17734 23: Request Problem Information
17735 21: Authentication Method
17736 22: Authentication Data
17737 18: Will Delay Interval
17738 1: Payload Format Indicator
17739 2: Message Expiry Interval
17740 3: Content Type
17741 8: Response Topic
17742 9: Correlation Data
17743 Not supported yet:
17744 38: User Property
17745
17746 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
17747 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
17748 packets only):
17749 17: Session Expiry Interval
17750 33: Receive Maximum
17751 36: Maximum QoS
17752 37: Retain Available
17753 39: Maximum Packet Size
17754 18: Assigned Client Identifier
17755 34: Topic Alias Maximum
17756 31: Reason String
17757 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
17758 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
17759 42: Shared Subscription Available
17760 19: Server Keep Alive
17761 26: Response Information
17762 28: Server Reference
17763 21: Authentication Method
17764 22: Authentication Data
17765 Not supported yet:
17766 38: User Property
17767
17768 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
17769 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
17770 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
17771 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
17772
17773 Example:
17774
17775 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
17776 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
17777 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
17778 if data_in_buffer
17779 # do the same as above
17780 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
17781 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
17782 if data_in_buffer
17783
17784mqtt_is_valid
17785 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
17786
17787 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
17788 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
17789 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
17790 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
17791
Christopher Faulet140a3572022-03-22 09:41:11 +010017792 Only MQTT 3.1, 3.1.1 and 5.0 are supported.
17793
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010017794 Example:
17795
17796 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
Daniel Corbettcc9d9b02021-05-13 10:46:07 -040017797 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid }
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010017798
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017799mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017800 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020017801 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
17802 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017803 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017804 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017805 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017806 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17807 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
17808 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
17809 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017810 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017811 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017812
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010017813nbsrv
17814 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
17815 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
17816 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
17817 map lookup.
17818
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017819neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017820 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
17821 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
17822 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
17823 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017824
17825not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017826 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017827 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017828 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017829 absence of a flag).
17830
17831odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017832 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017833 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
17834
17835or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017836 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017837 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017838 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
17839 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017840 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017841 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17842 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
17843 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
17844 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017845 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017846 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017847
Thayne McCombs02cf4ec2022-12-14 00:19:59 -070017848param(<name>,[<delim>])
17849 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the input string
17850 where parameters are delimited by <delim>, which defaults to "&", and the name
17851 and value of the parameter are separated by a "=". If there is no "=" and
17852 value before the end of the parameter segment, it is treated as equivalent to
17853 a value of an empty string.
17854
17855 This can be useful for extracting parameters from a query string, or possibly
17856 a x-www-form-urlencoded body. In particular, `query,param(<name>)` can be used
17857 as an alternative to `urlp(<name>)` which only uses "&" as a delimiter,
17858 whereas "urlp" also uses "?" and ";".
17859
17860 Note that this converter doesn't do anything special with url encoded
17861 characters. If you want to decode the value, you can use the url_dec converter
17862 on the output. If the name of the parameter in the input might contain encoded
17863 characters, you'll probably want do normalize the input before calling
17864 "param". This can be done using "http-request normalize-uri", in particular
17865 the percent-decode-unreserved and percent-to-uppercase options.
17866
17867 Example :
17868 str(a=b&c=d&a=r),param(a) # b
17869 str(a&b=c),param(a) # ""
17870 str(a=&b&c=a),param(b) # ""
17871 str(a=1;b=2;c=4),param(b,;) # 2
17872 query,param(redirect_uri),urldec()
17873
William Lallemanddd754cb2022-08-26 16:21:28 +020017874port_only
17875 Converts a string which contains a Host header value into an integer by
17876 returning its port.
17877 The input must respect the format of the host header value
17878 (rfc9110#section-7.2). It will support that kind of input: hostname,
17879 hostname:80, 127.0.0.1, 127.0.0.1:80, [::1], [::1]:80.
17880
17881 If no port were provided in the input, it will return 0.
17882
17883 See also: "host_only" converter which will return the host.
17884
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017885protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
17886 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
17887 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
17888 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
17889 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
17890 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
17891 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
17892 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
17893 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
17894 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
17895 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
17896 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
17897
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010017898regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010017899 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
17900 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
17901 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
17902 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
17903 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
17904 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
17905 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
17906 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
17907 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010017908 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
17909 of characters with other ones.
17910
17911 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
17912 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
17913 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
17914 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
17915 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
17916 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010017917
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010017918 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010017919
17920 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
17921 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
17922 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010017923 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010017924
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010017925 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
17926 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
17927
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010017928 # capture groups and backreferences
17929 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020017930 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010017931 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
17932
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020017933capture-req(<id>)
17934 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
17935 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
17936
17937 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020017938 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
17939 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020017940
17941capture-res(<id>)
17942 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
17943 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
17944
17945 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020017946 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
17947 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020017948
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020017949rtrim(<chars>)
17950 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
17951 of the input sample.
17952
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017953sdbm([<avalanche>])
17954 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
17955 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17956 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17957 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17958 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17959 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17960 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017961 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
17962 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017963
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020017964secure_memcmp(<var>)
17965 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
17966 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
17967 match.
17968
17969 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
17970 performed in constant time.
17971
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017972 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020017973 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17974
17975 Example :
17976
17977 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
17978 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
17979 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
17980 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
17981
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010017982set-var(<var>[,<cond> ...])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017983 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010017984 as-is if all of the specified conditions are true (see below for a list of
17985 possible conditions). The variable keeps the value and the associated input
17986 type. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
17987 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017988 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017989 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17990 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017991 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017992 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17993 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017994 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017995 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017996
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010017997 You can pass at most four conditions to the converter among the following
17998 possible conditions :
17999 - "ifexists"/"ifnotexists":
18000 Checks if the variable already existed before the current set-var call.
18001 A variable is usually created through a successful set-var call.
18002 Note that variables of scope "proc" are created during configuration
18003 parsing so the "ifexists" condition will always be true for them.
18004 - "ifempty"/"ifnotempty":
18005 Checks if the input is empty or not.
18006 Scalar types are never empty so the ifempty condition will be false for
18007 them regardless of the input's contents (integers, booleans, IPs ...).
18008 - "ifset"/"ifnotset":
18009 Checks if the variable was previously set or not, or if unset-var was
18010 called on the variable.
18011 A variable that does not exist yet is considered as not set. A "proc"
18012 variable can exist while not being set since they are created during
18013 configuration parsing.
18014 - "ifgt"/"iflt":
18015 Checks if the content of the variable is "greater than" or "less than"
18016 the input. This check can only be performed if both the input and
18017 the variable are of type integer. Otherwise, the check is considered as
18018 true by default.
18019
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020018020sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020018021 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020018022 sample with length of 20 bytes.
18023
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020018024sha2([<bits>])
18025 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
18026 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
18027
18028 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
18029 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
18030
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018031 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020018032 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18033
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020018034srv_queue
18035 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
18036 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
18037 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
18038 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
18039 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
18040
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020018041strcmp(<var>)
18042 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
18043 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
18044 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
18045 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
18046 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
18047 shorter).
18048
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020018049 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
18050 strings in constant time.
18051
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020018052 Example :
18053
18054 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
18055 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
18056 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
18057
18058
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018059sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018060 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
18061 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018062 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018063 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
18064 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018065 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018066 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18067 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018068 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018069 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
18070 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018071 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018072 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018073
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018074table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
18075 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18076 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18077 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
18078 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
18079 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
18080 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
18081
18082
18083table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
18084 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18085 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18086 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
18087 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
18088 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
18089 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
18090
18091table_conn_cnt(<table>)
18092 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18093 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018094 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018095 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
18096 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
18097
18098table_conn_cur(<table>)
18099 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18100 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18101 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
18102 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
18103 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
18104
18105table_conn_rate(<table>)
18106 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18107 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18108 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
18109 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
18110 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
18111
Frédéric Lécaillebbeec372022-08-16 18:11:25 +020018112table_expire(<table>[,<default_value>])
18113 Uses the input sample to perform a look up in the specified table. If the key
18114 is not found in the table, the converter fails except if <default_value> is
18115 set: this makes the converter succeed and return <default_value>. If the key
18116 is found the converter returns the key expiration delay associated with the
18117 input sample in the designated table.
18118 See also the table_idle sample fetch keyword.
18119
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020018120table_gpt(<idx>,<table>)
18121 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
18122 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
18123 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the general
18124 purpose tag at the index <idx> of the array associated to the input sample
18125 in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18126 If there is no GPT stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
18127 This applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on the legacy 'gpt0'
18128 data-type).
18129 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
18130
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018131table_gpt0(<table>)
18132 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18133 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
18134 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
18135 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
18136 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
18137
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018138table_gpc(<idx>,<table>)
18139 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
18140 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18141 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the
18142 General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array associated
18143 to the input sample in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer
18144 between 0 and 99.
18145 If there is no GPC stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
18146 This applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18147 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18148 See also the sc_get_gpc sample fetch keyword.
18149
18150table_gpc_rate(<idx>,<table>)
18151 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
18152 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18153 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the Global
18154 Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array (associated to the input sample
18155 in the designated stick-table <table>) was incremented over the
18156 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18157 If there is no gpc_rate stored at this index, it also returns the boolean
18158 value 0.
18159 This applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to the
18160 legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
18161 See also the sc_gpc_rate sample fetch keyword.
18162
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018163table_gpc0(<table>)
18164 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18165 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18166 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
18167 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
18168 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
18169
18170table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
18171 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18172 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18173 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
18174 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
18175 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
18176 sample fetch keyword.
18177
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018178table_gpc1(<table>)
18179 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18180 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18181 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
18182 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
18183 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
18184
18185table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
18186 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18187 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18188 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
18189 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
18190 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
18191 sample fetch keyword.
18192
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018193table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
18194 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18195 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018196 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018197 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
18198 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
18199
18200table_http_err_rate(<table>)
18201 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18202 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18203 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
18204 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
18205 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
18206 keyword.
18207
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018208table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
18209 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18210 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18211 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
18212 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
18213 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
18214
18215table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
18216 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18217 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18218 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
18219 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
18220 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
18221 keyword.
18222
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018223table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
18224 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18225 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018226 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018227 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
18228 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
18229
18230table_http_req_rate(<table>)
18231 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18232 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18233 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
18234 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
18235 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
18236 keyword.
18237
Aurelien DARRAGONfd766dd2022-11-23 14:35:06 +010018238table_idle(<table>[,<default_value>])
Frédéric Lécaillebbeec372022-08-16 18:11:25 +020018239 Uses the input sample to perform a look up in the specified table. If the key
18240 is not found in the table, the converter fails except if <default_value> is
18241 set: this makes the converter succeed and return <default_value>. If the key
18242 is found the converter returns the time the key entry associated with the
18243 input sample in the designated table remained idle since the last time it was
18244 updated.
18245 See also the table_expire sample fetch keyword.
18246
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018247table_kbytes_in(<table>)
18248 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18249 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018250 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018251 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
18252 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
18253 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
18254 keyword.
18255
18256table_kbytes_out(<table>)
18257 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18258 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018259 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018260 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
18261 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
18262 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
18263 keyword.
18264
18265table_server_id(<table>)
18266 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18267 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18268 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
18269 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
18270 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
18271 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
18272
18273table_sess_cnt(<table>)
18274 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18275 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018276 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018277 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
18278 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
18279 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
18280 keyword.
18281
18282table_sess_rate(<table>)
18283 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18284 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18285 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
18286 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
18287 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
18288 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
18289 keyword.
18290
18291table_trackers(<table>)
18292 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18293 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18294 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
18295 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
18296 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
18297 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
18298 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
18299 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
18300 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
18301 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
18302
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020018303ub64dec
18304 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
18305 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
18306 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
18307
18308 Example:
18309 # Decoding a JWT payload:
18310 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
18311
18312ub64enc
18313 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
18314
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020018315upper
18316 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
18317 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
18318 type. The result is of type string.
18319
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020018320url_dec([<in_form>])
18321 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
18322 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
18323 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
18324 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
18325 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
18326 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020018327
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010018328url_enc([<enc_type>])
18329 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
18330 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
18331 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
18332 optional argument is here for future changes.
18333
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010018334ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010018335 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010018336 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
18337 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
18338 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010018339 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
18340 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
18341 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
18342 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010018343 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010018344 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
18345 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010018346
18347 Example:
18348 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
18349 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
18350
18351 message Point {
18352 int32 latitude = 1;
18353 int32 longitude = 2;
18354 }
18355
18356 message PPoint {
18357 Point point = 59;
18358 }
18359
18360 message Rectangle {
18361 // One corner of the rectangle.
18362 PPoint lo = 48;
18363 // The other corner of the rectangle.
18364 PPoint hi = 49;
18365 }
18366
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020018367 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
18368 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
18369 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010018370
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010018371 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
18372 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018373 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010018374 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
18375
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020018376 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010018377
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010018378 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010018379
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020018380 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
18381 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
18382 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010018383
18384 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
18385 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
18386 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
18387
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020018388 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
18389 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
18390 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010018391
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010018392
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010018393unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010018394 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
18395 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
18396 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
18397 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18398 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
18399 response),
18400 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
18401 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
18402 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
18403 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
18404
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020018405utime(<format>[,<offset>])
18406 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
18407 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
18408 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
18409 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
18410 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
18411 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
18412
18413 Example :
18414
18415 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018416 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020018417 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
18418
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020018419word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
18420 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
18421 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
18422 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010018423 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020018424 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
18425 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
18426
18427 Example :
18428 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
18429 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
18430 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
18431 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
18432 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010018433 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010018434
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018435wt6([<avalanche>])
18436 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
18437 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
18438 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
18439 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
18440 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
18441 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
18442 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010018443 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
18444 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018445
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018446xor(<value>)
18447 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018448 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018449 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018450 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018451 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018452 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18453 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018454 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018455 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
18456 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018457 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018458 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018459
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010018460xxh3([<seed>])
18461 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
18462 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
18463 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
18464 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
18465 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
18466 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
18467 considered as cryptographically secure.
18468
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010018469xxh32([<seed>])
18470 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
18471 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
18472 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
18473 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
18474 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
18475 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
18476 as cryptographically secure.
18477
18478xxh64([<seed>])
18479 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
18480 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
18481 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
18482 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
18483 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
18484 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
18485 as cryptographically secure.
18486
William Lallemand9fbc84e2022-11-03 18:56:37 +010018487x509_v_err_str
18488 Convert a numerical value to its corresponding X509_V_ERR constant name. It
18489 is useful in ACL in order to have a configuration which works with multiple
18490 version of OpenSSL since some codes might change when changing version.
18491
18492 The list of constant provided by OpenSSL can be found at
18493 https://www.openssl.org/docs/manmaster/man3/X509_STORE_CTX_get_error.html#ERROR-CODES
18494 Be careful to read the page for the right version of OpenSSL.
18495
18496 Example:
18497
18498 bind :443 ssl crt common.pem ca-file ca-auth.crt verify optional crt-ignore-err X509_V_ERR_CERT_REVOKED,X509_V_ERR_CERT_HAS_EXPIRED
18499
18500 acl cert_expired ssl_c_verify,x509_v_err_str -m str X509_V_ERR_CERT_HAS_EXPIRED
18501 acl cert_revoked ssl_c_verify,x509_v_err_str -m str X509_V_ERR_CERT_REVOKED
18502 acl cert_ok ssl_c_verify,x509_v_err_str -m str X509_V_OK
18503
18504 http-response add-header X-SSL Ok if cert_ok
18505 http-response add-header X-SSL Expired if cert_expired
18506 http-response add-header X-SSL Revoked if cert_revoked
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018507
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200185087.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018509--------------------------------------------
18510
18511A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
18512not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
18513"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
18514The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
18515
18516always_false : boolean
18517 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
18518 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
18519
18520always_true : boolean
18521 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
18522 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
18523
18524avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018525 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018526 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
18527 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
18528 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
18529 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
18530 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
18531 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
18532 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
18533 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
18534 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
18535 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
18536 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
18537 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
18538 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010018539
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018540be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020018541 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
18542 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
18543 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
18544 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040018545 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
18546
18547be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
18548 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
18549 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
18550 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
18551 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
18552 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040018553 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
18554 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040018555
18556 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
18557 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
18558 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018559
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018560be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
18561 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
18562 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
18563 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018564 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018565 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
18566 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018567
18568 Example :
18569 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
18570 backend dynamic
18571 mode http
18572 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
18573 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018574
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018575bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020018576 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
18577 of the string.
18578
18579bool(<bool>) : bool
18580 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
18581 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
18582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018583connslots([<backend>]) : integer
18584 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018585 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018586 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
18587 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050018588
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080018589 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018590 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080018591 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
18592
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018593 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
18594 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080018595
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020018596 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018597 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018598 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018599 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018600 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018601 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020018602 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080018603
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018604 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
18605 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018606 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018607 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080018608
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010018609cpu_calls : integer
18610 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
18611 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
18612 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
18613 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
18614 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
18615 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
18616
18617cpu_ns_avg : integer
18618 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
18619 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
18620 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
18621 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
18622 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
18623 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
18624 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
18625 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
18626 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
18627 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
18628 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
18629
18630cpu_ns_tot : integer
18631 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
18632 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
18633 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
18634 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
18635 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
18636 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
18637 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
18638 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
18639 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
18640 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
18641 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
18642 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
18643 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
18644
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010018645date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020018646 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000018647
18648 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
18649 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
18650 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020018651 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
18652
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000018653 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
18654 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
18655 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
18656 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
18657 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
18658
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020018659 Example :
18660
18661 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
18662 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020018663
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000018664 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
18665 # millisecond granularity
18666 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
18667
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010018668date_us : integer
18669 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
18670 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
18671 from the same timeval structure.
18672
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020018673env(<name>) : string
18674 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
18675 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
18676 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
18677 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
18678 certain way.
18679
18680 Examples :
18681 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
18682 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
18683
18684 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010018685 http-request deny if !{ req.cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020018686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018687fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
18688 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018689 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
18690 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018691 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
18692 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018693 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018694 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
18695 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020018696
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020018697fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
18698 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
18699 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
18700 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
18701
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018702fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
18703 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
18704 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
18705 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
18706 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
18707 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
18708 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
18709 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
18710 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018711
18712 Example :
18713 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
18714 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
18715 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
18716 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
18717 frontend mail
18718 bind :25
18719 mode tcp
18720 maxconn 100
18721 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
18722 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
18723 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
18724 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018725
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010018726hostname : string
18727 Returns the system hostname.
18728
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018729int(<integer>) : signed integer
18730 Returns a signed integer.
18731
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020018732ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
18733 Returns an ipv4.
18734
18735ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
18736 Returns an ipv6.
18737
Tim Duesterhus46419372022-05-27 23:20:36 +020018738last_rule_file : string
Willy Tarreau0657b932022-03-09 17:33:05 +010018739 This returns the name of the configuration file containing the last final
18740 rule that was matched during stream analysis. A final rule is one that
18741 terminates the evaluation of the rule set (like an "accept", "deny" or
18742 "redirect"). This works for TCP request and response rules acting on the
18743 "content" rulesets, and on HTTP rules from "http-request", "http-response"
18744 and "http-after-response" rule sets. The legacy "redirect" rulesets are not
18745 supported (such information is not stored there), and neither "tcp-request
18746 connection" nor "tcp-request session" rulesets are supported because the
18747 information is stored at the stream level and streams do not exist during
18748 these rules. The main purpose of this function is to be able to report in
18749 logs where was the rule that gave the final verdict, in order to help
18750 figure why a request was denied for example. See also "last_rule_line".
18751
Tim Duesterhus46419372022-05-27 23:20:36 +020018752last_rule_line : integer
Willy Tarreau0657b932022-03-09 17:33:05 +010018753 This returns the line number in the configuration file where is located the
18754 last final rule that was matched during stream analysis. A final rule is one
18755 that terminates the evaluation of the rule set (like an "accept", "deny" or
18756 "redirect"). This works for TCP request and response rules acting on the
18757 "content" rulesets, and on HTTP rules from "http-request", "http-response"
18758 and "http-after-response" rule sets. The legacy "redirect" rulesets are not
18759 supported (such information is not stored there), and neither "tcp-request
18760 connection" nor "tcp-request session" rulesets are supported because the
18761 information is stored at the stream level and streams do not exist during
18762 these rules. The main purpose of this function is to be able to report in
18763 logs where was the rule that gave the final verdict, in order to help
18764 figure why a request was denied for example. See also "last_rule_file".
18765
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010018766lat_ns_avg : integer
18767 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
18768 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
18769 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
18770 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
18771 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
18772 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
18773 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
18774 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
18775 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020018776 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
18777 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
18778 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
18779 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
18780 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
18781 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010018782
18783lat_ns_tot : integer
18784 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
18785 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
18786 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
18787 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
18788 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
18789 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
18790 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
18791 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
18792 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020018793 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
18794 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
18795 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
18796 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
18797 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010018798 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
18799 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
18800 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
18801 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
18802 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
18803 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
18804
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020018805meth(<method>) : method
18806 Returns a method.
18807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018808nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
18809 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
18810 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
18811 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018812 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
18813 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
18814 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018815
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040018816prio_class : integer
18817 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
18818 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
18819 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
18820
18821prio_offset : integer
18822 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
18823 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
18824 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
18825 set-priority-offset".
18826
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010018827proc : integer
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +020018828 Always returns value 1 (historically it would return the calling process
18829 number).
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010018830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018831queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018832 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
18833 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
18834 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018835 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
18836 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
18837 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
18838 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
18839 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
18840
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010018841rand([<range>]) : integer
18842 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
18843 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
18844 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
18845 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
18846 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
18847
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018848srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
18849 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
18850 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
18851 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
18852 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
18853 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040018854 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
18855 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
18856
18857srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
18858 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
18859 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
18860 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
18861 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
18862 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
18863 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
18864 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
18865
18866 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
18867 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018868
18869srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
18870 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
18871 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
18872 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018873 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018874 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
18875 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
18876 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
18877
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020018878srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
18879 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
18880 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
18881 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
18882 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
18883 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
18884 fetch methods.
18885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018886srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
18887 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
18888 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018889 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018890 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
18891 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018892 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018893 overloading servers).
18894
18895 Example :
18896 # Redirect to a separate back
18897 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
18898 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
18899 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
18900
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020018901srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020018902 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
18903 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
18904 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
18905
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020018906srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020018907 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
18908 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
18909 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
18910
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020018911srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020018912 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
18913 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
18914 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
18915
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010018916stopping : boolean
18917 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
18918 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
18919 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
18920
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020018921str(<string>) : string
18922 Returns a string.
18923
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018924table_avl([<table>]) : integer
18925 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
18926 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
18927
18928table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18929 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
18930 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
18931 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
18932
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010018933thread : integer
18934 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
18935 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
18936 and debugging purposes.
18937
Alexandar Lazic528adc32021-06-01 00:27:01 +020018938uuid([<version>]) : string
18939 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
18940 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
18941 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
18942
Willy Tarreau54496a62021-09-03 12:00:13 +020018943var(<var-name>[,<default>]) : undefined
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018944 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Willy Tarreau54496a62021-09-03 12:00:13 +020018945 sample fetch fails, unless a default value is provided, in which case it will
18946 return it as a string. Empty strings are permitted. The name of the variable
18947 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018948 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018949 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18950 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018951 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018952 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
18953 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018954 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018955 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018956
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200189577.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018958----------------------------------
18959
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018960The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018961closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
18962methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
18963sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
18964TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018965the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
18966counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020018967"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +010018968used if the global "tune.stick-counters" value does not exceed 3, otherwise the
18969counter number can be specified as the first integer argument when using the
18970"sc_" prefix starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (tune.stick-counters-1).
18971An optional table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the
18972currently tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of
18973the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018974
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020018975bc_dst : ip
18976 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
18977 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
18978 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
18979 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
18980
18981bc_dst_port : integer
18982 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018983 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected to.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020018984
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010018985bc_err : integer
18986 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current backend
18987 connection. See the "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes
18988 and their corresponding error message.
18989
18990bc_err_str : string
18991 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
18992 backend connection, resulting in a connection failure. See the
18993 "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes and their
18994 corresponding error message.
18995
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010018996bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010018997 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
18998 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
18999 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
19000
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019001bc_src : ip
19002 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019003 the server address HAProxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019004 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
19005 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
19006
19007bc_src_port : integer
19008 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019009 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected from.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019011be_id : integer
19012 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020019013 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
19014 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019015
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010019016be_name : string
19017 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020019018 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
19019 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010019020
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010019021be_server_timeout : integer
19022 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
19023 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
19024 also the "cur_server_timeout".
19025
19026be_tunnel_timeout : integer
19027 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
19028 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
19029 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
19030
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010019031cur_server_timeout : integer
19032 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
19033 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
19034 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
19035
19036cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
19037 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
19038 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
19039 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
19040
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019041dst : ip
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020019042 This is the destination IP address of the connection on the client side,
19043 which is the address the client connected to. Any tcp/http rules may alter
19044 this address. It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
19045 type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address
19046 is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. When the incoming
19047 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
19048 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
19049 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
19050 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
19051 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
19052 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019053
19054dst_conn : integer
19055 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
19056 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
19057 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
19058 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
19059 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
19060 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
19061 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
19062 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019063
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020019064dst_is_local : boolean
19065 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
19066 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
19067 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
19068 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019069 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020019070 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
19071 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
19072 it only once per connection.
19073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019074dst_port : integer
19075 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
19076 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020019077 Any tcp/http rules may alter this address. This might be used when running in
19078 transparent mode, when assigning dynamic ports to some clients for a whole
19079 application session, to stick all users to a same server, or to pass the
19080 destination port information to a server using an HTTP header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019081
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010019082fc_dst : ip
19083 This is the original destination IP address of the connection on the client
19084 side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter this address. See "dst"
19085 for details.
19086
19087fc_dst_is_local : boolean
19088 Returns true if the original destination address of the incoming connection
19089 is local to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the
19090 system. See "dst_is_local" for details.
19091
19092fc_dst_port : integer
19093 Returns an integer value corresponding to the original destination TCP port
19094 of the connection on the client side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may
19095 alter this address. See "dst-port" for details.
19096
19097fc_err : integer
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020019098 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current
19099 connection. Any strictly positive value of this fetch indicates that the
19100 connection did not succeed and would result in an error log being output (as
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010019101 described in section 8.2.6). See the "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020019102 error codes and their corresponding error message.
19103
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010019104fc_err_str : string
Ilya Shipitsin01881082021-08-07 14:41:56 +050019105 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020019106 connection, resulting in a connection failure. This string corresponds to the
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010019107 "message" part of the error log format (see section 8.2.6). See below for a
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020019108 full list of error codes and their corresponding error messages :
19109
19110 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
19111 | ID | message |
19112 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
19113 | 0 | "Success" |
19114 | 1 | "Reached configured maxconn value" |
19115 | 2 | "Too many sockets on the process" |
19116 | 3 | "Too many sockets on the system" |
19117 | 4 | "Out of system buffers" |
19118 | 5 | "Protocol or address family not supported" |
19119 | 6 | "General socket error" |
19120 | 7 | "Source port range exhausted" |
19121 | 8 | "Can't bind to source address" |
19122 | 9 | "Out of local source ports on the system" |
19123 | 10 | "Local source address already in use" |
19124 | 11 | "Connection closed while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
19125 | 12 | "Connection error while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
19126 | 13 | "Timeout while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
19127 | 14 | "Truncated PROXY protocol header received" |
19128 | 15 | "Received something which does not look like a PROXY protocol header" |
19129 | 16 | "Received an invalid PROXY protocol header" |
19130 | 17 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the PROXY protocol header" |
19131 | 18 | "Connection closed while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
19132 | 19 | "Connection error while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
19133 | 20 | "Timeout while waiting for a NetScaler Client IP header" |
19134 | 21 | "Truncated NetScaler Client IP header received" |
19135 | 22 | "Received an invalid NetScaler Client IP magic number" |
19136 | 23 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the NetScaler Client IP header" |
19137 | 24 | "Connection closed during SSL handshake" |
19138 | 25 | "Connection error during SSL handshake" |
19139 | 26 | "Timeout during SSL handshake" |
19140 | 27 | "Too many SSL connections" |
19141 | 28 | "Out of memory when initializing an SSL connection" |
19142 | 29 | "Rejected a client-initiated SSL renegotiation attempt" |
19143 | 30 | "SSL client CA chain cannot be verified" |
19144 | 31 | "SSL client certificate not trusted" |
19145 | 32 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the configured one" |
19146 | 33 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the expected one" |
19147 | 34 | "SSL handshake failure" |
19148 | 35 | "SSL handshake failure after heartbeat" |
19149 | 36 | "Stopped a TLSv1 heartbeat attack (CVE-2014-0160)" |
19150 | 37 | "Attempt to use SSL on an unknown target (internal error)" |
19151 | 38 | "Server refused early data" |
19152 | 39 | "SOCKS4 Proxy write error during handshake" |
19153 | 40 | "SOCKS4 Proxy read error during handshake" |
19154 | 41 | "SOCKS4 Proxy deny the request" |
19155 | 42 | "SOCKS4 Proxy handshake aborted by server" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton61944f72021-09-29 18:56:51 +020019156 | 43 | "SSL fatal error" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020019157 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
19158
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020019159fc_fackets : integer
19160 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
19161 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
19162 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
19163 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19164
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020019165fc_http_major : integer
19166 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
19167 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
19168 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
19169
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020019170fc_lost : integer
19171 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
19172 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
19173 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
19174 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19175
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020019176fc_pp_authority : string
19177 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
19178 if any.
19179
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010019180fc_pp_unique_id : string
19181 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
19182 if any.
19183
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010019184fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
19185 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
19186 header.
19187
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020019188fc_reordering : integer
19189 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
19190 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
19191 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
19192 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19193
19194fc_retrans : integer
19195 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
19196 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
19197 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
19198 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19199
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020019200fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
19201 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
19202 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
19203 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
19204 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
19205 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
19206 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19207
19208fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
19209 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
19210 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
19211 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
19212 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
19213 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
19214 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19215
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020019216fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070019217 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
19218 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
19219 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
19220 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19221
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020019222fc_src : ip
19223 This is the original destination IP address of the connection on the client
19224 side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter this address. See "src"
19225 for details.
19226
19227fc_src_is_local : boolean
19228 Returns true if the source address of incoming connection is local to the
19229 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system. See
19230 "src_is_local" for details.
19231
19232fc_src_port : integer
19233
19234 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
19235 connection on the client side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter
19236 this address. See "src-port" for details.
19237
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070019238
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020019239fc_unacked : integer
19240 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
19241 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
19242 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
19243 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070019244
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020019245fe_defbe : string
19246 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
19247 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
19248
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019249fe_id : integer
19250 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010019251 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019252 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
19253
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010019254fe_name : string
19255 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
19256 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
19257 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
19258
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010019259fe_client_timeout : integer
19260 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
19261 current frontend.
19262
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019263sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019264sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
19265sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
19266sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019267 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
19268 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
19269 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
19270
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019271sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019272sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
19273sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
19274sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019275 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
19276 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
19277 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
19278
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019279sc_clr_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19280 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
19281 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
19282 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
19283 returns its previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
19284 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
19285 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
19286 will always return zero.
19287 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
19288 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
19289
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019290sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019291sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19292sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19293sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020019294 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
19295 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010019296 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
19297 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
19298 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020019299
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019300 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020019301 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
19302 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019303 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
19304 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
19305 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020019306 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
19307 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
19308
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019309sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19310sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19311sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19312sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19313 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
19314 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
19315 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
19316 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
19317 when a first ACL was verified.
19318
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019319sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019320sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19321sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19322sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019323 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019324 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
19325
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019326sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019327sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
19328sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
19329sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019330 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
19331 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
19332 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
19333
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019334sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019335sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
19336sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
19337sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019338 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
19339 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
19340 See also src_conn_rate.
19341
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019342sc_get_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19343 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
19344 in the GPC array and associated to the currently tracked counter of
19345 ID <ctr> from the current proxy's stick-table or from the designated
19346 stick-table <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
19347 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2. If there is not gpc stored at this
19348 index, zero is returned.
19349 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
19350 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types). See also src_get_gpc and sc_inc_gpc.
19351
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019352sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019353sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19354sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19355sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019356 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019357 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020019358
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019359sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19360sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19361sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19362sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19363 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
19364 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
19365
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020019366sc_get_gpt(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19367 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
19368 the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> and from the
19369 current proxy's sitck-table or the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
19370 is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
19371 If there is no GPT stored at this index, zero is returned.
19372 This fetch applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on
19373 the legacy 'gpt0' data-type). See also src_get_gpt.
19374
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020019375sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19376sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
19377sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
19378sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
19379 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
19380 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
19381
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019382sc_gpc_rate(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19383 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
19384 index <idx> of the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> from
19385 the current proxy's table or from the designated stick-table <table>.
19386 It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was incremented over the
19387 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer
19388 between 0 and 2.
19389 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter array must be stored in the stick-table
19390 for a value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
19391 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
19392 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
19393 See also src_gpc_rate, sc_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
19394
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019395sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019396sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
19397sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
19398sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020019399 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
19400 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
19401 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019402 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
19403 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
19404 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019405
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019406sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19407sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
19408sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
19409sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
19410 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
19411 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
19412 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
19413 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
19414 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
19415 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
19416
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019417sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019418sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19419sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19420sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019421 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019422 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
19423 See also src_http_err_cnt.
19424
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019425sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019426sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
19427sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
19428sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019429 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
19430 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
19431 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
19432 src_http_err_rate.
19433
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010019434sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19435sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19436sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19437sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19438 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
19439 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
19440 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
19441
19442sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19443sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
19444sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
19445sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
19446 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
19447 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
19448 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
19449 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
19450
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019451sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019452sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19453sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19454sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019455 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019456 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
19457 src_http_req_cnt.
19458
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019459sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019460sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
19461sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
19462sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019463 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
19464 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
19465 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
19466 src_http_req_rate.
19467
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019468sc_inc_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19469 Increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
19470 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
19471 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
19472 returns its new value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
19473 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
19474 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
19475 will increase it to 1 and will return 1.
19476 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
19477 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
19478
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019479sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019480sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19481sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19482sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019483 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010019484 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
19485 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
19486 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
19487 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019488
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019489 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019490 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
19491 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019492 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
19493
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019494sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19495sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19496sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19497sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19498 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
19499 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
19500 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
19501 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
19502 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
19503
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019504sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019505sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
19506sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
19507sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020019508 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
19509 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
19510 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019511
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019512sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019513sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
19514sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
19515sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020019516 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
19517 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
19518 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019519
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019520sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019521sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19522sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19523sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019524 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019525 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
19526 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
19527 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019528 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019529 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
19530
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019531sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019532sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
19533sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
19534sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019535 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
19536 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
19537 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
19538 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
19539 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019540 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019541
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019542sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019543sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
19544sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
19545sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020019546 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
19547 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
19548 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
19549
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019550sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019551sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
19552sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
19553sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010019554 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
19555 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019556 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010019557 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
19558 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019559 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
19560 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
19561 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010019562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019563so_id : integer
19564 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
19565 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
19566 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019567
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010019568so_name : string
19569 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
19570 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
19571 strings instead of integers.
19572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019573src : ip
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020019574 This is the source IP address of the client of the session. Any tcp/http
19575 rules may alter this address. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and
19576 IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
19577 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the TCP-level source
19578 address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a
19579 proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind directive
19580 is used, it can be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol
19581 compatible component for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which
19582 sees the real address. When the incoming connection passed through address
19583 translation or redirection involving connection tracking, the original
19584 destination address before the redirection will be reported. On Linux
19585 systems, the source and destination may seldom appear reversed if the
19586 nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late response may reopen a
19587 timed out connection and switch what is believed to be the source and the
19588 destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019589
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010019590 Example:
19591 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
19592 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
19593
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019594src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
19595 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
19596 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
19597 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019598 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019599
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019600src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
19601 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
19602 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019603 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019604 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019605
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019606src_clr_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
19607 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
19608 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
19609 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its
19610 previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
19611 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 0 is returned.
19612 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
19613 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
19614 See also sc_clr_gpc.
19615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019616src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19617 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
19618 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
19619 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
19620 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
19621 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
19622 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020019623
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019624 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020019625 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
19626 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
19627 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
19628 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010019629 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020019630 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
19631 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
19632
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019633src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19634 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
19635 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
19636 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
19637 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
19638 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
19639 was verified.
19640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019641src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019642 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019643 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019644 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019645 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019647src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019648 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019649 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
19650 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019651 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019653src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
19654 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
19655 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
19656 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019657 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019658
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019659src_get_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
19660 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the
19661 array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
19662 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
19663 is an integer between 0 and 99.
19664 If the address is not found or there is no gpc stored at this index, zero
19665 is returned.
19666 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not on the legacy
19667 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
19668 See also sc_get_gpc and src_inc_gpc.
19669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019670src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019671 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019672 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019673 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019674 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019675
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019676src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19677 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
19678 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
19679 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
19680 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
19681
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020019682src_get_gpt(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
19683 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
19684 the array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
19685 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>.
19686 <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
19687 If the address is not found or the GPT is not stored, zero is returned.
19688 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
19689
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020019690src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
19691 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
19692 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
19693 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
19694 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
19695
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019696src_gpc_rate(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
19697 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
19698 index <idx> of the array associated to the incoming connection's
19699 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
19700 stick-table <table>. It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was
19701 incremented over the configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
19702 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter must be stored in the stick-table for a
19703 value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
19704 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
19705 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
19706 See also sc_gpc_rate, src_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
19707
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019708src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020019709 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019710 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020019711 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
19712 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019713 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
19714 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
19715 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020019716
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019717src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
19718 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
19719 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
19720 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
19721 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
19722 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
19723 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
19724 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
19725
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019726src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019727 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019728 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019729 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019730 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019731 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019732
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019733src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
19734 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
19735 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
19736 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
19737 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019738 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019739
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010019740src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19741 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
19742 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050019743 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010019744 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
19745 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
19746
19747src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
19748 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
19749 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
19750 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
19751 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
19752 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
19753 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
19754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019755src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019756 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019757 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
19758 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019759 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019760
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019761src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
19762 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
19763 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
19764 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019765 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019766 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019767
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019768src_inc_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
19769 Increments the General Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array
19770 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
19771 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its new
19772 value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
19773 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 1 is returned.
19774 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
19775 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
19776 See also sc_inc_gpc.
19777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019778src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19779 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
19780 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
19781 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019782 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019783 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
19784 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019785
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019786 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019787 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010019788 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019789 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019790
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019791src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19792 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
19793 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
19794 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
19795 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
19796 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
19797 connection when a first ACL was verified.
19798
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020019799src_is_local : boolean
19800 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
19801 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
19802 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
19803 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019804 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020019805 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
19806 once per connection.
19807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019808src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020019809 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
19810 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
19811 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
19812 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
19813 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019815src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020019816 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
19817 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
19818 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
19819 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
19820 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020019821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019822src_port : integer
19823 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020019824 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected
19825 from. Any tcp/http rules may alter this address. Usage of this function is
19826 very limited as modern protocols do not care much about source ports
19827 nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010019828
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019829src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019830 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019831 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
19832 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
19833 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019834 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019835
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019836src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
19837 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
19838 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
19839 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
19840 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019841 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019842
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019843src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19844 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
19845 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
19846 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
19847 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
19848 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
19849 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
19850 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
19851 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020019852
19853 Example :
19854 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
19855 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
19856 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
19857 listen ssh
19858 bind :22
19859 mode tcp
19860 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019861 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019862 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020019863 server local 127.0.0.1:22
19864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019865srv_id : integer
19866 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
19867 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020019868 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020019869
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080019870srv_name : string
19871 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
19872 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020019873 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080019874
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200198757.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019876----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020019877
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019878The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019879closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
19880when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
19881usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019882future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020019883
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001988451d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
19885 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
19886 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
19887 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
19888 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
19889 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
19890
19891 Example :
19892 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
19893 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
19894 # the request.
19895 frontend http-in
19896 bind *:8081
19897 default_backend servers
19898 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
19899 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
19900
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019901ssl_bc : boolean
19902 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
19903 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019904 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
19905 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019906
19907ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
19908 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019909 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
19910 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019911
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019912ssl_bc_alpn : string
19913 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
19914 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020019915 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019916 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
19917 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
19918 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
19919 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
19920 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019921 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
19922 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019923
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019924ssl_bc_cipher : string
19925 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019926 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
19927 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019928
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019929ssl_bc_client_random : binary
19930 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
19931 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
19932 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019933 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019934
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020019935ssl_bc_err : integer
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020019936 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020019937 returns the ID of the last error of the first error stack raised on the
19938 backend side. It can raise handshake errors as well as other read or write
19939 errors occurring during the connection's lifetime. In order to get a text
19940 description of this error code, you can either use the "ssl_bc_err_str"
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020019941 sample fetch or use the "openssl errstr" command (which takes an error code
19942 in hexadecimal representation as parameter). Please refer to your SSL
19943 library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error codes.
19944
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020019945ssl_bc_err_str : string
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020019946 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020019947 returns a string representation of the last error of the first error stack
19948 that was raised on the connection from the backend's perspective. See also
19949 "ssl_fc_err".
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020019950
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010019951ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
19952 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19953 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019954 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
19955 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010019956
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019957ssl_bc_npn : string
19958 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
19959 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020019960 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019961 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
19962 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
19963 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
19964 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019965 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
19966 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019967
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019968ssl_bc_protocol : string
19969 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019970 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
19971 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019972
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020019973ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019974 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020019975 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019976 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
19977 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019978
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019979ssl_bc_server_random : binary
19980 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
19981 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
19982 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019983 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019984
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019985ssl_bc_session_id : binary
19986 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
19987 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019988 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
19989 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019990
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040019991ssl_bc_session_key : binary
19992 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
19993 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
19994 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019995 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040019996
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019997ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
19998 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019999 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
20000 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020001
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020002ssl_c_ca_err : integer
20003 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20004 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
20005 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
20006 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
20007 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020020008
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020009ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
20010 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20011 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
20012 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
20013 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010020014
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010020015ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020020016 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
20017 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20018 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050020019 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020020020 does not support resumed sessions.
20021
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010020022ssl_c_der : binary
20023 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
20024 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20025 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
20026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020027ssl_c_err : integer
20028 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20029 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
20030 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
20031 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
20032 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020020033
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020034ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020035 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20036 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
20037 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
20038 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
20039 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
20040 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
20041 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
20042 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020043 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
20044 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
20045 LDAP v3.
20046 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
20047 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020020048
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020049ssl_c_key_alg : string
20050 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
20051 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20052 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020020053
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020054ssl_c_notafter : string
20055 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
20056 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20057 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020020058
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020059ssl_c_notbefore : string
20060 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
20061 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20062 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010020063
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020064ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020065 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20066 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
20067 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
20068 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
20069 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
20070 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
20071 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
20072 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020073 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
20074 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
20075 LDAP v3.
20076 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
20077 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010020078
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020079ssl_c_serial : binary
20080 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
20081 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20082 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020020083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020084ssl_c_sha1 : binary
20085 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
20086 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
20087 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020020088 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
20089 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
20090
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020091 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020020092 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020020093
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020094ssl_c_sig_alg : string
20095 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
20096 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
20097 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020020098
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020099ssl_c_used : boolean
20100 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
20101 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020020102
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020103ssl_c_verify : integer
20104 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
20105 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
20106 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
20107 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020020108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020109ssl_c_version : integer
20110 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
20111 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020020112
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010020113ssl_f_der : binary
20114 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
20115 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20116 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
20117
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020118ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020119 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20120 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
20121 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
20122 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020020123 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020124 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
20125 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
20126 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020127 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
20128 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
20129 LDAP v3.
20130 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
20131 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020020132
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020133ssl_f_key_alg : string
20134 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
20135 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
20136 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020020137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020138ssl_f_notafter : string
20139 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
20140 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20141 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020020142
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020143ssl_f_notbefore : string
20144 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
20145 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20146 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020020147
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020148ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020149 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20150 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
20151 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
20152 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
20153 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
20154 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
20155 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
20156 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020157 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
20158 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
20159 LDAP v3.
20160 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
20161 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020020162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020163ssl_f_serial : binary
20164 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
20165 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20166 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020020167
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020020168ssl_f_sha1 : binary
20169 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
20170 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
20171 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
20172
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020173ssl_f_sig_alg : string
20174 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
20175 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
20176 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020020177
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020178ssl_f_version : integer
20179 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
20180 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
20181
20182ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020020183 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
20184 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
20185 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
20186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020187 Example :
20188 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
20189 listen http-https
20190 bind :80
20191 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
20192 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
20193
20194ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
20195 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
20196 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
20197
20198ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020199 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020200 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020201 HAProxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020202 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
20203 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
20204 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
20205 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
20206 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
20207 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
20208
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020209ssl_fc_cipher : string
20210 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
20211 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020020212
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020213ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
20214 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
20215 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020216 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020217 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
20218 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
20219 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010020220
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020221 Example:
20222 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
20223 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20224 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20225 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20226 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
20227 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
20228 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
20229 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
20230 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
20231
20232ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010020233 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020234 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020235 capture buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
20236 Setting <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020237 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
20238 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010020239
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020240ssl_fc_cipherlist_str([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010020241 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020242 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020243 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020244 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
20245 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
20246 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
20247 Note that this sample-fetch is only available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the
20248 function is not enabled, this sample-fetch returns the hash like
20249 "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010020250
20251ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020252 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can return only if the value
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020253 "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash take
20254 into account all the data of the cipher list.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020255
20256ssl_fc_ecformats_bin : binary
20257 Return the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curve point
20258 formats. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020259 buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020260
20261 Example:
20262 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
20263 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20264 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20265 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20266 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
20267 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
20268 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
20269 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
20270 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
20271
20272ssl_fc_eclist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
20273 Returns the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curves. The
20274 maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020275 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020276 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
20277 0 : return the full list of supported elliptic curves (default)
20278 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
20279
20280 Example:
20281 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
20282 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20283 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20284 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20285 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
20286 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
20287 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
20288 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
20289 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
20290
20291ssl_fc_extlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
20292 Returns the binary form of the client hello extension list. The maximum
20293 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020294 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020295 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
20296 0 : return the full list of extensions (default)
20297 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
20298
20299 Example:
20300 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
20301 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20302 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20303 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20304 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
20305 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
20306 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
20307 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
20308 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010020309
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020310ssl_fc_client_random : binary
20311 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
20312 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
20313 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
20314
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020020315ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
20316 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
20317 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
20318 transport layer.
20319 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
20320 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
20321 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
20322 "tune.ssl.keylog"
20323
20324ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
20325 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
20326 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
20327 transport layer.
20328 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
20329 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
20330 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
20331 "tune.ssl.keylog"
20332
20333ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
20334 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
20335 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
20336 transport layer.
20337 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
20338 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
20339 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
20340 "tune.ssl.keylog"
20341
20342ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
20343 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
20344 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
20345 transport layer.
20346 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
20347 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
20348 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
20349 "tune.ssl.keylog"
20350
20351ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
20352 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
20353 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
20354 transport layer.
20355 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
20356 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
20357 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
20358 "tune.ssl.keylog"
20359
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020020360ssl_fc_err : integer
20361 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20362 returns the ID of the last error of the first error stack raised on the
20363 frontend side, or 0 if no error was encountered. It can be used to identify
20364 handshake related errors other than verify ones (such as cipher mismatch), as
20365 well as other read or write errors occurring during the connection's
20366 lifetime. Any error happening during the client's certificate verification
20367 process will not be raised through this fetch but via the existing
20368 "ssl_c_err", "ssl_c_ca_err" and "ssl_c_ca_err_depth" fetches. In order to get
20369 a text description of this error code, you can either use the
20370 "ssl_fc_err_str" sample fetch or use the "openssl errstr" command (which
20371 takes an error code in hexadecimal representation as parameter). Please refer
20372 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
20373 codes.
20374
20375ssl_fc_err_str : string
20376 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20377 returns a string representation of the last error of the first error stack
20378 that was raised on the frontend side. Any error happening during the client's
20379 certificate verification process will not be raised through this fetch. See
20380 also "ssl_fc_err".
20381
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020382ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020020383 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
20384 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010020385 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
20386 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
20387 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
20388 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020020389
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020020390ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
20391 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
20392 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
20393 wait until the handshake happened.
20394
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020395ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
20396 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020020397 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
20398 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020399 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020020400 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020020401
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020020402ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020020403 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010020404 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
20405 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020020406
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020407ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020408 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020409 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by HAProxy. The result
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020410 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
20411 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
20412 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
20413 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
20414 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
20415 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020020416
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020417ssl_fc_protocol : string
20418 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
20419 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020020420
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020421ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id : integer
20422 The version of the TLS protocol by which the client wishes to communicate
20423 during the session as indicated in client hello message. This value can
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020424 return only if the value "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than
20425 0.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020426
20427 Example:
20428 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
20429 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20430 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20431 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20432 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
20433 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
20434 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
20435 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
20436 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
20437
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020020438ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040020439 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020020440 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Faulet15ae22c2021-11-09 14:23:36 +010020441 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_fc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040020442
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020020443ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
20444 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
20445 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
20446 transport layer.
20447 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
20448 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
20449 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
20450 "tune.ssl.keylog"
20451
20452ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
20453 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
20454 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
20455 transport layer.
20456 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
20457 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
20458 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
20459 "tune.ssl.keylog"
20460
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020461ssl_fc_server_random : binary
20462 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
20463 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
20464 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
20465
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020466ssl_fc_session_id : binary
20467 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
20468 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
20469 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
20470 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020020471
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040020472ssl_fc_session_key : binary
20473 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
20474 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
20475 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
20476 BoringSSL.
20477
20478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020479ssl_fc_sni : string
20480 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
20481 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020482 deciphered by HAProxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020483 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
20484 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
20485
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020020486 This fetch is different from "req.ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020487 connection being deciphered by HAProxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020488 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020489 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020020490 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020020491
Willy Tarreaud26fb572022-11-25 10:12:12 +010020492 CAUTION! Except under very specific conditions, it is normally not correct to
20493 use this field as a substitute for the HTTP "Host" header field. For example,
20494 when forwarding an HTTPS connection to a server, the SNI field must be set
20495 from the HTTP Host header field using "req.hdr(host)" and not from the front
20496 SNI value. The reason is that SNI is solely used to select the certificate
20497 the server side will present, and that clients are then allowed to send
20498 requests with different Host values as long as they match the names in the
20499 certificate. As such, "ssl_fc_sni" should normally not be used as an argument
20500 to the "sni" server keyword, unless the backend works in TCP mode.
20501
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020502 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020503 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
20504 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020020505
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020506ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
20507 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
20508 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020020509
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020020510ssl_s_der : binary
20511 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
20512 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20513 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
20514
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020020515ssl_s_chain_der : binary
20516 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
20517 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20518 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050020519 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020020520 does not support resumed sessions.
20521
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020020522ssl_s_key_alg : string
20523 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
20524 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
20525 SSL/TLS transport layer.
20526
20527ssl_s_notafter : string
20528 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
20529 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20530 transport layer.
20531
20532ssl_s_notbefore : string
20533 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
20534 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20535 transport layer.
20536
20537ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
20538 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20539 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
20540 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
20541 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
20542 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
20543 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020020544 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
20545 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020020546 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
20547 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
20548 LDAP v3.
20549 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
20550 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
20551
20552ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
20553 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20554 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
20555 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
20556 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
20557 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
20558 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020020559 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
20560 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020020561 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
20562 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
20563 LDAP v3.
20564 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
20565 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
20566
20567ssl_s_serial : binary
20568 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
20569 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20570 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
20571
20572ssl_s_sha1 : binary
20573 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
20574 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
20575 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
20576
20577ssl_s_sig_alg : string
20578 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
20579 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
20580 layer.
20581
20582ssl_s_version : integer
20583 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
20584 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020020585
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200205867.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020587------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020020588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020589Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
20590sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
20591only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
20592For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
20593be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
20594can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
20595sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
20596for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
20597content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020020598
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010020599Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
20600 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020601 HTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010020602 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
20603 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
20604 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
20605 sample expression). So be careful.
20606
Willy Tarreau3ec14612022-03-10 10:39:58 +010020607distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
20608 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
20609 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
20610 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
20611 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
20612 HAProxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
20613 list of supported tokens.
20614
20615distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
20616 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
20617 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
20618 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
20619 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
20620 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through HAProxy.
20621 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
20622 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
20623 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
20624 supported tokens.
20625
20626 Example :
20627 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
20628 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
20629 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
20630 # send large files to the big farm
20631 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
20632
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020633payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020634 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020635 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
20636 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010020637
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020638payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
20639 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020640 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020641 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010020642
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020643req.len : integer
20644req_len : integer (deprecated)
20645 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
20646 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
20647 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
20648 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
20649 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020650 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020651 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
20652 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020653
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020654req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
20655 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020020656 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
20657 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
20658 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
20659 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020660
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020661 ACL derivatives :
20662 req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020664req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
20665 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
20666 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
20667 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
20668 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020669
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020670 ACL derivatives :
20671 req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020672
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020673 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020675req.proto_http : boolean
20676req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
20677 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
20678 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
20679 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
20680 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
20681 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
20682 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
20683 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020684
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020685 Example:
20686 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
20687 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
20688 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020020689 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020690
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020691req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
20692rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20693 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
20694 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
20695 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
20696 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
20697 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
20698 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
20699 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020701 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
20702 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
20703 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
20704 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
20705 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
20706 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020707
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020708 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020709 req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020710
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020711 Example :
20712 listen tse-farm
20713 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
20714 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
20715 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
20716 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
20717 # apply RDP cookie persistence
20718 persist rdp-cookie
20719 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
20720 # This is only useful makes sense if
20721 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
20722 stick-table type string size 204800
20723 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
20724 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
20725 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020726
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020727 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020728 "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020729
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020730req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
20731rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
20732 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
20733 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
20734 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
20735 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020736
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020737 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020738 req.rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020739
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110020740req.ssl_alpn : string
20741 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
20742 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
20743 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
20744 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
20745 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
20746 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020020747 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110020748
20749 Examples :
20750 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
20751 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020752 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020020753 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110020754 default_backend bk_default
20755
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020020756req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
20757 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
20758 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020020759 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
20760 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
20761 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
20762 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
20763 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020020764
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020765req.ssl_hello_type : integer
20766req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
20767 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
20768 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
20769 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
20770 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
20771 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
20772 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
20773 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020775req.ssl_sni : string
20776req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
20777 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
20778 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
20779 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
20780 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
20781 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020020782 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
20783 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
20784 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
20785 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
20786 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
20787 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
20788 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
20789 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
20790 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020791
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020792 ACL derivatives :
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020020793 req.ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020795 Examples :
20796 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
20797 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020798 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020020799 use_backend bk_allow if { req.ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020800 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020801
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053020802req.ssl_st_ext : integer
20803 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
20804 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
20805 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
20806 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
20807 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
20808 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
20809 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
20810 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
20811 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
20812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020813req.ssl_ver : integer
20814req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
20815 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
20816 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
20817 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
20818 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
20819 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
20820 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
20821 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020822 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020823 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020825 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020826 req.ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020827
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020020828res.len : integer
20829 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
20830 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
20831 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
20832 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
20833 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020834 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020020835 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020836 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020020837
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020838res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
20839 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020020840 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020841 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020020842 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020843 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020845res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
20846 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
20847 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
20848 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020849 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
20850 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020851
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020852 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020853
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020020854res.ssl_hello_type : integer
20855rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
20856 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
20857 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
20858 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
20859 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
20860 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
20861 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
20862 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
20863
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020864wait_end : boolean
20865 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
20866 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020867 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020868 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
20869 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020870 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020871 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
20872 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020873
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020874 Examples :
20875 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
20876 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
20877 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020878
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020879 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
20880 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
20881 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
20882 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
20883 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
20884 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
20885 tcp-request content reject
20886
20887
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200208887.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020889--------------------------------------
20890
20891It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
20892This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
20893data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
20894its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
20895HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
20896content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
20897to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
20898more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
20899response are indexed.
20900
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010020901Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
20902 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
20903 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
20904 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
20905 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
20906 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
20907 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
20908
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020909base : string
20910 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
20911 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
20912 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
20913 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
20914 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
20915 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
20916 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
20917 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
20918
20919 ACL derivatives :
20920 base : exact string match
20921 base_beg : prefix match
20922 base_dir : subdir match
20923 base_dom : domain match
20924 base_end : suffix match
20925 base_len : length match
20926 base_reg : regex match
20927 base_sub : substring match
20928
20929base32 : integer
20930 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
20931 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
20932 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020020933 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
20934 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
20935 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020936
20937base32+src : binary
20938 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
20939 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
20940 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
20941 per-URL counters.
20942
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010020943baseq : string
20944 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
20945 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
20946 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
20947 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
20948
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010020949capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
20950 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
20951 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
20952 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
20953
20954capture.req.method : string
20955 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
20956 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
20957 because it's allocated.
20958
20959capture.req.uri : string
20960 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
20961 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
20962 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
20963 allocated.
20964
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020020965capture.req.ver : string
20966 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
20967 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
20968 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
20969
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010020970capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
20971 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
20972 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
20973 The first entry is an index of 0.
20974 See also: "capture response header"
20975
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020020976capture.res.ver : string
20977 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
20978 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
20979 persistent flag.
20980
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020020981req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020020982 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
20983 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
20984 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020020985
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020020986req.body_param([<name>) : string
20987 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
20988 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
20989 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
20990 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
20991 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
20992 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
20993 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
20994 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
20995 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
20996 given.
20997
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020020998req.body_len : integer
20999 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
21000 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020021001 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
21002 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020021003
21004req.body_size : integer
21005 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020021006 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
21007 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020021008
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021009req.cook([<name>]) : string
21010cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
21011 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
21012 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
21013 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
21014 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
21015 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
21016 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
21017 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
21018 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
21019
21020 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021021 req.cook([<name>]) : exact string match
21022 req.cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
21023 req.cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
21024 req.cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
21025 req.cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
21026 req.cook_len([<name>]) : length match
21027 req.cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
21028 req.cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021030req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
21031cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
21032 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
21033 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021034
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021035req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
21036cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
21037 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
21038 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
21039 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
21040 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020021041
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021042cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
21043 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
21044 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
21045 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
21046 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020021047 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021048 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
21049 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
21050 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
21051 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021052
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021053hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
21054 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
21055 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
21056 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
21057 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021058 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021059
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021060req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021061 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
21062 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
21063 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
21064 with headers such as User-Agent.
21065
21066 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
21067 found.
21068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021069 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
21070 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
21071 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021072 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021074req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
21075 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
21076 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021077 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
21078 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021080req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021081 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
21082 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
21083 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
21084 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
21085 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
21086 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
21087 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
21088
21089 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
21090 found.
21091
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021092 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
21093 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
21094 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021095 with -1 being the last one.
21096
21097 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
21098 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021099
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021100 ACL derivatives :
21101 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
21102 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
21103 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
21104 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
21105 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
21106 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
21107 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
21108 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
21109
21110req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
21111hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
21112 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
21113 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021114 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
21115 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
21116 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
21117
21118 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
21119 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
21120 which contain more than one of certain headers.
21121
21122 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021123
21124req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
21125hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
21126 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
21127 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
21128 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010021129 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
21130 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
21131 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
21132 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
21133 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021134
21135 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
21136
21137 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021138
21139req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
21140hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
21141 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
21142 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
21143 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021144
21145 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
21146
21147 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021148
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010021149req.hdrs : string
21150 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
21151 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
21152 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
21153 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
21154
21155req.hdrs_bin : binary
21156 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
21157 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
21158 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
21159 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
21160 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
21161 names and values (length of 0 for both).
21162
21163 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010021164
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010021165 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
21166 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010021167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021168http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
21169 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
21170 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
21171 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
21172 basic auth is supported.
21173
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonf5dd3372021-10-01 15:36:53 +020021174http_auth_bearer([<header>]) : string
21175 Returns the client-provided token found in the authorization data when the
21176 Bearer scheme is used (to send JSON Web Tokens for instance). No check is
21177 performed on the data sent by the client.
21178 If a specific <header> is supplied, it will parse this header instead of the
21179 Authorization one.
21180
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010021181http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
21182 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
21183 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
21184 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
21185 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021186 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
21187 basic auth is supported.
21188
21189 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010021190 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
21191 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
21192 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
21193 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021194
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020021195http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010021196 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
21197 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
21198 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020021199
21200http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010021201 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
21202 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
21203 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020021204
21205http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010021206 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
21207 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
21208 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020021209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021210http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020021211 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
21212 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021213 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
21214 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020021215
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021216method : integer + string
21217 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
21218 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
21219 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
21220 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
21221 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
21222 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
21223 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021224
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021225 ACL derivatives :
21226 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021227
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021228 Example :
21229 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
21230 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
21231 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021232
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021233path : string
21234 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
21235 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
21236 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
21237 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
21238 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021239 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021240 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021241
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021242 ACL derivatives :
21243 path : exact string match
21244 path_beg : prefix match
21245 path_dir : subdir match
21246 path_dom : domain match
21247 path_end : suffix match
21248 path_len : length match
21249 path_reg : regex match
21250 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021251
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020021252pathq : string
21253 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
21254 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
21255 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
21256 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
21257 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
21258 result in both cases.
21259
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010021260query : string
21261 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
21262 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
21263 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
21264 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010021265 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010021266 which stops before the question mark.
21267
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010021268req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
21269 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
21270 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
21271 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
21272 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
21273
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021274req.ver : string
21275req_ver : string (deprecated)
21276 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
21277 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
21278 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021279
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021280 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021281 req.ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020021282
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021283res.body : binary
21284 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
21285 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021286 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
21287
21288 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021289
21290res.body_len : integer
21291 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
21292 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021293 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
21294
21295 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021296
21297res.body_size : integer
21298 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
21299 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
21300 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
21301 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021302 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
21303
21304 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021305
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010021306res.cache_hit : boolean
21307 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
21308 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
21309
21310res.cache_name : string
21311 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
21312 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
21313 empty string.
21314
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021315res.comp : boolean
21316 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
21317 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
21318 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021319
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021320res.comp_algo : string
21321 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
21322 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
21323 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021325res.cook([<name>]) : string
21326scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
21327 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
21328 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021329 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
21330
21331 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020021332
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021333 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021334 res.scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020021335
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021336res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
21337scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
21338 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
21339 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021340 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
21341
21342 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021343
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021344res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
21345scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
21346 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
21347 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021348 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
21349
21350 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021351
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021352res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021353 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
21354 on the headers within an HTTP response.
21355
21356 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
21357 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
21358
21359 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
21360
21361 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021362
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021363res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021364 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
21365 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
21366
21367 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
21368 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
21369
21370 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021371
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021372res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
21373shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021374 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
21375 on the headers within an HTTP response.
21376
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050021377 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021378 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
21379
21380 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021381
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021382 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021383 res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
21384 res.hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
21385 res.hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
21386 res.hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
21387 res.hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
21388 res.hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
21389 res.hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
21390 res.hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021391
21392res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
21393shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021394 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
21395 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
21396
21397 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050021398 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021399
21400 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021401
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021402res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
21403shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021404 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
21405 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
21406
21407 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
21408
21409 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021410
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010021411res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
21412 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
21413 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
21414 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021415 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
21416
21417 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010021418
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021419res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
21420shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021421 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
21422 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
21423
21424 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
21425
21426 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021427
21428res.hdrs : string
21429 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
21430 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
21431 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021432 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
21433
21434 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021435
21436res.hdrs_bin : binary
21437 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
21438 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
21439 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
21440 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
21441 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
21442 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
21443 (length of 0 for both).
21444
21445 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
21446
21447 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
21448 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010021449
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021450res.ver : string
21451resp_ver : string (deprecated)
21452 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021453 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
21454
21455 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020021456
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021457 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021458 resp.ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010021459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021460set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
21461 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
21462 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020021463 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021464 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010021465
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021466 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
21467 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010021468
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021469status : integer
21470 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
21471 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021472 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
21473
21474 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021475
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020021476unique-id : string
21477 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
21478 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
21479 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
21480 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
21481 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
21482 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
21483
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021484url : string
21485 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
21486 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
21487 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
21488 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
21489 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
21490 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
21491 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021492
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021493 ACL derivatives :
21494 url : exact string match
21495 url_beg : prefix match
21496 url_dir : subdir match
21497 url_dom : domain match
21498 url_end : suffix match
21499 url_len : length match
21500 url_reg : regex match
21501 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021503url_ip : ip
21504 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
21505 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
21506 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
21507 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020021508 entry in a table for a given source address. It may be used in combination
21509 with 'http-request set-dst' to emulate the older 'option http_proxy'.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021511url_port : integer
21512 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020021513 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed..
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021514
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020021515urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
21516url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021517 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
21518 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020021519 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
21520 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
21521 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
21522 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021523 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
21524 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020021525 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
21526 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021527
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021528 ACL derivatives :
21529 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
21530 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
21531 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
21532 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
21533 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
21534 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
21535 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
21536 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021537
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021538
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021539 Example :
21540 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
21541 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
21542 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
21543 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021544
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030021545urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021546 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
21547 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
21548 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020021549
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020021550url32 : integer
21551 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
21552 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
21553 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
21554 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
21555 is an unsigned integer.
21556
21557url32+src : binary
21558 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
21559 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
21560 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
21561
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020021562
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200215637.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021564---------------------------------------
21565
21566This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
21567used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
21568purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
21569There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
21570or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
21571any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
21572for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
21573
21574internal.htx.data : integer
21575 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
21576 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
21577
21578internal.htx.free : integer
21579 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
21580 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
21581
21582internal.htx.free_data : integer
21583 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
21584 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
21585
21586internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010021587 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
21588 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
21589 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021590
21591internal.htx.nbblks : integer
21592 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
21593 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
21594
21595internal.htx.size : integer
21596 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
21597 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
21598
21599internal.htx.used : integer
21600 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
21601 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
21602 direction.
21603
21604internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
21605 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
21606 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
21607 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
21608 of the special value :
21609 * head : The oldest inserted block
21610 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021611 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021612
21613internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
21614 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
21615 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
21616 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
21617 integer or one of the special value :
21618 * head : The oldest inserted block
21619 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021620 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021621
21622internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
21623 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
21624 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
21625 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
21626 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
21627
21628 * head : The oldest inserted block
21629 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021630 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021631
21632internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
21633 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
21634 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
21635 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
21636 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
21637
21638 * head : The oldest inserted block
21639 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021640 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021641
21642internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
21643 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
21644 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
21645 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
21646 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
21647
21648 * head : The oldest inserted block
21649 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021650 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021651
21652internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
21653 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
21654 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
21655 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
21656 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
21657
21658 * head : The oldest inserted block
21659 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021660 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021661
21662internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
21663 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
21664 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
21665 it returns false.
21666
21667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200216687.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021669---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010021670
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021671Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
21672every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020021673order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010021674
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021675ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020021676---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
21677FALSE always_false never match
21678HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
21679HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
21680HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010021681HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020021682HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
21683HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
21684HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
21685HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
Björn Jacke20d0f502021-10-15 16:32:15 +020021686LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 ::1 match connection from local host
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020021687METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
21688METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
21689METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
21690METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
21691METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
21692METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
21693METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
21694METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
21695RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
21696REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
21697TRUE always_true always match
21698WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
21699---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010021700
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010021701
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200217028. Logging
21703----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010021704
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021705One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
21706provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
21707very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
21708provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
21709state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021710to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021711headers.
21712
21713In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
21714about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
21715send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
21716
21717 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
21718 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
21719 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
21720 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
21721 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021722 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060021723 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021724
21725The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
21726allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
21727as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
21728while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
21729real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
21730delay.
21731
21732
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200217338.1. Log levels
21734---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021735
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090021736TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021737source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090021738HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
21739in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
21740track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
21741syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
21742about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021743
21744
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200217458.2. Log formats
21746----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021747
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021748HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090021749and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
21750slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
21751options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021752
21753 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
21754 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
21755 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
21756 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
21757 extents.
21758
21759 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
21760 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
21761 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
21762 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
21763 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
21764
21765 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
21766 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
21767 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
21768 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
21769 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
21770
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020021771 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
21772 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
21773 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
21774 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
21775
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021776 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
21777
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021778Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
21779specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
21780field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
21781servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
21782always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
21783identifier.
21784
21785Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
21786 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
21787 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
21788 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
21789 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
21790
21791
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200217928.2.1. Default log format
21793-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021794
21795This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
21796as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
21797format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
21798
21799 Example :
21800 listen www
21801 mode http
21802 log global
21803 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
21804
21805 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
21806 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
21807 (www/HTTP)
21808
21809 Field Format Extract from the example above
21810 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
21811 2 'Connect from' Connect from
21812 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
21813 4 'to' to
21814 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
21815 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
21816
21817Detailed fields description :
21818 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
21819 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
21820 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
21821 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
21822 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
21823 and processed the connection.
21824 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
21825
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010021826In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
21827"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
21828connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
21829
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021830It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
21831will eventually disappear.
21832
21833
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200218348.2.2. TCP log format
21835---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021836
21837The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
21838is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
21839information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
21840counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
21841emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
21842environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
21843the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
21844sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020021845specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021846not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend.
21847
21848The TCP log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
21849exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010021850if required. Additionally the HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT variable can be used instead.
21851Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021852
21853 # strict equivalent of "option tcplog"
21854 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
21855 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010021856 # or using the HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT variable
21857 log-format "${HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT}"
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021858
21859A few fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those
21860are marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021861
21862 Example :
21863 frontend fnt
21864 mode tcp
21865 option tcplog
21866 log global
21867 default_backend bck
21868
21869 backend bck
21870 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
21871
21872 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
21873 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
21874 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
21875
21876 Field Format Extract from the example above
21877 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
21878 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
21879 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
21880 4 frontend_name fnt
21881 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
21882 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
21883 7 bytes_read* 212
21884 8 termination_state --
21885 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
21886 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
21887
21888Detailed fields description :
21889 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021890 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010021891 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
21892 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010021893 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021894 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010021895 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021896
21897 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010021898 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
21899 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
21900 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021901
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021902 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by HAProxy
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021903 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
21904 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021905 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
21906 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
21907 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
21908 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021909
21910 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
21911 and processed the connection.
21912
21913 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
21914 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
21915 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
21916 applications.
21917
21918 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
21919 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
21920 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
21921 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
21922 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
21923
21924 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
21925 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
21926 See "Timers" below for more details.
21927
21928 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
21929 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
21930 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
21931 "Timers" below for more details.
21932
21933 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021934 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021935 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
21936 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
21937 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
21938 details.
21939
21940 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
21941 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
21942 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
21943 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
21944 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
21945
21946 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
21947 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
21948 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
21949 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
21950 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
21951 for more details.
21952
21953 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021954 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021955 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
21956 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
21957 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021958 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021959
21960 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
21961 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
21962 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
21963 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
21964 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
21965 caused by a denial of service attack.
21966
21967 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
21968 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
21969 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
21970 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
21971 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
21972 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
21973 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
21974 denial of service attack.
21975
21976 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
21977 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
21978 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
21979 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
21980 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
21981 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
21982 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
21983 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
21984 be processed than on other servers.
21985
21986 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
21987 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
21988 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
21989 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021990 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021991 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
21992 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
21993 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
21994 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
21995 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
21996 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
21997 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
21998 should not be attributed to the logged server.
21999
22000 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
22001 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
22002 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
22003 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
22004 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
22005 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022006 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022007 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
22008
22009 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
22010 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
22011 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
22012 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
22013 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
22014 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022015 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022016 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
22017 occurs.
22018
22019
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200220208.2.3. HTTP log format
22021----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022022
22023The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
22024is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
22025the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
22026are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
22027emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
22028generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
22029"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
22030which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020022031frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
22032is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022033
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022034The HTTP log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
22035exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022036if required. Additionally the HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT variable can be used
22037instead. Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022038
22039 # strict equivalent of "option httplog"
22040 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
22041 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
22042
22043And the CLF log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on
22044this exact string:
22045
22046 # strict equivalent of "option httplog clf"
22047 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
22048 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
22049 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022050 # or using the HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT variable
22051 log-format "${HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT}"
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022052
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022053Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
22054slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
22055with a star ('*') after the field name below.
22056
22057 Example :
22058 frontend http-in
22059 mode http
22060 option httplog
22061 log global
22062 default_backend bck
22063
22064 backend static
22065 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
22066
22067 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
22068 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
22069 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022070 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022071
22072 Field Format Extract from the example above
22073 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
22074 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022075 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022076 4 frontend_name http-in
22077 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022078 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022079 7 status_code 200
22080 8 bytes_read* 2750
22081 9 captured_request_cookie -
22082 10 captured_response_cookie -
22083 11 termination_state ----
22084 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
22085 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
22086 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
22087 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
22088 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022089
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022090Detailed fields description :
22091 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022092 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022093 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
22094 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010022095 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022096 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010022097 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022098
22099 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022100 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
22101 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
22102 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022103
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022104 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022105 was received by HAProxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022106
22107 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
22108 and processed the connection.
22109
22110 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
22111 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
22112 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
22113
22114 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
22115 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
22116 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
22117 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
22118 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
22119 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
22120
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022121 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
22122 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
22123 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050022124 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022125 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
22126 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022127 HAProxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022128 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022129
22130 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
22131 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022132 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022133
22134 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
22135 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022136 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
22137 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022138
22139 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
22140 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
22141 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
22142 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
22143 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022144 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
22145 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022146
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022147 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in HAProxy, which is the total
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022148 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
22149 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
22150 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
22151 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
22152 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
22153 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022154 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022155
22156 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022157 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by HAProxy when
22158 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022159
22160 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
22161 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050022162 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022163 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
22164 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
22165 overflowing.
22166
22167 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
22168 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
22169 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
22170 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
22171 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
22172 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
22173 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
22174 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
22175
22176 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
22177 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
22178 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
22179 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
22180 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
22181 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
22182 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
22183 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
22184
22185 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
22186 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
22187 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
22188 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
22189 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
22190 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
22191 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
22192
22193 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040022194 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022195 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
22196 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
22197 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022198 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022199 system.
22200
22201 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
22202 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
22203 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
22204 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
22205 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
22206 caused by a denial of service attack.
22207
22208 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
22209 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
22210 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
22211 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
22212 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
22213 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
22214 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
22215 denial of service attack.
22216
22217 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
22218 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
22219 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
22220 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
22221 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
22222 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
22223 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
22224 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
22225 processed than on other servers.
22226
22227 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
22228 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
22229 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
22230 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022231 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022232 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
22233 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
22234 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
22235 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
22236 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
22237 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
22238 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
22239 should not be attributed to the logged server.
22240
22241 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
22242 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
22243 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
22244 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
22245 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
22246 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022247 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022248 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
22249
22250 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
22251 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
22252 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
22253 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
22254 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
22255 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022256 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022257 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
22258 occurs.
22259
22260 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
22261 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
22262 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
22263 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
22264 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
22265 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
22266 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
22267 cookies" below for more details.
22268
22269 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
22270 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
22271 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
22272 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
22273 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
22274 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
22275 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
22276 and cookies" below for more details.
22277
22278 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
22279 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
22280 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
22281 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
22282 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
22283 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
22284 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
22285 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
22286
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022287
222888.2.4. HTTPS log format
22289----------------------
22290
22291The HTTPS format is the best suited for HTTP over SSL connections. It is an
22292extension of the HTTP format (see section 8.2.3) to which SSL related
22293information are added. It is enabled when "option httpslog" is specified in the
22294frontend. Just like the TCP and HTTP formats, the log is usually emitted at the
22295end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified. A session which
22296matches the "monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log
22297sessions for which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option
22298dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if
22299"option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend.
22300
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022301The HTTPS log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
22302exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022303if required. Additionally the HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT variable can be used
22304instead. Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022305
22306 # strict equivalent of "option httpslog"
22307 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
22308 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r \
22309 %[fc_err]/%[ssl_fc_err,hex]/%[ssl_c_err]/\
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010022310 %[ssl_c_ca_err]/%[ssl_fc_is_resumed] %[ssl_fc_sni]/%sslv/%sslc"
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022311 # or using the HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT variable
22312 log-format "${HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT}"
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022313
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022314This format is basically the HTTP one (see section 8.2.3) with new fields
22315appended to it. The new fields (lines 17 and 18) will be detailed here. For the
22316HTTP ones, refer to the HTTP section.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022317
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022318 Example :
22319 frontend https-in
22320 mode http
22321 option httpslog
22322 log global
22323 bind *:443 ssl crt mycerts/srv.pem ...
22324 default_backend bck
22325
22326 backend static
22327 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000 ssl crt mycerts/clt.pem ...
22328
22329 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
22330 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] https-in \
22331 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010022332 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1" 0/0/0/0/0 \
22333 1wt.eu/TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022334
22335 Field Format Extract from the example above
22336 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
22337 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
22338 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
22339 4 frontend_name https-in
22340 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
22341 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
22342 7 status_code 200
22343 8 bytes_read* 2750
22344 9 captured_request_cookie -
22345 10 captured_response_cookie -
22346 11 termination_state ----
22347 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
22348 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
22349 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
22350 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
22351 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010022352 17 fc_err '/' ssl_fc_err '/' ssl_c_err
William Lallemand1d58b012021-10-14 14:27:48 +020022353 '/' ssl_c_ca_err '/' ssl_fc_is_resumed 0/0/0/0/0
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010022354 18 ssl_fc_sni '/' ssl_version
22355 '/' ssl_ciphers 1wt.eu/TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022356
22357Detailed fields description :
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010022358 - "fc_err" is the status of the connection on the frontend's side. It
22359 corresponds to the "fc_err" sample fetch. See the "fc_err" and "fc_err_str"
22360 sample fetch functions for more information.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022361
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020022362 - "ssl_fc_err" is the last error of the first SSL error stack that was
22363 raised on the connection from the frontend's perspective. It might be used
22364 to detect SSL handshake errors for instance. It will be 0 if everything
Ilya Shipitsinbd6b4be2021-10-15 16:18:21 +050022365 went well. See the "ssl_fc_err" sample fetch's description for more
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020022366 information.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022367
22368 - "ssl_c_err" is the status of the client's certificate verification process.
22369 The handshake might be successful while having a non-null verification
22370 error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_err" sample fetch and
22371 the "crt-ignore-err" option.
22372
22373 - "ssl_c_ca_err" is the status of the client's certificate chain verification
22374 process. The handshake might be successful while having a non-null
22375 verification error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_ca_err"
22376 sample fetch and the "ca-ignore-err" option.
22377
William Lallemand1d58b012021-10-14 14:27:48 +020022378 - "ssl_fc_is_resumed" is true if the incoming TLS session was resumed with
22379 the stateful cache or a stateless ticket. Don't forgot that a TLS session
22380 can be shared by multiple requests.
22381
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010022382 - "ssl_fc_sni" is the SNI (Server Name Indication) presented by the client
22383 to select the certificate to be used. It usually matches the host name for
22384 the first request of a connection. An absence of this field may indicate
22385 that the SNI was not sent by the client, and will lead haproxy to use the
22386 default certificate, or to reject the connection in case of strict-sni.
22387
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022388 - "ssl_version" is the SSL version of the frontend.
22389
22390 - "ssl_ciphers" is the SSL cipher used for the connection.
22391
22392
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +0100223938.2.5. Error log format
22394-----------------------
22395
22396When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
22397protocol header, HAProxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format,
22398unless a dedicated error log format is defined through an "error-log-format"
22399line. By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
22400"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
22401will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
22402logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
22403
22404The default format looks like this :
22405
22406 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
22407 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
22408 Connection error during SSL handshake
22409
22410 Field Format Extract from the example above
22411 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
22412 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
22413 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
22414 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
22415 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
22416
22417These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
22418failures.
22419
22420By using the "error-log-format" directive, the legacy log format described
22421above will not be used anymore, and all error log lines will follow the
22422defined format.
22423
22424An example of reasonably complete error-log-format follows, it will report the
22425source address and port, the connection accept() date, the frontend name, the
22426number of active connections on the process and on thit frontend, haproxy's
22427internal error identifier on the front connection, the hexadecimal OpenSSL
22428error number (that can be copy-pasted to "openssl errstr" for full decoding),
22429the client certificate extraction status (0 indicates no error), the client
22430certificate validation status using the CA (0 indicates no error), a boolean
22431indicating if the connection is new or was resumed, the optional server name
22432indication (SNI) provided by the client, the SSL version name and the SSL
22433ciphers used on the connection, if any. Note that backend connection errors
22434are never reported here since in order for a backend connection to fail, it
22435would have passed through a successful stream, hence will be available as
22436regular traffic log (see option httplog or option httpslog).
22437
22438 # detailed frontend connection error log
Lukas Tribus2b949732021-12-09 01:27:14 +010022439 error-log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %ac/%fc %[fc_err]/\
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010022440 %[ssl_fc_err,hex]/%[ssl_c_err]/%[ssl_c_ca_err]/%[ssl_fc_is_resumed] \
22441 %[ssl_fc_sni]/%sslv/%sslc"
22442
22443
224448.2.6. Custom log format
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020022445------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022446
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022447When the default log formats are not sufficient, it is possible to define new
22448ones in very fine details. As creating a log-format from scratch is not always
22449a trivial task, it is strongly recommended to first have a look at the existing
22450formats ("option tcplog", "option httplog", "option httpslog"), pick the one
22451looking the closest to the expectation, copy its "log-format" equivalent string
22452and adjust it.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022453
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022454HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022455Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
22456separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
22457prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
22458
22459Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
22460variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010022461("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022462
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010022463If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020022464as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010022465less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
22466the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
22467
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020022468Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
22469"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
22470delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
22471preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022472
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010022473Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
22474'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
22475https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
22476such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
22477
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022478Flags are :
22479 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040022480 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010022481 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
22482 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022483
22484 Example:
22485
22486 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
22487 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
22488
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010022489 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
22490
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022491Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
22492
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022493 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020022494 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022495 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
22496 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
22497 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022498 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
22499 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
22500 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020022501 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000022502 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000022503 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000022504 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000022505 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000022506 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
22507 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010022508 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020022509 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020022510 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Christopher Faulet3010e002021-12-03 10:48:36 +010022511 | H | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022512 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020022513 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080022514 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022515 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
22516 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
22517 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
22518 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
22519 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020022520 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022521 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000022522 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022523 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022524 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022525 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
22526 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022527 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
22528 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
22529 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022530 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022531 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
22532 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022533 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022534 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
22535 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
22536 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020022537 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020022538 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020022539 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
22540 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
22541 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
22542 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020022543 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020022544 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020022545 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022546 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010022547 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022548 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022549 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
22550 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
22551 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022552 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020022553 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
22554 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022555 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022556 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
22557 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020022558 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022559 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020022560 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022561 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022562
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020022563 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022564
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010022565
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200225668.3. Advanced logging options
22567-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022568
22569Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
22570just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
22571options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
22572for more information about their usage.
22573
22574
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200225758.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
22576------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022577
22578It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022579HAProxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022580commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
22581monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
22582ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
22583
22584 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
22585 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
22586 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
22587 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
22588
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020022589 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
22590 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022591
22592 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
22593 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
22594 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
22595
22596
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200225978.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
22598----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022599
22600The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
22601what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
22602or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022603"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022604just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
22605log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
22606after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
22607is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
22608with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
22609with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
22610
22611
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226128.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
22613------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020022614
22615Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
22616for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
22617"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
22618retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
22619raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
22620a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
22621file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
22622you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
22623"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
22624
22625
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226268.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
22627--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020022628
22629Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
22630multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
22631them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
22632"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
22633logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
22634error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
22635and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
22636too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
22637useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
22638alternative.
22639
22640
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226418.4. Timing events
22642------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022643
22644Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
22645reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
22646the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
22647frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022648mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
22649addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
22650
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010022651Timings events in HTTP mode:
22652
22653 first request 2nd request
22654 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
22655 t tr t tr ...
22656 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
22657 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
22658 :<---- Tq ---->: :
22659 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000022660 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010022661 :<--------- Ta --------->:
22662
22663Timings events in TCP mode:
22664
22665 TCP session
22666 |<----------------->|
22667 t t
22668 ---|----|----|----|----|---
22669 | Th Tw Tc Td |
22670 |<------ Tt ------->|
22671
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022672 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022673 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022674 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
22675 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
22676 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022677 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022678 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
22679 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
22680 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
22681 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022682
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022683 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
22684 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
22685 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022686 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
22687 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
22688 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
22689 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
22690 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
22691 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022692
22693 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
22694 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
22695 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
22696 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
22697 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
22698 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
22699 request typed by hand during a test.
22700
22701 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
22702 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022703 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022704 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
22705 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
22706 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
22707 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022708
22709 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
22710 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
22711 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
22712 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
22713 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
22714
22715 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
22716 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
22717 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
22718 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
22719 connection never established.
22720
22721 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
22722 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
22723 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
22724 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
22725 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
22726 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
22727 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
22728 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
22729 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
22730 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
22731 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
22732
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022733 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
22734 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
22735 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
22736 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
22737 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
22738 by subtracting other timers when valid :
22739
22740 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
22741
22742 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
22743 "Ta" can never be negative.
22744
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022745 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
22746 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022747 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
22748 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030022749 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022750
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022751 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022752
22753 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022754 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
22755 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022756
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000022757 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
22758 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
22759 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
22760 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
22761 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
22762 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
22763 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
22764 prefixed with a '+' sign.
22765
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022766These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
22767protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
22768that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022769due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
22770"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
22771that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022772
22773Most common cases :
22774
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022775 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
22776 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
22777 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
22778 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
22779 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022780 ended, HAProxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022781 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
22782 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
22783 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
22784 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
22785 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020022786 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022787
22788 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
22789 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
22790 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
22791 of ms on remote networks.
22792
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020022793 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
22794 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
22795 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022796
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022797 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
22798 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022799 HAProxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022800 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
22801 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
22802 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
22803 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
22804 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
22805 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022806
22807Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
22808
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022809 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022810 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022811 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022812
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022813 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022814 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
22815 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
22816
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022817 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022818 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
22819 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
22820 flags.
22821
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022822 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
22823 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022824 Check the session termination flags, then check the
22825 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
22826 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
22827 the client connection was maintained open.
22828
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022829 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030022830 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022831 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022832 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
22833
22834
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200228358.5. Session state at disconnection
22836-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022837
22838TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
22839"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
228402-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
22841each of which has a special meaning :
22842
22843 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
22844 session to terminate :
22845
22846 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
22847
22848 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
22849 server explicitly refused it.
22850
22851 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
22852 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
22853 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
22854 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022855 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020022856
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022857 L : the session was locally processed by HAProxy and was not passed to
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020022858 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022859
22860 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
22861 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
22862 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
22863 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
22864 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
22865
22866 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
22867 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
22868 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
22869 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
22870 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
22871
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022872 D : the session was killed by HAProxy because the server was detected
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090022873 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
22874
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022875 U : the session was killed by HAProxy on this backup server because an
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070022876 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
22877 backup connections when going up.
22878
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022879 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020022880
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022881 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
22882 send or receive data.
22883
22884 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
22885 send or receive data.
22886
22887 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
22888 with nothing left in the buffers.
22889
22890 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
22891
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010022892 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022893 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
22894
22895 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
22896 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
22897 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
22898 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
22899 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
22900
22901 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
22902 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
22903
22904 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
22905 server (HTTP only).
22906
22907 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
22908
22909 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
22910 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
22911 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
22912
22913 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
22914 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
22915 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
22916
22917 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
22918
22919 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
22920 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
22921
22922 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
22923 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
22924 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
22925
22926 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
22927 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020022928 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
22929 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022930
22931 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
22932 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
22933 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
22934 another server.
22935
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022936 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022937 server.
22938
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022939 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
22940 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
22941 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
22942 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
22943
22944 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
22945 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
22946 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
22947 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
22948
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020022949 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
22950 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
22951 "use-server" rule).
22952
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022953 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
22954
22955 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
22956 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
22957
22958 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
22959
22960 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
22961 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
22962 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
22963
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022964 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
22965 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030022966 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022967 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
22968 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
22969
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022970 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
22971
22972 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
22973 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
22974
22975 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
22976
22977 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
22978
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022979The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
22980was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022981helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
22982starvation, attacks, etc...
22983
22984The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
22985alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
22986easier finding and understanding.
22987
22988 Flags Reason
22989
22990 -- Normal termination.
22991
22992 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022993 server. This can happen when HAProxy tries to connect to a recently
22994 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while HAProxy is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022995 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
22996
22997 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
22998 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022999 client and HAProxy which decided to actively break the connection,
23000 by network routing issues between the client and HAProxy, or by a
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023001 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
23002 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010023003
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023004 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
23005 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020023006 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023007
23008 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
23009 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
23010 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
23011
23012 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
23013 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
23014 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
23015 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
23016 the server takes too long to respond.
23017
23018 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
23019 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
23020 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
23021 long a time to respond.
23022
23023 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
23024 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
23025 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023026 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between HAProxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020023027 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
23028 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023029
23030 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
23031 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
23032 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
23033 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
23034 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020023035 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020023036 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
23037 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
23038 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
23039 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
23040 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
23041 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
23042 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
23043 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023044 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020023045 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
23046 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
23047 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023048
23049 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
23050 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020023051 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
23052 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
23053 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
23054 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023055
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023056 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. Generally
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020023057 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
23058
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023059 SC The server or an equipment between it and HAProxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023060 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
23061 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023062 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023063 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
23064 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
23065
23066 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
23067 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
23068 503 or 504 here.
23069
23070 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023071 transfer. This usually means that HAProxy has received an RST from
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023072 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
23073 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
23074 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
23075
23076 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
23077 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023078 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023079 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023080 between the client and the server expiring first on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023081
23082 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
23083 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
23084 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
23085 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
23086 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
23087 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023088 between HAProxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023089
23090 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
23091 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
23092 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
23093 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
23094 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
23095 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
23096 solution is to fix the application.
23097
23098 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
23099 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
23100 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
23101 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
23102 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
23103 external attacks.
23104
23105 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070023106 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020023107 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023108 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
23109 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
23110
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010023111 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
23112 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
23113 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023114 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020023115 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010023116
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023117 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
23118 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
23119 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
23120 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010023121 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
23122 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
23123 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
23124 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
Christopher Faulet24dda942022-05-05 12:27:07 +020023125 logs. Finally, it may be due to an HTTP header rewrite failure on the
23126 response. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is sent (see
23127 "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-response strict-mode" for more
23128 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023129
23130 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
23131 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
23132 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
Christopher Faulet24dda942022-05-05 12:27:07 +020023133 returned an HTTP 403 error. It may also be due to an HTTP header
23134 rewrite failure on the request. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is
23135 sent (see "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-request strict-mode" for more
23136 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023137
23138 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
23139 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
23140 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
23141 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
23142
23143 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
23144 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
23145 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
23146 only be solved by proper system tuning.
23147
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023148The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023149persistence was handled by the client, the server and by HAProxy. This is very
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023150important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
23151re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
23152
23153 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
23154
23155 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
23156 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
23157 set on a GET request.
23158
23159 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
23160 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040023161 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023162 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
23163
23164 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
23165 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
23166 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
23167
23168 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
23169 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
23170 already got a cookie.
23171
23172 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
23173 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
23174 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
23175 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
23176 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
23177
23178 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
23179 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
23180 new cookie was inserted in the response.
23181
23182 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
23183 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
23184 new cookie was inserted in the response.
23185
23186 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
23187 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
23188
23189 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
23190 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
23191 then advertised in the response.
23192
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023193
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200231948.6. Non-printable characters
23195-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023196
23197In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
23198consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
23199converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
23200prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
23201being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
23202escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
23203is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
23204'}' when logging headers.
23205
23206Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
23207issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
23208containing spaces is "User-Agent".
23209
23210Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
23211the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
23212performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
23213
23214
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200232158.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
23216---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023217
23218Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
23219achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023220section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023221cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
23222the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
23223the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023224locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023225not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
23226user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
23227a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
23228wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
23229
23230 Examples :
23231 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
23232 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
23233
23234 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
23235 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
23236
23237
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200232388.8. Capturing HTTP headers
23239---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023240
23241Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
23242proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
23243the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
23244server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
23245
23246Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
23247response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023248section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023249
23250It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010023251time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
23252appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023253are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
23254and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
23255follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
23256request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
23257in the logs.
23258
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020023259As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
23260frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
23261an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
23262
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023263 Example :
23264 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
23265 listen proxy-out
23266 mode http
23267 option httplog
23268 option logasap
23269 log global
23270 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
23271
23272 # log the name of the virtual server
23273 capture request header Host len 20
23274
23275 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
23276 capture request header Content-Length len 10
23277
23278 # log the beginning of the referrer
23279 capture request header Referer len 20
23280
23281 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
23282 capture response header Server len 20
23283
23284 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
23285 capture response header Content-Length len 10
23286
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023287 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023288 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
23289
23290 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
23291 capture response header Via len 20
23292
23293 # log the URL location during a redirection
23294 capture response header Location len 20
23295
23296 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
23297 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
23298 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
23299 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
23300 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
23301
23302 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
23303 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
23304 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
23305 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010023306 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023307
23308 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
23309 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
23310 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
23311 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
23312 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010023313 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023314
23315
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200233168.9. Examples of logs
23317---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023318
23319These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
23320them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
23321reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
23322
23323 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
23324 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
23325 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
23326
23327 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
23328 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
23329
23330 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
23331 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
23332 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
23333
23334 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
23335 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
23336
23337 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
23338 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
23339 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
23340
23341 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010023342 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023343 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
23344 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
23345
23346 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
23347 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
23348 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
23349
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020023350 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
23351 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
23352 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
23353 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023354 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was HAProxy who decided to
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020023355 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023356
23357 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010023358 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023359
23360 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
23361 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
23362 Nothing was sent to any server.
23363
23364 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
23365 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
23366
23367 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
23368 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023369 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023370 send a 408 return code to the client.
23371
23372 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
23373 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
23374
23375 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
23376 5 seconds ("c----").
23377
23378 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
23379 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010023380 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023381
23382 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023383 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023384 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
23385 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
23386 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
23387 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
23388 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010023389
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020023390
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200233919. Supported filters
23392--------------------
23393
23394Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
23395accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
23396unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
23397
23398See also : "filter"
23399
234009.1. Trace
23401----------
23402
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010023403filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020023404
23405 Arguments:
23406 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
23407 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
23408
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010023409 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020023410
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023411 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020023412 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
23413 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
23414 amount of the parsed data.
23415
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023416 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010023417
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020023418This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
23419callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
23420information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
23421filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
23422
23423Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
23424tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
23425a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
23426
23427
234289.2. HTTP compression
23429---------------------
23430
23431filter compression
23432
23433The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
23434keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023435when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
23436fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
23437done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
23438explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
23439filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
23440listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
23441order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020023442
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023443See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
23444 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020023445
23446
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200234479.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
23448--------------------------------------------
23449
23450filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
23451
23452 Arguments :
23453
23454 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
23455 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
23456 parsed.
23457
23458 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
23459 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
23460 part must be placed in its own scope.
23461
23462The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
23463external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023464streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020023465exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
23466also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
23467
23468SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
23469the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
23470
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010023471For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020023472"doc/SPOE.txt".
23473
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100234749.4. Cache
23475----------
23476
23477filter cache <name>
23478
23479 Arguments :
23480
23481 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
23482
23483The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
23484"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050023485cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023486other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
23487case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
23488is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
23489filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010023490listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
23491order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010023492
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023493See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
23494 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
23495
23496
234979.5. Fcgi-app
23498-------------
23499
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040023500filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023501
23502 Arguments :
23503
23504 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
23505
23506The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
23507request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
23508reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
23509used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
23510implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
23511used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
23512fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
23513used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
23514order.
23515
23516See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
23517 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
23518
23519
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100235209.6. OpenTracing
23521----------------
23522
23523The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
23524HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
23525of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
23526Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
23527
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023528This feature is only enabled when HAProxy was built with USE_OT=1.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010023529
23530The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
23531HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
23532participates in the work of HAProxy.
23533
23534filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
23535
23536 Arguments :
23537
23538 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
23539 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
23540 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
23541 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
23542 OpenTracing filters.
23543
23544 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
23545 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
23546 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
23547 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
23548 filter must have its own scope defined.
23549
23550More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020023551of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010023552
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +0200235539.7. Bandwidth limitation
23554--------------------------
23555
23556filter bwlim-in <name> default-limit <size> default-period <time> [min-size <sz>]
23557filter bwlim-out <name> default-limit <size> default-period <time> [min-size <sz>]
23558filter bwlim-in <name> limit <size> key <pattern> [table <table>] [min-size <sz>]
23559filter bwlim-out <name> limit <size> key <pattern> [table <table>] [min-size <sz>]
23560
23561 Arguments :
23562
23563 <name> is the filter name that will be used by 'set-bandwidth-limit'
23564 actions to reference a specific bandwidth limitation filter.
23565
23566 <size> is max number of bytes that can be forwarded over the period.
23567 The value must be specified for per-stream and shared bandwidth
23568 limitation filters. It follows the HAProxy size format and is
23569 expressed in bytes.
23570
23571 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
23572 describes what elements will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
23573 and used to select which table entry to update the counters. It
23574 must be specified for shared bandwidth limitation filters only.
23575
23576 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
23577 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. It can
23578 be specified for shared bandwidth limitation filters only.
23579
23580 <time> is the default time period used to evaluate the bandwidth
Ilya Shipitsin3b64a282022-07-29 22:26:53 +050023581 limitation rate. It can be specified for per-stream bandwidth
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020023582 limitation filters only. It follows the HAProxy time format and
23583 is expressed in milliseconds.
23584
23585 <min-size> is the optional minimum number of bytes forwarded at a time by
23586 a stream excluding the last packet that may be smaller. This
23587 value can be specified for per-stream and shared bandwidth
23588 limitation filters. It follows the HAProxy size format and is
23589 expressed in bytes.
23590
23591Bandwidth limitation filters should be used to restrict the data forwarding
23592speed at the stream level. By extension, such filters limit the network
23593bandwidth consumed by a resource. Several bandwidth limitation filters can be
23594used. For instance, it is possible to define a limit per source address to be
23595sure a client will never consume all the network bandwidth, thereby penalizing
23596other clients, and another one per stream to be able to fairly handle several
23597connections for a given client.
23598
23599The definition order of these filters is important. If several bandwidth
23600filters are enabled on a stream, the filtering will be applied in their
23601definition order. It is also important to understand the definition order of
23602the other filters have an influence. For instance, depending on the HTTP
23603compression filter is defined before or after a bandwidth limitation filter,
23604the limit will be applied on the compressed payload or not. The same is true
23605for the cache filter.
23606
23607There are two kinds of bandwidth limitation filters. The first one enforces a
23608default limit and is applied per stream. The second one uses a stickiness table
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +050023609to enforce a limit equally divided between all streams sharing the same entry in
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020023610the table.
23611
23612In addition, for a given filter, depending on the filter keyword used, the
23613limitation can be applied on incoming data, received from the client and
23614forwarded to a server, or on outgoing data, received from a server and sent to
23615the client. To apply a limit on incoming data, "bwlim-in" keyword must be
23616used. To apply it on outgoing data, "bwlim-out" keyword must be used. In both
23617cases, the bandwidth limitation is applied on forwarded data, at the stream
23618level.
23619
23620The bandwidth limitation is applied at the stream level and not at the
23621connection level. For multiplexed protocols (H2, H3 and FastCGI), the streams
23622of the same connection may have different limits.
23623
23624For a per-stream bandwidth limitation filter, default period and limit must be
23625defined. As their names suggest, they are the default values used to setup the
23626bandwidth limitation rate for a stream. However, for this kind of filter and
23627only this one, it is possible to redefine these values using sample expressions
23628when the filter is enabled with a TCP/HTTP "set-bandwidth-limit" action.
23629
23630For a shared bandwidth limitation filter, depending on whether it is applied on
23631incoming or outgoing data, the stickiness table used must store the
23632corresponding bytes rate information. "bytes_in_rate(<period>)" counter must be
23633stored to limit incoming data and "bytes_out_rate(<period>)" counter must be
23634used to limit outgoing data.
23635
23636Finally, it is possible to set the minimum number of bytes that a bandwidth
23637limitation filter can forward at a time for a given stream. It should be used
23638to not forward too small amount of data, to reduce the CPU usage. It must
23639carefully be defined. Too small, a value can increase the CPU usage. Too high,
23640it can increase the latency. It is also highly linked to the defined bandwidth
23641limit. If it is too close to the bandwidth limit, some pauses may be
23642experienced to not exceed the limit because too many bytes will be consumed at
23643a time. It is highly dependent on the filter configuration. A good idea is to
23644start with something around 2 TCP MSS, typically 2896 bytes, and tune it after
23645some experimentations.
23646
23647 Example:
23648 frontend http
23649 bind *:80
23650 mode http
23651
23652 # If this filter is enabled, the stream will share the download limit
23653 # of 10m/s with all other streams with the same source address.
23654 filter bwlim-out limit-by-src key src table limit-by-src limit 10m
23655
Ilya Shipitsin3b64a282022-07-29 22:26:53 +050023656 # If this filter is enabled, the stream will be limited to download at 1m/s,
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020023657 # independently of all other streams.
23658 filter bwlim-out limit-by-strm default-limit 1m default-period 1s
23659
23660 # Limit all streams to 1m/s (the default limit) and those accessing the
23661 # internal API to 100k/s. Limit each source address to 10m/s. The shared
23662 # limit is applied first. Both are limiting the download rate.
23663 http-request set-bandwidth-limit limit-by-strm
23664 http-request set-bandwidth-limit limit-by-strm limit 100k if { path_beg /internal }
23665 http-request set-bandwidth-limit limit-by-src
23666 ...
23667
23668 backend limit-by-src
23669 # The stickiness table used by <limit-by-src> filter
23670 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 3600s store bytes_out_rate(1s)
23671
23672See also : "tcp-request content set-bandwidth-limit",
23673 "tcp-response content set-bandwidth-limit",
23674 "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" and
23675 "http-response set-bandwidth-limit".
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010023676
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002367710. FastCGI applications
23678-------------------------
23679
23680HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
23681feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
23682the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
23683FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
23684servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
23685FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
23686backend.
23687
23688HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
23689application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
23690connection.
23691
2369210.1. Setup
23693-----------
23694
2369510.1.1. Fcgi-app section
23696--------------------------
23697
23698fcgi-app <name>
23699 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
23700 document root must be defined.
23701
23702acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
23703 Declare or complete an access list.
23704
23705 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
23706 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
23707 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
23708 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
23709 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
23710
23711docroot <path>
23712 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
23713 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
23714 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
23715
23716index <script-name>
23717 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
23718 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
23719 is an optional setting.
23720
23721 Example :
23722 index index.php
23723
23724log-stderr global
23725log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010023726 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023727 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
23728
23729 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
23730 default STDERR messages are ignored.
23731
23732pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
23733 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
23734 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
23735 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
23736
23737 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
23738 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
23739 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
23740 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
23741
23742 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
23743 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
23744
23745path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010023746 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010023747 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
23748 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
23749 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
23750 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
23751 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
23752 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
23753 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010023754
23755 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050023756 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010023757 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
23758 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
23759 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
23760 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023761
23762 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010023763 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
23764 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023765
23766option get-values
23767no option get-values
23768 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
23769
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040023770 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023771 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
23772
23773 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
23774 application will accept.
23775
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020023776 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
23777 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023778
23779 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050023780 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023781 option is disabled.
23782
23783 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
23784 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
23785 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
23786 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
23787 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
23788 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
23789
23790option keep-conn
23791no option keep-conn
23792 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
23793 sending a response.
23794
23795 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
23796 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
23797
23798option max-reqs <reqs>
23799 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
23800 accept.
23801
23802 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
23803 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
23804 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
23805 to 1.
23806
23807option mpxs-conns
23808no option mpxs-conns
23809 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
23810
23811 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
23812 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
23813
23814set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
23815 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
23816 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
23817 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
23818 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
23819
23820 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
23821 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
23822 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
23823
23824 Example :
23825 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
23826 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
23827
23828 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
23829
23830
2383110.1.2. Proxy section
23832---------------------
23833
23834use-fcgi-app <name>
23835 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
23836
23837 Arguments :
23838 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
23839
23840 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
23841 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
23842 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
23843 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
23844 application may be defined at a time per backend.
23845
23846 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
23847 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
23848 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
23849 application are evaluated.
23850
23851
2385210.1.3. Example
23853---------------
23854
23855 frontend front-http
23856 mode http
23857 bind *:80
23858 bind *:
23859
23860 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
23861 default_backend back-static
23862
23863 backend back-static
23864 mode http
23865 server www A.B.C.D:80
23866
23867 backend back-dynamic
23868 mode http
23869 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
23870 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
23871
23872 fcgi-app php-fpm
23873 log-stderr global
23874 option keep-conn
23875
23876 docroot /var/www/my-app
23877 index index.php
23878 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
23879
23880
2388110.2. Default parameters
23882------------------------
23883
23884A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
23885the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050023886script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023887applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
23888
23889 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23890 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
23891 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
23892 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
23893 | | |
23894 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23895 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
23896 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
23897 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
23898 | | application. |
23899 | | |
23900 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23901 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
23902 | | the request. It may not be set. |
23903 | | |
23904 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23905 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
23906 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
23907 | | the application's configuration. |
23908 | | |
23909 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23910 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
23911 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
23912 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
23913 | | |
23914 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23915 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
23916 | | following the part that identifies the script |
23917 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
23918 | | be defined. |
23919 | | |
23920 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23921 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
23922 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
23923 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
23924 | | is not set too. |
23925 | | |
23926 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23927 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
23928 | | set. |
23929 | | |
23930 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23931 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
23932 | | the request. |
23933 | | |
23934 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23935 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
23936 | | client as part of user authentication. |
23937 | | |
23938 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23939 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
23940 | | script to process the request. |
23941 | | |
23942 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23943 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
23944 | | |
23945 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23946 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
23947 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
23948 | | |
23949 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23950 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
23951 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
23952 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
23953 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
23954 | | |
23955 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23956 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
23957 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
23958 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
23959 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
23960 | | side. |
23961 | | |
23962 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23963 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
23964 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
23965 | | connected to. |
23966 | | |
23967 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23968 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
23969 | | |
23970 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Faulet5cd0e522021-06-11 13:34:42 +020023971 | SERVER_SOFTWARE | Contains the string "HAProxy" followed by the |
23972 | | current HAProxy version. |
23973 | | |
23974 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023975 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
23976 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
23977 | | |
23978 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23979
23980
2398110.3. Limitations
23982------------------
23983
23984The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
23985way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
23986during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
23987establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
23988application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
23989or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
23990message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
23991these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
23992and HTTP servers under the same backend.
23993
23994Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
23995request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
23996requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
23997
23998About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
23999into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
24000fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
24001"http-request" ones.
24002
24003Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
24004FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
24005processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
24006must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
24007here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010024008
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024009
2401011. Address formats
24011-------------------
24012
24013Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
24014address.
24015
24016This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
24017The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
24018of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
24019equivalent is '::'.
24020
24021Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
24022is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
24023
24024This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
24025family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
24026
24027Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
24028configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
24029use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
24030'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
24031
24032Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
24033socket type and the transport method.
24034
24035
2403611.1 Address family prefixes
24037----------------------------
24038
24039'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
24040
24041'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
24042 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
24043 listening.
24044
24045'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
24046 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
24047 on the statement using this address, a port or
24048 a port range may or must be specified.
24049
24050'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24051 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
24052 using this address, a port or a port range
24053 may or must be specified.
24054
24055'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24056 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
24057 using this address, a port or a port range
24058 may or must be specified.
24059
24060'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
24061 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
24062 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
24063 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
24064 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
24065 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
24066
24067'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
24068 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
24069 start by slash '/'.
24070
24071
2407211.2 Socket type prefixes
24073-------------------------
24074
24075Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
24076type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
24077this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
24078This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
24079but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
24080
24081Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
Willy Tarreaud4c6fbe2023-01-16 12:07:12 +010024082instead use aliases of the next section "11.3 Protocol prefixes".
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024083
24084If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
24085they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
24086report this to the maintainers.
24087
24088'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
24089 to "stream"
24090
24091'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
24092 to "datagram".
24093
24094
2409511.3 Protocol prefixes
24096----------------------
24097
Willy Tarreaued682402023-01-16 12:14:11 +010024098'quic4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24099 an IPv4 address but socket type is forced to
24100 "datagram" and the transport method is forced
24101 to "stream". Depending on the statement using
24102 this address, a UDP port or port range can or
24103 must be specified.
24104
24105'quic6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24106 an IPv6 address but socket type is forced to
24107 "datagram" and the transport method is forced
24108 to "stream". Depending on the statement using
24109 this address, a UDP port or port range can or
24110 must be specified.
24111
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024112'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
24113 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
24114 socket type and transport method is forced to
24115 "stream". Depending on the statement using
24116 this address, a port or a port range can or
24117 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
24118 of 'stream+ip@'.
24119
24120'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24121 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
24122 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
24123 statement using this address, a port or port
24124 range can or must be specified.
24125 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
24126
24127'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24128 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
24129 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
24130 statement using this address, a port or port
24131 range can or must be specified.
24132 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
24133
24134'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
24135 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
24136 socket type and transport method is forced to
24137 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
24138 this address, a port or a port range can or
24139 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
24140 of 'dgram+ip@'.
24141
24142'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24143 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
24144 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
24145 the statement using this address, a port or
24146 port range can or must be specified.
Willy Tarreau24101f92023-01-16 12:11:38 +010024147 It is considered as an alias of 'dgram+ipv4@'.
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024148
24149'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24150 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
24151 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
24152 the statement using this address, a port or
24153 port range can or must be specified.
Willy Tarreau24101f92023-01-16 12:11:38 +010024154 It is considered as an alias of 'dgram+ipv4@'.
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024155
24156'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
24157 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
24158 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
24159
24160'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
24161 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
24162 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
24163
24164In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
24165QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
24166
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010024167/*
24168 * Local variables:
24169 * fill-column: 79
24170 * End:
24171 */